xref: /netbsd-src/external/gpl3/gdb.old/dist/bfd/elf64-ppc.c (revision 73d56d5b0be8704e4f0a7e8221a2c7309572c9a1)
1 /* PowerPC64-specific support for 64-bit ELF.
2    Copyright (C) 1999-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3    Written by Linus Nordberg, Swox AB <info@swox.com>,
4    based on elf32-ppc.c by Ian Lance Taylor.
5    Largely rewritten by Alan Modra.
6 
7    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
8 
9    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12    (at your option) any later version.
13 
14    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
17    GNU General Public License for more details.
18 
19    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
20    with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
21    51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
22 
23 
24 /* The 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI may be found at
25    http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/PPC-elf64abi.txt, and
26    http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/spec/book1.html  */
27 
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc64.h"
35 #include "elf64-ppc.h"
36 #include "dwarf2.h"
37 
38 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_ha_reloc
39   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
40 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_branch_reloc
41   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
42 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc
43   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
44 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc
45   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
46 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc
47   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
48 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_reloc
49   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
50 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc
51   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
52 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc
53   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
54 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc
55   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
56 static bfd_vma opd_entry_value
57   (asection *, bfd_vma, asection **, bfd_vma *, bfd_boolean);
58 
59 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM	powerpc_elf64_le_vec
60 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME	"elf64-powerpcle"
61 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf64_vec
62 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf64-powerpc"
63 #define ELF_ARCH		bfd_arch_powerpc
64 #define ELF_TARGET_ID		PPC64_ELF_DATA
65 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE	EM_PPC64
66 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE		0x10000
67 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE	0x1000
68 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE	ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
69 #define elf_info_to_howto	ppc64_elf_info_to_howto
70 
71 #define elf_backend_want_got_sym 0
72 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 0
73 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment 3
74 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
75 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 8
76 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
77 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
78 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
79 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
80 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
81 #define elf_backend_default_execstack 0
82 
83 #define bfd_elf64_mkobject		      ppc64_elf_mkobject
84 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_type_lookup	      ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup
85 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_name_lookup	      ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup
86 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data  ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
87 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_print_private_bfd_data  ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data
88 #define bfd_elf64_new_section_hook	      ppc64_elf_new_section_hook
89 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_hash_table_create  ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create
90 #define bfd_elf64_get_synthetic_symtab	      ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
91 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_just_syms	      ppc64_elf_link_just_syms
92 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_gc_sections	      ppc64_elf_gc_sections
93 
94 #define elf_backend_object_p		      ppc64_elf_object_p
95 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus	      ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus
96 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo		      ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo
97 #define elf_backend_write_core_note	      ppc64_elf_write_core_note
98 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections   _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections
99 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol      ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
100 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook	      ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook
101 #define elf_backend_check_directives	      ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs
102 #define elf_backend_notice_as_needed	      ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed
103 #define elf_backend_archive_symbol_lookup     ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup
104 #define elf_backend_check_relocs	      ppc64_elf_check_relocs
105 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible	      _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
106 #define elf_backend_gc_keep		      ppc64_elf_gc_keep
107 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_dynamic_ref       ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref
108 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook	      ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook
109 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol     ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
110 #define elf_backend_hide_symbol		      ppc64_elf_hide_symbol
111 #define elf_backend_maybe_function_sym	      ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym
112 #define elf_backend_always_size_sections      ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust
113 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections     ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
114 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol		      ppc64_elf_hash_symbol
115 #define elf_backend_init_index_section	      _bfd_elf_init_2_index_sections
116 #define elf_backend_action_discarded	      ppc64_elf_action_discarded
117 #define elf_backend_relocate_section	      ppc64_elf_relocate_section
118 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol     ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
119 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class	      ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class
120 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections   ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
121 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook   ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook
122 #define elf_backend_special_sections	      ppc64_elf_special_sections
123 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol_attribute    ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute
124 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol	      ppc64_elf_merge_symbol
125 #define elf_backend_get_reloc_section	      bfd_get_section_by_name
126 
127 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
128    section.  */
129 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
130 
131 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
132 #define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 8)
133 #define LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 16 : 8)
134 
135 /* The initial size of the plt reserved for the dynamic linker.  */
136 #define PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 16)
137 
138 /* Offsets to some stack save slots.  */
139 #define STK_LR 16
140 #define STK_TOC(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 40 : 24)
141 /* This one is dodgy.  ELFv2 does not have a linker word, so use the
142    CR save slot.  Used only by optimised __tls_get_addr call stub,
143    relying on __tls_get_addr_opt not saving CR..  */
144 #define STK_LINKER(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 32 : 8)
145 
146 /* TOC base pointers offset from start of TOC.  */
147 #define TOC_BASE_OFF	0x8000
148 /* TOC base alignment.  */
149 #define TOC_BASE_ALIGN	256
150 
151 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block.  */
152 #define TP_OFFSET	0x7000
153 #define DTP_OFFSET	0x8000
154 
155 /* .plt call stub instructions.  The normal stub is like this, but
156    sometimes the .plt entry crosses a 64k boundary and we need to
157    insert an addi to adjust r11.  */
158 #define STD_R2_0R1	0xf8410000	/* std	 %r2,0+40(%r1)	     */
159 #define ADDIS_R11_R2	0x3d620000	/* addis %r11,%r2,xxx@ha     */
160 #define LD_R12_0R11	0xe98b0000	/* ld	 %r12,xxx+0@l(%r11)  */
161 #define MTCTR_R12	0x7d8903a6	/* mtctr %r12		     */
162 #define LD_R2_0R11	0xe84b0000	/* ld	 %r2,xxx+8@l(%r11)   */
163 #define LD_R11_0R11	0xe96b0000	/* ld	 %r11,xxx+16@l(%r11) */
164 #define BCTR		0x4e800420	/* bctr			     */
165 
166 #define ADDI_R11_R11	0x396b0000	/* addi %r11,%r11,off@l	 */
167 #define ADDI_R12_R11	0x398b0000	/* addi %r12,%r11,off@l	 */
168 #define ADDI_R12_R12	0x398c0000	/* addi %r12,%r12,off@l	 */
169 #define ADDIS_R2_R2	0x3c420000	/* addis %r2,%r2,off@ha	 */
170 #define ADDI_R2_R2	0x38420000	/* addi	 %r2,%r2,off@l	 */
171 
172 #define XOR_R2_R12_R12	0x7d826278	/* xor	 %r2,%r12,%r12	 */
173 #define ADD_R11_R11_R2	0x7d6b1214	/* add	 %r11,%r11,%r2	 */
174 #define XOR_R11_R12_R12	0x7d8b6278	/* xor	 %r11,%r12,%r12	 */
175 #define ADD_R2_R2_R11	0x7c425a14	/* add	 %r2,%r2,%r11	 */
176 #define CMPLDI_R2_0	0x28220000	/* cmpldi %r2,0		 */
177 #define BNECTR		0x4ca20420	/* bnectr+		 */
178 #define BNECTR_P4	0x4ce20420	/* bnectr+		 */
179 
180 #define LD_R12_0R2	0xe9820000	/* ld	 %r12,xxx+0(%r2) */
181 #define LD_R11_0R2	0xe9620000	/* ld	 %r11,xxx+0(%r2) */
182 #define LD_R2_0R2	0xe8420000	/* ld	 %r2,xxx+0(%r2)	 */
183 
184 #define LD_R2_0R1	0xe8410000	/* ld	 %r2,0(%r1)	 */
185 #define LD_R2_0R12	0xe84c0000	/* ld	 %r2,0(%r12)	 */
186 #define ADD_R2_R2_R12	0x7c426214	/* add	 %r2,%r2,%r12	 */
187 
188 #define LIS_R2		0x3c400000	/* lis %r2,xxx@ha	  */
189 #define LIS_R12		0x3d800000	/* lis %r12,xxx@ha	  */
190 #define ADDIS_R2_R12	0x3c4c0000	/* addis %r2,%r12,xxx@ha  */
191 #define ADDIS_R12_R2	0x3d820000	/* addis %r12,%r2,xxx@ha  */
192 #define ADDIS_R12_R11	0x3d8b0000	/* addis %r12,%r11,xxx@ha */
193 #define ADDIS_R12_R12	0x3d8c0000	/* addis %r12,%r12,xxx@ha */
194 #define ORIS_R12_R12_0	0x658c0000	/* oris  %r12,%r12,xxx@hi */
195 #define ORI_R12_R12_0	0x618c0000	/* ori   %r12,%r12,xxx@l  */
196 #define LD_R12_0R12	0xe98c0000	/* ld	 %r12,xxx@l(%r12) */
197 #define SLDI_R12_R12_32	0x799c07c6	/* sldi  %r12,%r12,32     */
198 #define LDX_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b602a	/* ldx   %r12,%r11,%r12   */
199 #define ADD_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b6214	/* add   %r12,%r11,%r12   */
200 
201 /* __glink_PLTresolve stub instructions.  We enter with the index in R0.  */
202 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE(htab)			\
203   (8u + (htab->opd_abi ? 11 * 4 : 14 * 4))
204 					/* 0:				*/
205 					/*  .quad plt0-1f		*/
206 					/* __glink:			*/
207 #define MFLR_R12	0x7d8802a6	/*  mflr %12			*/
208 #define BCL_20_31	0x429f0005	/*  bcl 20,31,1f		*/
209 					/* 1:				*/
210 #define MFLR_R11	0x7d6802a6	/*  mflr %11			*/
211 					/*  ld %2,(0b-1b)(%11)		*/
212 #define MTLR_R12	0x7d8803a6	/*  mtlr %12			*/
213 #define ADD_R11_R2_R11	0x7d625a14	/*  add %11,%2,%11		*/
214 					/*  ld %12,0(%11)		*/
215 					/*  ld %2,8(%11)		*/
216 					/*  mtctr %12			*/
217 					/*  ld %11,16(%11)		*/
218 					/*  bctr			*/
219 #define MFLR_R0		0x7c0802a6	/*  mflr %r0			*/
220 #define MTLR_R0		0x7c0803a6	/*  mtlr %r0			*/
221 #define SUB_R12_R12_R11	0x7d8b6050	/*  subf %r12,%r11,%r12		*/
222 #define ADDI_R0_R12	0x380c0000	/*  addi %r0,%r12,0		*/
223 #define SRDI_R0_R0_2	0x7800f082	/*  rldicl %r0,%r0,62,2		*/
224 
225 /* Pad with this.  */
226 #define NOP		0x60000000
227 
228 /* Some other nops.  */
229 #define CROR_151515	0x4def7b82
230 #define CROR_313131	0x4ffffb82
231 
232 /* .glink entries for the first 32k functions are two instructions.  */
233 #define LI_R0_0		0x38000000	/* li    %r0,0		*/
234 #define B_DOT		0x48000000	/* b     .		*/
235 
236 /* After that, we need two instructions to load the index, followed by
237    a branch.  */
238 #define LIS_R0_0	0x3c000000	/* lis   %r0,0		*/
239 #define ORI_R0_R0_0	0x60000000	/* ori	 %r0,%r0,0	*/
240 
241 /* Instructions used by the save and restore reg functions.  */
242 #define STD_R0_0R1	0xf8010000	/* std   %r0,0(%r1)	*/
243 #define STD_R0_0R12	0xf80c0000	/* std   %r0,0(%r12)	*/
244 #define LD_R0_0R1	0xe8010000	/* ld    %r0,0(%r1)	*/
245 #define LD_R0_0R12	0xe80c0000	/* ld    %r0,0(%r12)	*/
246 #define STFD_FR0_0R1	0xd8010000	/* stfd  %fr0,0(%r1)	*/
247 #define LFD_FR0_0R1	0xc8010000	/* lfd   %fr0,0(%r1)	*/
248 #define LI_R12_0	0x39800000	/* li    %r12,0		*/
249 #define STVX_VR0_R12_R0	0x7c0c01ce	/* stvx  %v0,%r12,%r0	*/
250 #define LVX_VR0_R12_R0	0x7c0c00ce	/* lvx   %v0,%r12,%r0	*/
251 #define MTLR_R0		0x7c0803a6	/* mtlr  %r0		*/
252 #define BLR		0x4e800020	/* blr			*/
253 
254 /* Since .opd is an array of descriptors and each entry will end up
255    with identical R_PPC64_RELATIVE relocs, there is really no need to
256    propagate .opd relocs;  The dynamic linker should be taught to
257    relocate .opd without reloc entries.  */
258 #ifndef NO_OPD_RELOCS
259 #define NO_OPD_RELOCS 0
260 #endif
261 
262 #ifndef ARRAY_SIZE
263 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
264 #endif
265 
266 static inline int
267 abiversion (bfd *abfd)
268 {
269   return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI;
270 }
271 
272 static inline void
273 set_abiversion (bfd *abfd, int ver)
274 {
275   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC64_ABI;
276   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= ver & EF_PPC64_ABI;
277 }
278 
279 /* Relocation HOWTO's.  */
280 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
281    field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
282    always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
283    PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
284    the LSB.  For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
285    and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
286    rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0.  */
287 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
288 	    complain, special_func)				\
289   HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0,	\
290 	 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func,		\
291 	 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
292 
293 static reloc_howto_type *ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) R_PPC64_max];
294 
295 static reloc_howto_type ppc64_elf_howto_raw[] =
296 {
297   /* This reloc does nothing.  */
298   HOW (R_PPC64_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
299        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
300 
301   /* A standard 32 bit relocation.  */
302   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
303        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
304 
305   /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
306      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
307   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
308        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
309 
310   /* A standard 16 bit relocation.  */
311   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
312        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
313 
314   /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow.  */
315   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
316        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
317 
318   /* Bits 16-31 of an address.  */
319   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
320        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
321 
322   /* Bits 16-31 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low 16
323      bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
324   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
325        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
326 
327   /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
328      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
329   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
330        ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
331 
332   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
333      indicate that the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two
334      bits must be zero.  */
335   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
336        ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
337 
338   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
339      indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower
340      two bits must be zero.  */
341   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
342        ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
343 
344   /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
345   HOW (R_PPC64_REL24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
346        ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
347 
348   /* A variant of R_PPC64_REL24, used when r2 is not the toc pointer.  */
349   HOW (R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
350        ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
351 
352   /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
353   HOW (R_PPC64_REL14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
354        ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
355 
356   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
357      the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must be
358      zero.  */
359   HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
360        ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
361 
362   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
363      the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must
364      be zero.  */
365   HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
366        ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
367 
368   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
369      symbol.  */
370   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372 
373   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
374      the symbol.  */
375   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
376        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
377 
378   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
379      the symbol.  */
380   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
381        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
382 
383   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
384      the symbol.  */
385   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
386        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
387 
388   /* This is used only by the dynamic linker.  The symbol should exist
389      both in the object being run and in some shared library.  The
390      dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
391      shared library into the object, because the object being
392      run has to have the data at some particular address.  */
393   HOW (R_PPC64_COPY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
394        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
395 
396   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR64, but used when setting global offset table
397      entries.  */
398   HOW (R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
399        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
400 
401   /* Created by the link editor.  Marks a procedure linkage table
402      entry for a symbol.  */
403   HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
404        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
405 
406   /* Used only by the dynamic linker.  When the object is run, this
407      doubleword64 is set to the load address of the object, plus the
408      addend.  */
409   HOW (R_PPC64_RELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
410        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
411 
412   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR32, but may be unaligned.  */
413   HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
414        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
415 
416   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but may be unaligned.  */
417   HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
418        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
419 
420   /* 32-bit PC relative.  */
421   HOW (R_PPC64_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
422        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
423 
424   /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.  */
425   HOW (R_PPC64_PLT32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
426        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
427 
428   /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
429      FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL32 not supported.  */
430   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
431        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
432 
433   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
434      the symbol.  */
435   HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
436        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437 
438   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
439      the symbol.  */
440   HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
441        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
442 
443   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
444      the symbol.  */
445   HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
446        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
447 
448   /* 16-bit section relative relocation.  */
449   HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
450        ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
451 
452   /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but no overflow warning.  */
453   HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
454        ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
455 
456   /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation.  */
457   HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
458        ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
459 
460   /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation.  */
461   HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
462        ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc),
463 
464   /* Like R_PPC64_REL24 without touching the two least significant bits.  */
465   HOW (R_PPC64_REL30, 2, 30, 0xfffffffc, 2, TRUE, dont,
466        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
467 
468   /* Relocs in the 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI, not in the 32-bit ABI.  */
469 
470   /* A standard 64-bit relocation.  */
471   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
472        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
473 
474   /* The bits 32-47 of an address.  */
475   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
476        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
477 
478   /* The bits 32-47 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
479      16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
480   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
481        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
482 
483   /* The bits 48-63 of an address.  */
484   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
485        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
486 
487   /* The bits 48-63 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
488      16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
489   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
490        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
491 
492   /* Like ADDR64, but may be unaligned.  */
493   HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
494        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
495 
496   /* 64-bit relative relocation.  */
497   HOW (R_PPC64_REL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
498        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
499 
500   /* 64-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.  */
501   HOW (R_PPC64_PLT64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
502        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
503 
504   /* 64-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage
505      table.  */
506   /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL64 not supported.  */
507   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
508        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
509 
510   /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation.  */
511   /* R_PPC64_TOC16	  47	   half16*	S + A - .TOC.  */
512   HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
513        ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
514 
515   /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation without overflow.  */
516   /* R_PPC64_TOC16_LO	  48	   half16	 #lo (S + A - .TOC.)  */
517   HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
518        ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
519 
520   /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits.  */
521   /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HI	  49	   half16	 #hi (S + A - .TOC.)  */
522   HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
523        ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
524 
525   /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits, plus 1 if the
526      contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is
527      negative.  */
528   /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HA	  50	   half16	 #ha (S + A - .TOC.)  */
529   HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
530        ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc),
531 
532   /* 64-bit relocation; insert value of TOC base (.TOC.).  */
533   /* R_PPC64_TOC		  51	   doubleword64	 .TOC.  */
534   HOW (R_PPC64_TOC, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
535        ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc),
536 
537   /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but also informs the link editor that the
538      value to relocate may (!) refer to a PLT entry which the link
539      editor (a) may replace with the symbol value.  If the link editor
540      is unable to fully resolve the symbol, it may (b) create a PLT
541      entry and store the address to the new PLT entry in the GOT.
542      This permits lazy resolution of function symbols at run time.
543      The link editor may also skip all of this and just (c) emit a
544      R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT to tie the symbol to the GOT entry.  */
545   /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16 not implemented.  */
546     HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE,signed,
547 	  ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
548 
549   /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but without overflow.  */
550   /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented.  */
551   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
552        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
553 
554   /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address.  */
555   /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI not implemented.  */
556   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
557        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
558 
559   /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address, plus
560      1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
561      is negative.  */
562   /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA not implemented.  */
563   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
564        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
565 
566   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
567   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
568        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
569 
570   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
571   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
572        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
573 
574   /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
575   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
576        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
577 
578   /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
579   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
580        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
581 
582   /* Like R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
583   HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
584        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
585 
586   /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
587   HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
588        ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
589 
590   /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
591   HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
592        ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
593 
594   /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
595   HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
596        ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
597 
598   /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
599   HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
600        ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
601 
602   /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
603   /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS not implemented.  */
604   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
605        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
606 
607   /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field.  */
608   /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented.  */
609   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
610        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
611 
612   /* Marker relocs for TLS.  */
613   HOW (R_PPC64_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
614        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
615 
616   HOW (R_PPC64_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
617        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
618 
619   HOW (R_PPC64_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
620        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
621 
622   /* Marker reloc for optimizing r2 save in prologue rather than on
623      each plt call stub.  */
624   HOW (R_PPC64_TOCSAVE, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
625        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
626 
627   /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions.  */
628   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
629        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
630 
631   HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
632        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
633 
634   /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
635      definition of its TLS sym.  */
636   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPMOD64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
637        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638 
639   /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
640      of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
641      contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000.  */
642   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
643        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
644 
645   /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc.  */
646   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
647        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
648 
649   /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
650   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
651        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
652 
653   /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
654   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
655        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
656 
657   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
658   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
659        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
660 
661   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
662   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
663        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
664 
665   /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
666   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
667        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
668 
669   /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
670   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
671        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
672 
673   /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
674   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
675        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
676 
677   /* Like DTPREL16, but for insns with a DS field.  */
678   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
679        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
680 
681   /* Like DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow.  */
682   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
683        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
684 
685   /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
686      sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13).  */
687   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
688        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
689 
690   /* A 16 bit tprel reloc.  */
691   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
692        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
693 
694   /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
695   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
696        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
697 
698   /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
699   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
700        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
701 
702   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
703   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
704        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
705 
706   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
707   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
708        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
709 
710   /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
711   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
712        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
713 
714   /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
715   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
716        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
717 
718   /* Like TPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
719   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
720        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
721 
722   /* Like TPREL16, but for insns with a DS field.  */
723   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
724        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
725 
726   /* Like TPREL16_DS, but no overflow.  */
727   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
728        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
729 
730   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
731      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
732      to the first entry relative to the TOC base (r2).  */
733   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
734        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
735 
736   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow.  */
737   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
738        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
739 
740   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
741   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
742        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
743 
744   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
745   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
746        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
747 
748   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
749      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
750      first entry relative to the TOC base (r2).  */
751   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
752        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
753 
754   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow.  */
755   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
756        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
757 
758   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
759   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
760        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
761 
762   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
763   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
764        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
765 
766   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
767      the offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2).  */
768   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
769        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
770 
771   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow.  */
772   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
773        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
774 
775   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
776   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
777        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
778 
779   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
780   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
781        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
782 
783   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
784      offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2).  */
785   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
786        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
787 
788   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_DS, but no overflow.  */
789   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
790        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
791 
792   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
793   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
794        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
795 
796   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
797   HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
798        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
799 
800   HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_IREL, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
801        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
802 
803   HOW (R_PPC64_IRELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
804        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
805 
806   /* A 16 bit relative relocation.  */
807   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
808        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
809 
810   /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow.  */
811   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
812        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
813 
814   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address.  */
815   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
816        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
817 
818   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
819      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
820   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
821        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
822 
823   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
824        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
825 
826   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
827        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
828 
829   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
830        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
831 
832   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
833        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
834 
835   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
836        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
837 
838   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
839        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
840 
841   /* Like R_PPC64_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis.  */
842   HOW (R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
843        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
844 
845   /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only).  */
846   HOW (R_PPC64_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
847        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
848 
849   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but no overflow.  */
850   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
851        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
852 
853   /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but no overflow.  */
854   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
855        ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
856 
857   /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, but no overflow.  */
858   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
859        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
860 
861   /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, but no overflow.  */
862   HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
863        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
864 
865   /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, but no overflow.  */
866   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
867        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
868 
869   /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, but no overflow.  */
870   HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
871        ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
872 
873   /* Marker reloc on ELFv2 large-model function entry.  */
874   HOW (R_PPC64_ENTRY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
875        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
876 
877   /* Like ADDR64, but use local entry point of function.  */
878   HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
879        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
880 
881   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
882   HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
883        NULL),
884 
885   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
886   HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
887        NULL),
888 };
889 
890 
891 /* Initialize the ppc64_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can
892    be done.  */
893 
894 static void
895 ppc_howto_init (void)
896 {
897   unsigned int i, type;
898 
899   for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
900     {
901       type = ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
902       BFD_ASSERT (type < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table));
903       ppc64_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
904     }
905 }
906 
907 static reloc_howto_type *
908 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd,
909 			     bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
910 {
911   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r = R_PPC64_NONE;
912 
913   if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
914     /* Initialize howto table if needed.  */
915     ppc_howto_init ();
916 
917   switch (code)
918     {
919     default:
920       /* xgettext:c-format */
921       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), abfd,
922 			  (int) code);
923       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
924       return NULL;
925 
926     case BFD_RELOC_NONE:			r = R_PPC64_NONE;
927       break;
928     case BFD_RELOC_32:				r = R_PPC64_ADDR32;
929       break;
930     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26:			r = R_PPC64_ADDR24;
931       break;
932     case BFD_RELOC_16:				r = R_PPC64_ADDR16;
933       break;
934     case BFD_RELOC_LO16:			r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO;
935       break;
936     case BFD_RELOC_HI16:			r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI;
937       break;
938     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH;
939       break;
940     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S:			r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
941       break;
942     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA;
943       break;
944     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16:			r = R_PPC64_ADDR14;
945       break;
946     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;
947       break;
948     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;
949       break;
950     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26:			r = R_PPC64_REL24;
951       break;
952     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:		r = R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
953       break;
954     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16:			r = R_PPC64_REL14;
955       break;
956     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN:		r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN;
957       break;
958     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN:		r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN;
959       break;
960     case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF:			r = R_PPC64_GOT16;
961       break;
962     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF:			r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO;
963       break;
964     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF:			r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HI;
965       break;
966     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HA;
967       break;
968     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY:			r = R_PPC64_COPY;
969       break;
970     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT:		r = R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT;
971       break;
972     case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:			r = R_PPC64_REL32;
973       break;
974     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF:			r = R_PPC64_PLT32;
975       break;
976     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL:		r = R_PPC64_PLTREL32;
977       break;
978     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF:			r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO;
979       break;
980     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF:			r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HI;
981       break;
982     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HA;
983       break;
984     case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL:			r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF;
985       break;
986     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO;
987       break;
988     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI;
989       break;
990     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA;
991       break;
992     case BFD_RELOC_CTOR:			r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
993       break;
994     case BFD_RELOC_64:				r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
995       break;
996     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER;
997       break;
998     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER_S:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA;
999       break;
1000     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST;
1001       break;
1002     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST_S:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA;
1003       break;
1004     case BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL:			r = R_PPC64_REL64;
1005       break;
1006     case BFD_RELOC_64_PLTOFF:			r = R_PPC64_PLT64;
1007       break;
1008     case BFD_RELOC_64_PLT_PCREL:		r = R_PPC64_PLTREL64;
1009       break;
1010     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16:			r = R_PPC64_TOC16;
1011       break;
1012     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
1013       break;
1014     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HI;
1015       break;
1016     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
1017       break;
1018     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC:			r = R_PPC64_TOC;
1019       break;
1020     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16:		r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16;
1021       break;
1022     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO;
1023       break;
1024     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI;
1025       break;
1026     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA;
1027       break;
1028     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS;
1029       break;
1030     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS;
1031       break;
1032     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:		r = R_PPC64_GOT16_DS;
1033       break;
1034     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:		r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS;
1035       break;
1036     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:		r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS;
1037       break;
1038     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:		r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS;
1039       break;
1040     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:		r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS;
1041       break;
1042     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:		r = R_PPC64_TOC16_DS;
1043       break;
1044     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:		r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS;
1045       break;
1046     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:		r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS;
1047       break;
1048     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:	r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS;
1049       break;
1050     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS:			r = R_PPC64_TLS;
1051       break;
1052     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD:			r = R_PPC64_TLSGD;
1053       break;
1054     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD:			r = R_PPC64_TLSLD;
1055       break;
1056     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD:			r = R_PPC64_DTPMOD64;
1057       break;
1058     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16:			r = R_PPC64_TPREL16;
1059       break;
1060     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
1061       break;
1062     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI;
1063       break;
1064     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:		r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH;
1065       break;
1066     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
1067       break;
1068     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:		r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA;
1069       break;
1070     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL:			r = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
1071       break;
1072     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16:		r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16;
1073       break;
1074     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO;
1075       break;
1076     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI;
1077       break;
1078     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:		r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH;
1079       break;
1080     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA;
1081       break;
1082     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:	r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA;
1083       break;
1084     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL:			r = R_PPC64_DTPREL64;
1085       break;
1086     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16;
1087       break;
1088     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;
1089       break;
1090     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;
1091       break;
1092     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;
1093       break;
1094     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16;
1095       break;
1096     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;
1097       break;
1098     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;
1099       break;
1100     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;
1101       break;
1102     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS;
1103       break;
1104     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1105       break;
1106     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI;
1107       break;
1108     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA;
1109       break;
1110     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS;
1111       break;
1112     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1113       break;
1114     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;
1115       break;
1116     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:		r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;
1117       break;
1118     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:		r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS;
1119       break;
1120     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:		r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1121       break;
1122     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:	r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER;
1123       break;
1124     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:	r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA;
1125       break;
1126     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:	r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST;
1127       break;
1128     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:	r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1129       break;
1130     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:		r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS;
1131       break;
1132     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:	r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1133       break;
1134     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:	r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER;
1135       break;
1136     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:	r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA;
1137       break;
1138     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:	r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST;
1139       break;
1140     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:	r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1141       break;
1142     case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL:			r = R_PPC64_REL16;
1143       break;
1144     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL:			r = R_PPC64_REL16_LO;
1145       break;
1146     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL:			r = R_PPC64_REL16_HI;
1147       break;
1148     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL:		r = R_PPC64_REL16_HA;
1149       break;
1150     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:		r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH;
1151       break;
1152     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:		r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA;
1153       break;
1154     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:		r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER;
1155       break;
1156     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:		r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA;
1157       break;
1158     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:		r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST;
1159       break;
1160     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:	r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA;
1161       break;
1162     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA:			r = R_PPC64_16DX_HA;
1163       break;
1164     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA:		r = R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA;
1165       break;
1166     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ENTRY:			r = R_PPC64_ENTRY;
1167       break;
1168     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:		r = R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL;
1169       break;
1170     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:		r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT;
1171       break;
1172     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:		r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY;
1173       break;
1174     }
1175 
1176   return ppc64_elf_howto_table[r];
1177 };
1178 
1179 static reloc_howto_type *
1180 ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1181 			     const char *r_name)
1182 {
1183   unsigned int i;
1184 
1185   for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
1186     if (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
1187 	&& strcasecmp (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
1188       return &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
1189 
1190   return NULL;
1191 }
1192 
1193 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc.  */
1194 
1195 static bfd_boolean
1196 ppc64_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd, arelent *cache_ptr,
1197 			 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
1198 {
1199   unsigned int type;
1200 
1201   /* Initialize howto table if needed.  */
1202   if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1203     ppc_howto_init ();
1204 
1205   type = ELF64_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
1206   if (type >= ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table))
1207     {
1208       /* xgettext:c-format */
1209       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1210 			  abfd, type);
1211       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1212       return FALSE;
1213     }
1214   cache_ptr->howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[type];
1215   if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL || cache_ptr->howto->name == NULL)
1216     {
1217       /* xgettext:c-format */
1218       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1219 			  abfd, type);
1220       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1221       return FALSE;
1222     }
1223 
1224   return TRUE;
1225 }
1226 
1227 /* Handle the R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA and similar relocs.  */
1228 
1229 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1230 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1231 		    void *data, asection *input_section,
1232 		    bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1233 {
1234   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1235   long insn;
1236   bfd_size_type octets;
1237   bfd_vma value;
1238 
1239   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1240      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1241      link time.  */
1242   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1243     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1244 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1245 
1246   /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits.
1247      We won't actually be using the low 16 bits, so trashing them
1248      doesn't matter.  */
1249   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1250   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1251   if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA)
1252     return bfd_reloc_continue;
1253 
1254   value = 0;
1255   if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1256     value = symbol->value;
1257   value += (reloc_entry->addend
1258 	    + symbol->section->output_offset
1259 	    + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
1260   value -= (reloc_entry->address
1261 	    + input_section->output_offset
1262 	    + input_section->output_section->vma);
1263   value = (bfd_signed_vma) value >> 16;
1264 
1265   octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
1266   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1267   insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
1268   insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
1269   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1270   if (value + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
1271     return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1272   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1273 }
1274 
1275 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1276 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1277 			void *data, asection *input_section,
1278 			bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1279 {
1280   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1281     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1282 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1283 
1284   if (strcmp (symbol->section->name, ".opd") == 0
1285       && (symbol->section->owner->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0)
1286     {
1287       bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (symbol->section,
1288 				      symbol->value + reloc_entry->addend,
1289 				      NULL, NULL, FALSE);
1290       if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
1291 	reloc_entry->addend = dest - (symbol->value
1292 				      + symbol->section->output_section->vma
1293 				      + symbol->section->output_offset);
1294     }
1295   else
1296     {
1297       elf_symbol_type *elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symbol;
1298 
1299       if (symbol->section->owner != abfd
1300 	  && symbol->section->owner != NULL
1301 	  && abiversion (symbol->section->owner) >= 2)
1302 	{
1303 	  unsigned int i;
1304 
1305 	  for (i = 0; i < symbol->section->owner->symcount; ++i)
1306 	    {
1307 	      asymbol *symdef = symbol->section->owner->outsymbols[i];
1308 
1309 	      if (strcmp (symdef->name, symbol->name) == 0)
1310 		{
1311 		  elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symdef;
1312 		  break;
1313 		}
1314 	    }
1315 	}
1316       reloc_entry->addend
1317 	+= PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
1318     }
1319   return bfd_reloc_continue;
1320 }
1321 
1322 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1323 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1324 			 void *data, asection *input_section,
1325 			 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1326 {
1327   long insn;
1328   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1329   bfd_size_type octets;
1330   /* Assume 'at' branch hints.  */
1331   bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
1332 
1333   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1334      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1335      link time.  */
1336   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1337     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1338 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1339 
1340   octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
1341   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1342   insn &= ~(0x01 << 21);
1343   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1344   if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
1345       || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN)
1346     insn |= 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field.  */
1347 
1348   if (is_isa_v2)
1349     {
1350       /* Set 'a' bit.  This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
1351 	 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
1352 	 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t).  */
1353       if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
1354 	insn |= 0x02 << 21;
1355       else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
1356 	insn |= 0x08 << 21;
1357       else
1358 	goto out;
1359     }
1360   else
1361     {
1362       bfd_vma target = 0;
1363       bfd_vma from;
1364 
1365       if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1366 	target = symbol->value;
1367       target += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1368       target += symbol->section->output_offset;
1369       target += reloc_entry->addend;
1370 
1371       from = (reloc_entry->address
1372 	      + input_section->output_offset
1373 	      + input_section->output_section->vma);
1374 
1375       /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
1376       if ((bfd_signed_vma) (target - from) < 0)
1377 	insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
1378     }
1379   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1380  out:
1381   return ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1382 				 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1383 }
1384 
1385 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1386 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1387 			 void *data, asection *input_section,
1388 			 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1389 {
1390   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1391      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1392      link time.  */
1393   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1394     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1395 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1396 
1397   /* Subtract the symbol section base address.  */
1398   reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1399   return bfd_reloc_continue;
1400 }
1401 
1402 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1403 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1404 			    void *data, asection *input_section,
1405 			    bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1406 {
1407   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1408      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1409      link time.  */
1410   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1411     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1412 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1413 
1414   /* Subtract the symbol section base address.  */
1415   reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1416 
1417   /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits.  */
1418   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1419   return bfd_reloc_continue;
1420 }
1421 
1422 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1423 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1424 		     void *data, asection *input_section,
1425 		     bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1426 {
1427   bfd_vma TOCstart;
1428 
1429   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1430      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1431      link time.  */
1432   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1433     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1434 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1435 
1436   TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1437   if (TOCstart == 0)
1438     TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1439 
1440   /* Subtract the TOC base address.  */
1441   reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1442   return bfd_reloc_continue;
1443 }
1444 
1445 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1446 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1447 			void *data, asection *input_section,
1448 			bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1449 {
1450   bfd_vma TOCstart;
1451 
1452   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1453      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1454      link time.  */
1455   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1456     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1457 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1458 
1459   TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1460   if (TOCstart == 0)
1461     TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1462 
1463   /* Subtract the TOC base address.  */
1464   reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1465 
1466   /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits.  */
1467   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1468   return bfd_reloc_continue;
1469 }
1470 
1471 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1472 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1473 		       void *data, asection *input_section,
1474 		       bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1475 {
1476   bfd_vma TOCstart;
1477   bfd_size_type octets;
1478 
1479   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1480      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1481      link time.  */
1482   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1483     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1484 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1485 
1486   TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1487   if (TOCstart == 0)
1488     TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1489 
1490   octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
1491   bfd_put_64 (abfd, TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1492   return bfd_reloc_ok;
1493 }
1494 
1495 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1496 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1497 			   void *data, asection *input_section,
1498 			   bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1499 {
1500   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1501      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
1502      link time.  */
1503   if (output_bfd != NULL)
1504     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1505 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1506 
1507   if (error_message != NULL)
1508     {
1509       static char buf[60];
1510       sprintf (buf, "generic linker can't handle %s",
1511 	       reloc_entry->howto->name);
1512       *error_message = buf;
1513     }
1514   return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1515 }
1516 
1517 /* Track GOT entries needed for a given symbol.  We might need more
1518    than one got entry per symbol.  */
1519 struct got_entry
1520 {
1521   struct got_entry *next;
1522 
1523   /* The symbol addend that we'll be placing in the GOT.  */
1524   bfd_vma addend;
1525 
1526   /* Unlike other ELF targets, we use separate GOT entries for the same
1527      symbol referenced from different input files.  This is to support
1528      automatic multiple TOC/GOT sections, where the TOC base can vary
1529      from one input file to another.  After partitioning into TOC groups
1530      we merge entries within the group.
1531 
1532      Point to the BFD owning this GOT entry.  */
1533   bfd *owner;
1534 
1535   /* Zero for non-tls entries, or TLS_TLS and one of TLS_GD, TLS_LD,
1536      TLS_TPREL or TLS_DTPREL for tls entries.  */
1537   unsigned char tls_type;
1538 
1539   /* Non-zero if got.ent points to real entry.  */
1540   unsigned char is_indirect;
1541 
1542   /* Reference count until size_dynamic_sections, GOT offset thereafter.  */
1543   union
1544   {
1545     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1546     bfd_vma offset;
1547     struct got_entry *ent;
1548   } got;
1549 };
1550 
1551 /* The same for PLT.  */
1552 struct plt_entry
1553 {
1554   struct plt_entry *next;
1555 
1556   bfd_vma addend;
1557 
1558   union
1559   {
1560     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1561     bfd_vma offset;
1562   } plt;
1563 };
1564 
1565 struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata
1566 {
1567   struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1568 
1569   /* Shortcuts to dynamic linker sections.  */
1570   asection *got;
1571   asection *relgot;
1572 
1573   /* Used during garbage collection.  We attach global symbols defined
1574      on removed .opd entries to this section so that the sym is removed.  */
1575   asection *deleted_section;
1576 
1577   /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling.  Support for multiple GOT
1578      sections means we potentially need one of these for each input bfd.  */
1579   struct got_entry tlsld_got;
1580 
1581   union
1582   {
1583     /* A copy of relocs before they are modified for --emit-relocs.  */
1584     Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
1585 
1586     /* Section contents.  */
1587     bfd_byte *contents;
1588   } opd;
1589 
1590   /* Nonzero if this bfd has small toc/got relocs, ie. that expect
1591      the reloc to be in the range -32768 to 32767.  */
1592   unsigned int has_small_toc_reloc : 1;
1593 
1594   /* Set if toc/got ha relocs detected not using r2, or lo reloc
1595      instruction not one we handle.  */
1596   unsigned int unexpected_toc_insn : 1;
1597 };
1598 
1599 #define ppc64_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1600   ((struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1601 
1602 #define ppc64_tlsld_got(bfd) \
1603   (&ppc64_elf_tdata (bfd)->tlsld_got)
1604 
1605 #define is_ppc64_elf(bfd) \
1606   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1607    && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC64_ELF_DATA)
1608 
1609 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras.  */
1610 
1611 static bfd_boolean
1612 ppc64_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1613 {
1614   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata),
1615 				  PPC64_ELF_DATA);
1616 }
1617 
1618 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 64 bit input bfd when the
1619    default is 32 bit.  Also select arch based on apuinfo.  */
1620 
1621 static bfd_boolean
1622 ppc64_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1623 {
1624   if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1625     return TRUE;
1626 
1627   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32)
1628     {
1629       Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1630 
1631       if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
1632 	{
1633 	  /* Relies on arch after 32 bit default being 64 bit default.  */
1634 	  abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1635 	  BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64);
1636 	}
1637     }
1638   return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1639 }
1640 
1641 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
1642 
1643 static bfd_boolean
1644 ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1645 {
1646   size_t offset, size;
1647 
1648   if (note->descsz != 504)
1649     return FALSE;
1650 
1651   /* pr_cursig */
1652   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1653 
1654   /* pr_pid */
1655   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 32);
1656 
1657   /* pr_reg */
1658   offset = 112;
1659   size = 384;
1660 
1661   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
1662   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1663 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
1664 }
1665 
1666 static bfd_boolean
1667 ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1668 {
1669   if (note->descsz != 136)
1670     return FALSE;
1671 
1672   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1673     = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1674   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1675     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 40, 16);
1676   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1677     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 56, 80);
1678 
1679   return TRUE;
1680 }
1681 
1682 static char *
1683 ppc64_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type,
1684 			   ...)
1685 {
1686   switch (note_type)
1687     {
1688     default:
1689       return NULL;
1690 
1691     case NT_PRPSINFO:
1692       {
1693 	char data[136] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1694 	va_list ap;
1695 
1696 	va_start (ap, note_type);
1697 	memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1698 	strncpy (data + 40, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1699 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1700 	DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1701 	/* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1702 	   -Wstringop-truncation:
1703 	   https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1704 	 */
1705 	DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1706 #endif
1707 	strncpy (data + 56, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1708 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1709 	DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1710 #endif
1711 	va_end (ap);
1712 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1713 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1714       }
1715 
1716     case NT_PRSTATUS:
1717       {
1718 	char data[504];
1719 	va_list ap;
1720 	long pid;
1721 	int cursig;
1722 	const void *greg;
1723 
1724 	va_start (ap, note_type);
1725 	memset (data, 0, 112);
1726 	pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1727 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 32);
1728 	cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1729 	bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1730 	greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1731 	memcpy (data + 112, greg, 384);
1732 	memset (data + 496, 0, 8);
1733 	va_end (ap);
1734 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1735 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1736       }
1737     }
1738 }
1739 
1740 /* Add extra PPC sections.  */
1741 
1742 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc64_elf_special_sections[] =
1743 {
1744   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),	  0, SHT_NOBITS,   0 },
1745   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"),	 -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1746   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1747   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc"),	  0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1748   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc1"),	  0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1749   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tocbss"), 0, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1750   { NULL,		      0,  0, 0,		   0 }
1751 };
1752 
1753 enum _ppc64_sec_type {
1754   sec_normal = 0,
1755   sec_opd = 1,
1756   sec_toc = 2
1757 };
1758 
1759 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data
1760 {
1761   struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
1762 
1763   union
1764   {
1765     /* An array with one entry for each opd function descriptor,
1766        and some spares since opd entries may be either 16 or 24 bytes.  */
1767 #define OPD_NDX(OFF) ((OFF) >> 4)
1768     struct _opd_sec_data
1769     {
1770       /* Points to the function code section for local opd entries.  */
1771       asection **func_sec;
1772 
1773       /* After editing .opd, adjust references to opd local syms.  */
1774       long *adjust;
1775     } opd;
1776 
1777     /* An array for toc sections, indexed by offset/8.  */
1778     struct _toc_sec_data
1779     {
1780       /* Specifies the relocation symbol index used at a given toc offset.  */
1781       unsigned *symndx;
1782 
1783       /* And the relocation addend.  */
1784       bfd_vma *add;
1785     } toc;
1786   } u;
1787 
1788   enum _ppc64_sec_type sec_type:2;
1789 
1790   /* Flag set when small branches are detected.  Used to
1791      select suitable defaults for the stub group size.  */
1792   unsigned int has_14bit_branch:1;
1793 
1794   /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected.  */
1795   unsigned int has_pltcall:1;
1796 };
1797 
1798 #define ppc64_elf_section_data(sec) \
1799   ((struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
1800 
1801 static bfd_boolean
1802 ppc64_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1803 {
1804   if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
1805     {
1806       struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *sdata;
1807       bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
1808 
1809       sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1810       if (sdata == NULL)
1811 	return FALSE;
1812       sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
1813     }
1814 
1815   return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
1816 }
1817 
1818 static struct _opd_sec_data *
1819 get_opd_info (asection * sec)
1820 {
1821   if (sec != NULL
1822       && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) != NULL
1823       && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd)
1824     return &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
1825   return NULL;
1826 }
1827 
1828 /* Parameters for the qsort hook.  */
1829 static bfd_boolean synthetic_relocatable;
1830 static asection *synthetic_opd;
1831 
1832 /* qsort comparison function for ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab.  */
1833 
1834 static int
1835 compare_symbols (const void *ap, const void *bp)
1836 {
1837   const asymbol *a = *(const asymbol **) ap;
1838   const asymbol *b = *(const asymbol **) bp;
1839 
1840   /* Section symbols first.  */
1841   if ((a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && !(b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
1842     return -1;
1843   if (!(a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && (b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
1844     return 1;
1845 
1846   /* then .opd symbols.  */
1847   if (synthetic_opd != NULL)
1848     {
1849       if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") == 0
1850 	  && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
1851 	return -1;
1852       if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") != 0
1853 	  && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
1854 	return 1;
1855     }
1856 
1857   /* then other code symbols.  */
1858   if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
1859        == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
1860       && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
1861 	  != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
1862     return -1;
1863 
1864   if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
1865        != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
1866       && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
1867 	  == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
1868     return 1;
1869 
1870   if (synthetic_relocatable)
1871     {
1872       if (a->section->id < b->section->id)
1873 	return -1;
1874 
1875       if (a->section->id > b->section->id)
1876 	return 1;
1877     }
1878 
1879   if (a->value + a->section->vma < b->value + b->section->vma)
1880     return -1;
1881 
1882   if (a->value + a->section->vma > b->value + b->section->vma)
1883     return 1;
1884 
1885   /* For syms with the same value, prefer strong dynamic global function
1886      syms over other syms.  */
1887   if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0)
1888     return -1;
1889 
1890   if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0)
1891     return 1;
1892 
1893   if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0)
1894     return -1;
1895 
1896   if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
1897     return 1;
1898 
1899   if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0)
1900     return -1;
1901 
1902   if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0)
1903     return 1;
1904 
1905   if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0)
1906     return -1;
1907 
1908   if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
1909     return 1;
1910 
1911   return a > b;
1912 }
1913 
1914 /* Search SYMS for a symbol of the given VALUE.  */
1915 
1916 static asymbol *
1917 sym_exists_at (asymbol **syms, long lo, long hi, unsigned int id, bfd_vma value)
1918 {
1919   long mid;
1920 
1921   if (id == (unsigned) -1)
1922     {
1923       while (lo < hi)
1924 	{
1925 	  mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
1926 	  if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma < value)
1927 	    lo = mid + 1;
1928 	  else if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma > value)
1929 	    hi = mid;
1930 	  else
1931 	    return syms[mid];
1932 	}
1933     }
1934   else
1935     {
1936       while (lo < hi)
1937 	{
1938 	  mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
1939 	  if (syms[mid]->section->id < id)
1940 	    lo = mid + 1;
1941 	  else if (syms[mid]->section->id > id)
1942 	    hi = mid;
1943 	  else if (syms[mid]->value < value)
1944 	    lo = mid + 1;
1945 	  else if (syms[mid]->value > value)
1946 	    hi = mid;
1947 	  else
1948 	    return syms[mid];
1949 	}
1950     }
1951   return NULL;
1952 }
1953 
1954 static bfd_boolean
1955 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1956 {
1957   bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1958   return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1959 	  && section->vma <= vma
1960 	  && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1961 }
1962 
1963 /* Create synthetic symbols, effectively restoring "dot-symbol" function
1964    entry syms.  Also generate @plt symbols for the glink branch table.
1965    Returns count of synthetic symbols in RET or -1 on error.  */
1966 
1967 static long
1968 ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
1969 				long static_count, asymbol **static_syms,
1970 				long dyn_count, asymbol **dyn_syms,
1971 				asymbol **ret)
1972 {
1973   asymbol *s;
1974   size_t i, j, count;
1975   char *names;
1976   size_t symcount, codesecsym, codesecsymend, secsymend, opdsymend;
1977   asection *opd = NULL;
1978   bfd_boolean relocatable = (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0;
1979   asymbol **syms;
1980   int abi = abiversion (abfd);
1981 
1982   *ret = NULL;
1983 
1984   if (abi < 2)
1985     {
1986       opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".opd");
1987       if (opd == NULL && abi == 1)
1988 	return 0;
1989     }
1990 
1991   syms = NULL;
1992   codesecsym = 0;
1993   codesecsymend = 0;
1994   secsymend = 0;
1995   opdsymend = 0;
1996   symcount = 0;
1997   if (opd != NULL)
1998     {
1999       symcount = static_count;
2000       if (!relocatable)
2001 	symcount += dyn_count;
2002       if (symcount == 0)
2003 	return 0;
2004 
2005       syms = bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2006       if (syms == NULL)
2007 	return -1;
2008 
2009       if (!relocatable && static_count != 0 && dyn_count != 0)
2010 	{
2011 	  /* Use both symbol tables.  */
2012 	  memcpy (syms, static_syms, static_count * sizeof (*syms));
2013 	  memcpy (syms + static_count, dyn_syms,
2014 		  (dyn_count + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2015 	}
2016       else if (!relocatable && static_count == 0)
2017 	memcpy (syms, dyn_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2018       else
2019 	memcpy (syms, static_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2020 
2021       /* Trim uninteresting symbols.  Interesting symbols are section,
2022 	 function, and notype symbols.  */
2023       for (i = 0, j = 0; i < symcount; ++i)
2024 	if ((syms[i]->flags & (BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
2025 			       | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) == 0)
2026 	  syms[j++] = syms[i];
2027       symcount = j;
2028 
2029       synthetic_relocatable = relocatable;
2030       synthetic_opd = opd;
2031       qsort (syms, symcount, sizeof (*syms), compare_symbols);
2032 
2033       if (!relocatable && symcount > 1)
2034 	{
2035 	  /* Trim duplicate syms, since we may have merged the normal
2036 	     and dynamic symbols.  Actually, we only care about syms
2037 	     that have different values, so trim any with the same
2038 	     value.  Don't consider ifunc and ifunc resolver symbols
2039 	     duplicates however, because GDB wants to know whether a
2040 	     text symbol is an ifunc resolver.  */
2041 	  for (i = 1, j = 1; i < symcount; ++i)
2042 	    {
2043 	      const asymbol *s0 = syms[i - 1];
2044 	      const asymbol *s1 = syms[i];
2045 
2046 	      if ((s0->value + s0->section->vma
2047 		   != s1->value + s1->section->vma)
2048 		  || ((s0->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)
2049 		      != (s1->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)))
2050 		syms[j++] = syms[i];
2051 	    }
2052 	  symcount = j;
2053 	}
2054 
2055       i = 0;
2056       /* Note that here and in compare_symbols we can't compare opd and
2057 	 sym->section directly.  With separate debug info files, the
2058 	 symbols will be extracted from the debug file while abfd passed
2059 	 to this function is the real binary.  */
2060       if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2061 	++i;
2062       codesecsym = i;
2063 
2064       for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2065 	if (((syms[i]->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC
2066 					 | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2067 	     != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2068 	    || (syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2069 	  break;
2070       codesecsymend = i;
2071 
2072       for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2073 	if ((syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2074 	  break;
2075       secsymend = i;
2076 
2077       for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2078 	if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2079 	  break;
2080       opdsymend = i;
2081 
2082       for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2083 	if (((syms[i]->section->flags
2084 	      & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
2085 	    != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2086 	  break;
2087       symcount = i;
2088     }
2089   count = 0;
2090 
2091   if (relocatable)
2092     {
2093       bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2094       arelent *r;
2095       size_t size;
2096       size_t relcount;
2097 
2098       if (opdsymend == secsymend)
2099 	goto done;
2100 
2101       slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2102       relcount = (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) ? opd->reloc_count : 0;
2103       if (relcount == 0)
2104 	goto done;
2105 
2106       if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, opd, static_syms, FALSE))
2107 	{
2108 	  count = -1;
2109 	  goto done;
2110 	}
2111 
2112       size = 0;
2113       for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2114 	{
2115 	  asymbol *sym;
2116 
2117 	  while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2118 		 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2119 	    ++r;
2120 
2121 	  if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2122 	    break;
2123 
2124 	  if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2125 	    continue;
2126 
2127 	  if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2128 	    continue;
2129 
2130 	  sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2131 	  if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2132 			      sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2133 	    {
2134 	      ++count;
2135 	      size += sizeof (asymbol);
2136 	      size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2137 	    }
2138 	}
2139 
2140       if (size == 0)
2141 	goto done;
2142       s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2143       if (s == NULL)
2144 	{
2145 	  count = -1;
2146 	  goto done;
2147 	}
2148 
2149       names = (char *) (s + count);
2150 
2151       for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2152 	{
2153 	  asymbol *sym;
2154 
2155 	  while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2156 		 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2157 	    ++r;
2158 
2159 	  if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2160 	    break;
2161 
2162 	  if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2163 	    continue;
2164 
2165 	  if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2166 	    continue;
2167 
2168 	  sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2169 	  if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2170 			      sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2171 	    {
2172 	      size_t len;
2173 
2174 	      *s = *syms[i];
2175 	      s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2176 	      s->section = sym->section;
2177 	      s->value = sym->value + r->addend;
2178 	      s->name = names;
2179 	      *names++ = '.';
2180 	      len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2181 	      memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2182 	      names += len + 1;
2183 	      /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2184 		 synthetic symbol was derived from.  */
2185 	      s->udata.p = syms[i];
2186 	      s++;
2187 	    }
2188 	}
2189     }
2190   else
2191     {
2192       bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2193       bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
2194       size_t size;
2195       size_t plt_count = 0;
2196       bfd_vma glink_vma = 0, resolv_vma = 0;
2197       asection *dynamic, *glink = NULL, *relplt = NULL;
2198       arelent *p;
2199 
2200       if (opd != NULL && !bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, opd, &contents))
2201 	{
2202 	free_contents_and_exit_err:
2203 	  count = -1;
2204 	free_contents_and_exit:
2205 	  if (contents)
2206 	    free (contents);
2207 	  goto done;
2208 	}
2209 
2210       size = 0;
2211       for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2212 	{
2213 	  bfd_vma ent;
2214 
2215 	  /* Ignore bogus symbols.  */
2216 	  if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2217 	    continue;
2218 
2219 	  ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2220 	  if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2221 	    {
2222 	      ++count;
2223 	      size += sizeof (asymbol);
2224 	      size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2225 	    }
2226 	}
2227 
2228       /* Get start of .glink stubs from DT_PPC64_GLINK.  */
2229       if (dyn_count != 0
2230 	  && (dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")) != NULL)
2231 	{
2232 	  bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
2233 	  size_t extdynsize;
2234 	  void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
2235 
2236 	  if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
2237 	    goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2238 
2239 	  extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
2240 	  swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
2241 
2242 	  extdyn = dynbuf;
2243 	  extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
2244 	  for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
2245 	    {
2246 	      Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
2247 	      (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
2248 
2249 	      if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
2250 		break;
2251 
2252 	      if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC64_GLINK)
2253 		{
2254 		  /* The first glink stub starts at DT_PPC64_GLINK plus 32.
2255 		     See comment in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections. */
2256 		  glink_vma = dyn.d_un.d_val + 8 * 4;
2257 		  /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
2258 		     link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
2259 		     glink stubs now reside.  */
2260 		  glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma,
2261 						&glink_vma);
2262 		  break;
2263 		}
2264 	    }
2265 
2266 	  free (dynbuf);
2267 	}
2268 
2269       if (glink != NULL)
2270 	{
2271 	  /* Determine __glink trampoline by reading the relative branch
2272 	     from the first glink stub.  */
2273 	  bfd_byte buf[4];
2274 	  unsigned int off = 0;
2275 
2276 	  while (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
2277 					   glink_vma + off - glink->vma, 4))
2278 	    {
2279 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
2280 	      insn ^= B_DOT;
2281 	      if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
2282 		{
2283 		  resolv_vma
2284 		    = glink_vma + off + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
2285 		  break;
2286 		}
2287 	      off += 4;
2288 	      if (off > 4)
2289 		break;
2290 	    }
2291 
2292 	  if (resolv_vma)
2293 	    size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2294 
2295 	  relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
2296 	  if (relplt != NULL)
2297 	    {
2298 	      slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2299 	      if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dyn_syms, TRUE))
2300 		goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2301 
2302 	      plt_count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
2303 	      size += plt_count * sizeof (asymbol);
2304 
2305 	      p = relplt->relocation;
2306 	      for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2307 		{
2308 		  size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
2309 		  if (p->addend != 0)
2310 		    size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 16;
2311 		}
2312 	    }
2313 	}
2314 
2315       if (size == 0)
2316 	goto free_contents_and_exit;
2317       s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2318       if (s == NULL)
2319 	goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2320 
2321       names = (char *) (s + count + plt_count + (resolv_vma != 0));
2322 
2323       for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2324 	{
2325 	  bfd_vma ent;
2326 
2327 	  if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2328 	    continue;
2329 
2330 	  ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2331 	  if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2332 	    {
2333 	      size_t lo, hi;
2334 	      size_t len;
2335 	      asection *sec = abfd->sections;
2336 
2337 	      *s = *syms[i];
2338 	      lo = codesecsym;
2339 	      hi = codesecsymend;
2340 	      while (lo < hi)
2341 		{
2342 		  size_t mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2343 		  if (syms[mid]->section->vma < ent)
2344 		    lo = mid + 1;
2345 		  else if (syms[mid]->section->vma > ent)
2346 		    hi = mid;
2347 		  else
2348 		    {
2349 		      sec = syms[mid]->section;
2350 		      break;
2351 		    }
2352 		}
2353 
2354 	      if (lo >= hi && lo > codesecsym)
2355 		sec = syms[lo - 1]->section;
2356 
2357 	      for (; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2358 		{
2359 		  if (sec->vma > ent)
2360 		    break;
2361 		  /* SEC_LOAD may not be set if SEC is from a separate debug
2362 		     info file.  */
2363 		  if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2364 		    break;
2365 		  if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2366 		    s->section = sec;
2367 		}
2368 	      s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2369 	      s->value = ent - s->section->vma;
2370 	      s->name = names;
2371 	      *names++ = '.';
2372 	      len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2373 	      memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2374 	      names += len + 1;
2375 	      /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2376 		 synthetic symbol was derived from.  */
2377 	      s->udata.p = syms[i];
2378 	      s++;
2379 	    }
2380 	}
2381       free (contents);
2382 
2383       if (glink != NULL && relplt != NULL)
2384 	{
2385 	  if (resolv_vma)
2386 	    {
2387 	      /* Add a symbol for the main glink trampoline.  */
2388 	      memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2389 	      s->the_bfd = abfd;
2390 	      s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2391 	      s->section = glink;
2392 	      s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2393 	      s->name = names;
2394 	      memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve",
2395 		      sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2396 	      names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2397 	      s++;
2398 	      count++;
2399 	    }
2400 
2401 	  /* FIXME: It would be very much nicer to put sym@plt on the
2402 	     stub rather than on the glink branch table entry.  The
2403 	     objdump disassembler would then use a sensible symbol
2404 	     name on plt calls.  The difficulty in doing so is
2405 	     a) finding the stubs, and,
2406 	     b) matching stubs against plt entries, and,
2407 	     c) there can be multiple stubs for a given plt entry.
2408 
2409 	     Solving (a) could be done by code scanning, but older
2410 	     ppc64 binaries used different stubs to current code.
2411 	     (b) is the tricky one since you need to known the toc
2412 	     pointer for at least one function that uses a pic stub to
2413 	     be able to calculate the plt address referenced.
2414 	     (c) means gdb would need to set multiple breakpoints (or
2415 	     find the glink branch itself) when setting breakpoints
2416 	     for pending shared library loads.  */
2417 	  p = relplt->relocation;
2418 	  for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2419 	    {
2420 	      size_t len;
2421 
2422 	      *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
2423 	      /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
2424 		 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
2425 	      if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
2426 		s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
2427 	      s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2428 	      s->section = glink;
2429 	      s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
2430 	      s->name = names;
2431 	      s->udata.p = NULL;
2432 	      len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
2433 	      memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
2434 	      names += len;
2435 	      if (p->addend != 0)
2436 		{
2437 		  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
2438 		  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
2439 		  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
2440 		  names += strlen (names);
2441 		}
2442 	      memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
2443 	      names += sizeof ("@plt");
2444 	      s++;
2445 	      if (abi < 2)
2446 		{
2447 		  glink_vma += 8;
2448 		  if (i >= 0x8000)
2449 		    glink_vma += 4;
2450 		}
2451 	      else
2452 		glink_vma += 4;
2453 	    }
2454 	  count += plt_count;
2455 	}
2456     }
2457 
2458  done:
2459   free (syms);
2460   return count;
2461 }
2462 
2463 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2464    functions above are used generally.  Those named ppc64_elf_* are
2465    called by the main ELF linker code.  They appear in this file more
2466    or less in the order in which they are called.  eg.
2467    ppc64_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2468    ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2469    called.
2470 
2471    PowerPC64-ELF uses a similar scheme to PowerPC64-XCOFF in that
2472    functions have both a function code symbol and a function descriptor
2473    symbol.  A call to foo in a relocatable object file looks like:
2474 
2475    .		.text
2476    .	x:
2477    .		bl	.foo
2478    .		nop
2479 
2480    The function definition in another object file might be:
2481 
2482    .		.section .opd
2483    .	foo:	.quad	.foo
2484    .		.quad	.TOC.@tocbase
2485    .		.quad	0
2486    .
2487    .		.text
2488    .	.foo:	blr
2489 
2490    When the linker resolves the call during a static link, the branch
2491    unsurprisingly just goes to .foo and the .opd information is unused.
2492    If the function definition is in a shared library, things are a little
2493    different:  The call goes via a plt call stub, the opd information gets
2494    copied to the plt, and the linker patches the nop.
2495 
2496    .	x:
2497    .		bl	.foo_stub
2498    .		ld	2,40(1)
2499    .
2500    .
2501    .	.foo_stub:
2502    .		std	2,40(1)			# in practice, the call stub
2503    .		addis	11,2,Lfoo@toc@ha	# is slightly optimized, but
2504    .		addi	11,11,Lfoo@toc@l	# this is the general idea
2505    .		ld	12,0(11)
2506    .		ld	2,8(11)
2507    .		mtctr	12
2508    .		ld	11,16(11)
2509    .		bctr
2510    .
2511    .		.section .plt
2512    .	Lfoo:	reloc (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, foo)
2513 
2514    The "reloc ()" notation is supposed to indicate that the linker emits
2515    an R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT reloc against foo.  The dynamic linker does the opd
2516    copying.
2517 
2518    What are the difficulties here?  Well, firstly, the relocations
2519    examined by the linker in check_relocs are against the function code
2520    sym .foo, while the dynamic relocation in the plt is emitted against
2521    the function descriptor symbol, foo.  Somewhere along the line, we need
2522    to carefully copy dynamic link information from one symbol to the other.
2523    Secondly, the generic part of the elf linker will make .foo a dynamic
2524    symbol as is normal for most other backends.  We need foo dynamic
2525    instead, at least for an application final link.  However, when
2526    creating a shared library containing foo, we need to have both symbols
2527    dynamic so that references to .foo are satisfied during the early
2528    stages of linking.  Otherwise the linker might decide to pull in a
2529    definition from some other object, eg. a static library.
2530 
2531    Update: As of August 2004, we support a new convention.  Function
2532    calls may use the function descriptor symbol, ie. "bl foo".  This
2533    behaves exactly as "bl .foo".  */
2534 
2535 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2536    function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2537    library or PIE, even when the symbol is local.  */
2538 
2539 static int
2540 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2541 		   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
2542 {
2543   switch (r_type)
2544     {
2545     default:
2546       /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2547 	 address isn't fixed.  DTPREL64 is excluded because the
2548 	 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2549 	 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC64_OPT_TLS is set.  */
2550       return 1;
2551 
2552     case R_PPC64_REL32:
2553     case R_PPC64_REL64:
2554     case R_PPC64_REL30:
2555       return 0;
2556 
2557     case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
2558     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
2559     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
2560     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
2561     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
2562     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
2563     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
2564     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
2565     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
2566     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
2567     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
2568     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
2569     case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
2570       /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2571 	 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base.  */
2572       return bfd_link_dll (info);
2573     }
2574 }
2575 
2576 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2577    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2578    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2579    shared lib.  With code that gcc generates, it's vital that this be
2580    enabled;  In the PowerPC64 ABI, the address of a function is actually
2581    the address of a function descriptor, which resides in the .opd
2582    section.  gcc uses the descriptor directly rather than going via the
2583    GOT as some other ABI's do, which means that initialized function
2584    pointers must reference the descriptor.  Thus, a function pointer
2585    initialized to the address of a function in a shared library will
2586    either require a copy reloc, or a dynamic reloc.  Using a copy reloc
2587    redefines the function descriptor symbol to point to the copy.  This
2588    presents a problem as a plt entry for that function is also
2589    initialized from the function descriptor symbol and the copy reloc
2590    may not be initialized first.  */
2591 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2592 
2593 /* Section name for stubs is the associated section name plus this
2594    string.  */
2595 #define STUB_SUFFIX ".stub"
2596 
2597 /* Linker stubs.
2598    ppc_stub_long_branch:
2599    Used when a 14 bit branch (or even a 24 bit branch) can't reach its
2600    destination, but a 24 bit branch in a stub section will reach.
2601    .	b	dest
2602 
2603    ppc_stub_plt_branch:
2604    Similar to the above, but a 24 bit branch in the stub section won't
2605    reach its destination.
2606    .	addis	%r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2607    .	ld	%r12,xxx@toc@l(%r11)
2608    .	mtctr	%r12
2609    .	bctr
2610 
2611    ppc_stub_plt_call:
2612    Used to call a function in a shared library.  If it so happens that
2613    the plt entry referenced crosses a 64k boundary, then an extra
2614    "addi %r11,%r11,xxx@toc@l" will be inserted before the "mtctr".
2615    ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save starts with "std %r2,40(%r1)".
2616    .	addis	%r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2617    .	ld	%r12,xxx+0@toc@l(%r11)
2618    .	mtctr	%r12
2619    .	ld	%r2,xxx+8@toc@l(%r11)
2620    .	ld	%r11,xxx+16@toc@l(%r11)
2621    .	bctr
2622 
2623    ppc_stub_long_branch and ppc_stub_plt_branch may also have additional
2624    code to adjust the value and save r2 to support multiple toc sections.
2625    A ppc_stub_long_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2626    .	std	%r2,40(%r1)
2627    .	addis	%r2,%r2,off@ha
2628    .	addi	%r2,%r2,off@l
2629    .	b	dest
2630 
2631    A ppc_stub_plt_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2632    .	std	%r2,40(%r1)
2633    .	addis	%r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2634    .	ld	%r12,xxx@toc@l(%r11)
2635    .	addis	%r2,%r2,off@ha
2636    .	addi	%r2,%r2,off@l
2637    .	mtctr	%r12
2638    .	bctr
2639 
2640    All of the above stubs are shown as their ELFv1 variants.  ELFv2
2641    variants exist too, simpler for plt calls since a new toc pointer
2642    and static chain are not loaded by the stub.  In addition, ELFv2
2643    has some more complex stubs to handle calls marked with NOTOC
2644    relocs from functions where r2 is not a valid toc pointer.  These
2645    come in two flavours, the ones shown below, and _both variants that
2646    start with "std %r2,24(%r1)" to save r2 in the unlikely event that
2647    one call is from a function where r2 is used as the toc pointer but
2648    needs a toc adjusting stub for small-model multi-toc, and another
2649    call is from a function where r2 is not valid.
2650    ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2651    .	mflr	%r12
2652    .	bcl	20,31,1f
2653    .  1:
2654    .	mflr	%r11
2655    .	mtlr	%r12
2656    .	addis	%r12,%r11,dest-1b@ha
2657    .	addi	%r12,%r12,dest-1b@l
2658    .	b	dest
2659 
2660    ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2661    .	mflr	%r12
2662    .	bcl	20,31,1f
2663    .  1:
2664    .	mflr	%r11
2665    .	mtlr	%r12
2666    .	lis	%r12,xxx-1b@highest
2667    .	ori	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2668    .	sldi	%r12,%r12,32
2669    .	oris	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2670    .	ori	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2671    .	add	%r12,%r11,%r12
2672    .	mtctr	%r12
2673    .	bctr
2674 
2675    ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2676    .	mflr	%r12
2677    .	bcl	20,31,1f
2678    .  1:
2679    .	mflr	%r11
2680    .	mtlr	%r12
2681    .	lis	%r12,xxx-1b@highest
2682    .	ori	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2683    .	sldi	%r12,%r12,32
2684    .	oris	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2685    .	ori	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2686    .	ldx	%r12,%r11,%r12
2687    .	mtctr	%r12
2688    .	bctr
2689 
2690    In cases where the high instructions would add zero, they are
2691    omitted and following instructions modified in some cases.
2692 
2693    For a given stub group (a set of sections all using the same toc
2694    pointer value) there will be just one stub type used for any
2695    particular function symbol.  For example, if printf is called from
2696    code with the tocsave optimization (ie. r2 saved in function
2697    prologue) and therefore calls use a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub,
2698    and from other code without the tocsave optimization requiring a
2699    ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save linkage stub, a single stub of the latter
2700    type will be created.  Calls with the tocsave optimization will
2701    enter this stub after the instruction saving r2.  A similar
2702    situation exists when calls are marked with R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
2703    relocations.  These require a ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub
2704    to call an external function like printf.  If other calls to printf
2705    require a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub then a single
2706    ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub will be used for both types of
2707    call.  If other calls to printf require a ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
2708    linkage stub then a single ppc_stub_plt_call_both linkage stub will
2709    be created and calls not requiring r2 to be saved will enter the
2710    stub after the r2 save instruction.  There is an analogous
2711    hierarchy of long branch and plt branch stubs for local call
2712    linkage.  */
2713 
2714 enum ppc_stub_type
2715 {
2716   ppc_stub_none,
2717   ppc_stub_long_branch,
2718   ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off,
2719   ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc,
2720   ppc_stub_long_branch_both, /* r2off and notoc variants both needed.  */
2721   ppc_stub_plt_branch,
2722   ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off,
2723   ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc,
2724   ppc_stub_plt_branch_both,
2725   ppc_stub_plt_call,
2726   ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save,
2727   ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc,
2728   ppc_stub_plt_call_both,
2729   ppc_stub_global_entry,
2730   ppc_stub_save_res
2731 };
2732 
2733 /* Information on stub grouping.  */
2734 struct map_stub
2735 {
2736   /* The stub section.  */
2737   asection *stub_sec;
2738   /* This is the section to which stubs in the group will be attached.  */
2739   asection *link_sec;
2740   /* Next group.  */
2741   struct map_stub *next;
2742   /* Whether to emit a copy of register save/restore functions in this
2743      group.  */
2744   int needs_save_res;
2745   /* Current offset within stubs after the insn restoring lr in a
2746      _notoc or _both stub using bcl for pc-relative addressing, or
2747      after the insn restoring lr in a __tls_get_addr_opt plt stub.  */
2748   unsigned int lr_restore;
2749   /* Accumulated size of EH info emitted to describe return address
2750      if stubs modify lr.  Does not include 17 byte FDE header.  */
2751   unsigned int eh_size;
2752   /* Offset in glink_eh_frame to the start of EH info for this group.  */
2753   unsigned int eh_base;
2754 };
2755 
2756 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry
2757 {
2758   /* Base hash table entry structure.  */
2759   struct bfd_hash_entry root;
2760 
2761   enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
2762 
2763   /* Group information.  */
2764   struct map_stub *group;
2765 
2766   /* Offset within stub_sec of the beginning of this stub.  */
2767   bfd_vma stub_offset;
2768 
2769   /* Given the symbol's value and its section we can determine its final
2770      value when building the stubs (so the stub knows where to jump.  */
2771   bfd_vma target_value;
2772   asection *target_section;
2773 
2774   /* The symbol table entry, if any, that this was derived from.  */
2775   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
2776   struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
2777 
2778   /* Symbol type.  */
2779   unsigned char symtype;
2780 
2781   /* Symbol st_other.  */
2782   unsigned char other;
2783 };
2784 
2785 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry
2786 {
2787   /* Base hash table entry structure.  */
2788   struct bfd_hash_entry root;
2789 
2790   /* Offset within branch lookup table.  */
2791   unsigned int offset;
2792 
2793   /* Generation marker.  */
2794   unsigned int iter;
2795 };
2796 
2797 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols.  */
2798 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2799 {
2800   struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2801 
2802   /* The input section of the reloc.  */
2803   asection *sec;
2804 
2805   /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section.  */
2806   unsigned int count : 31;
2807 
2808   /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
2809   unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2810 };
2811 
2812 struct ppc_link_hash_entry
2813 {
2814   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2815 
2816   union
2817   {
2818     /* A pointer to the most recently used stub hash entry against this
2819        symbol.  */
2820     struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_cache;
2821 
2822     /* A pointer to the next symbol starting with a '.'  */
2823     struct ppc_link_hash_entry *next_dot_sym;
2824   } u;
2825 
2826   /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol.  */
2827   struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2828 
2829   /* Link between function code and descriptor symbols.  */
2830   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *oh;
2831 
2832   /* Flag function code and descriptor symbols.  */
2833   unsigned int is_func:1;
2834   unsigned int is_func_descriptor:1;
2835   unsigned int fake:1;
2836 
2837   /* Whether global opd/toc sym has been adjusted or not.
2838      After ppc64_elf_edit_opd/ppc64_elf_edit_toc has run, this flag
2839      should be set for all globals defined in any opd/toc section.  */
2840   unsigned int adjust_done:1;
2841 
2842   /* Set if this is an out-of-line register save/restore function,
2843      with non-standard calling convention.  */
2844   unsigned int save_res:1;
2845 
2846   /* Set if a duplicate symbol with non-zero localentry is detected,
2847      even when the duplicate symbol does not provide a definition.  */
2848   unsigned int non_zero_localentry:1;
2849 
2850   /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT (or TOC).
2851      Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2852      encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2853      of the other TLS bits are set.  tls_optimize clears bits when
2854      optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2855      needed.  If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared.  tls_optimize may also
2856      set TLS_TPRELGD when a GD reloc turns into a TPREL one.  We use a
2857      separate flag rather than setting TPREL just for convenience in
2858      distinguishing the two cases.
2859      These flags are also kept for local symbols.  */
2860 #define TLS_TLS		 1	/* Any TLS reloc.  */
2861 #define TLS_GD		 2	/* GD reloc. */
2862 #define TLS_LD		 4	/* LD reloc. */
2863 #define TLS_TPREL	 8	/* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2864 #define TLS_DTPREL	16	/* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2865 #define TLS_MARK	32	/* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2866 #define TLS_TPRELGD	64	/* TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2867 #define TLS_EXPLICIT   128	/* Marks TOC section TLS relocs. */
2868   unsigned char tls_mask;
2869 
2870   /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols.  In which
2871      case TLS_TLS will be 0.  */
2872 #define PLT_IFUNC	 2	/* STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
2873 #define PLT_KEEP	 4	/* inline plt call requires plt entry.  */
2874 #define NON_GOT        256	/* local symbol plt, not stored.  */
2875 };
2876 
2877 /* ppc64 ELF linker hash table.  */
2878 
2879 struct ppc_link_hash_table
2880 {
2881   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2882 
2883   /* The stub hash table.  */
2884   struct bfd_hash_table stub_hash_table;
2885 
2886   /* Another hash table for plt_branch stubs.  */
2887   struct bfd_hash_table branch_hash_table;
2888 
2889   /* Hash table for function prologue tocsave.  */
2890   htab_t tocsave_htab;
2891 
2892   /* Various options and other info passed from the linker.  */
2893   struct ppc64_elf_params *params;
2894 
2895   /* The size of sec_info below.  */
2896   unsigned int sec_info_arr_size;
2897 
2898   /* Per-section array of extra section info.  Done this way rather
2899      than as part of ppc64_elf_section_data so we have the info for
2900      non-ppc64 sections.  */
2901   struct
2902   {
2903     /* Along with elf_gp, specifies the TOC pointer used by this section.  */
2904     bfd_vma toc_off;
2905 
2906     union
2907     {
2908       /* The section group that this section belongs to.  */
2909       struct map_stub *group;
2910       /* A temp section list pointer.  */
2911       asection *list;
2912     } u;
2913   } *sec_info;
2914 
2915   /* Linked list of groups.  */
2916   struct map_stub *group;
2917 
2918   /* Temp used when calculating TOC pointers.  */
2919   bfd_vma toc_curr;
2920   bfd *toc_bfd;
2921   asection *toc_first_sec;
2922 
2923   /* Used when adding symbols.  */
2924   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *dot_syms;
2925 
2926   /* Shortcuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
2927   asection *glink;
2928   asection *global_entry;
2929   asection *sfpr;
2930   asection *pltlocal;
2931   asection *relpltlocal;
2932   asection *brlt;
2933   asection *relbrlt;
2934   asection *glink_eh_frame;
2935 
2936   /* Shortcut to .__tls_get_addr and __tls_get_addr.  */
2937   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2938   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr_fd;
2939 
2940   /* The size of reliplt used by got entry relocs.  */
2941   bfd_size_type got_reli_size;
2942 
2943   /* Statistics.  */
2944   unsigned long stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry];
2945 
2946   /* Number of stubs against global syms.  */
2947   unsigned long stub_globals;
2948 
2949   /* Set if we're linking code with function descriptors.  */
2950   unsigned int opd_abi:1;
2951 
2952   /* Support for multiple toc sections.  */
2953   unsigned int do_multi_toc:1;
2954   unsigned int multi_toc_needed:1;
2955   unsigned int second_toc_pass:1;
2956   unsigned int do_toc_opt:1;
2957 
2958   /* Set if tls optimization is enabled.  */
2959   unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2960 
2961   /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls.  */
2962   unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2963 
2964   /* Set on error.  */
2965   unsigned int stub_error:1;
2966 
2967   /* Whether func_desc_adjust needs to be run over symbols.  */
2968   unsigned int need_func_desc_adj:1;
2969 
2970   /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2971      referenced by dynamic relocations.  */
2972   unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2973   unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2974 
2975   /* Whether plt calls for ELFv2 localentry:0 funcs have been optimized.  */
2976   unsigned int has_plt_localentry0:1;
2977 
2978   /* Incremented every time we size stubs.  */
2979   unsigned int stub_iteration;
2980 
2981   /* Small local sym cache.  */
2982   struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2983 };
2984 
2985 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2986    are used here.  */
2987 
2988 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations.  */
2989 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2990 
2991 /* Nonzero if this section has an old-style call to __tls_get_addr.  */
2992 #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
2993 
2994 /* Nonzero if this section has any toc or got relocs.  */
2995 #define has_toc_reloc sec_flg2
2996 
2997 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to another section that uses
2998    the toc or got.  */
2999 #define makes_toc_func_call sec_flg3
3000 
3001 /* Recursion protection when determining above flag.  */
3002 #define call_check_in_progress sec_flg4
3003 #define call_check_done sec_flg5
3004 
3005 /* Get the ppc64 ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
3006 
3007 #define ppc_hash_table(p) \
3008   (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
3009   == PPC64_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
3010 
3011 #define ppc_stub_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3012   ((struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) \
3013    bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3014 
3015 #define ppc_branch_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3016   ((struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) \
3017    bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3018 
3019 /* Create an entry in the stub hash table.  */
3020 
3021 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3022 stub_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3023 		   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3024 		   const char *string)
3025 {
3026   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3027      subclass.  */
3028   if (entry == NULL)
3029     {
3030       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry));
3031       if (entry == NULL)
3032 	return entry;
3033     }
3034 
3035   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
3036   entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3037   if (entry != NULL)
3038     {
3039       struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *eh;
3040 
3041       /* Initialize the local fields.  */
3042       eh = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) entry;
3043       eh->stub_type = ppc_stub_none;
3044       eh->group = NULL;
3045       eh->stub_offset = 0;
3046       eh->target_value = 0;
3047       eh->target_section = NULL;
3048       eh->h = NULL;
3049       eh->plt_ent = NULL;
3050       eh->other = 0;
3051     }
3052 
3053   return entry;
3054 }
3055 
3056 /* Create an entry in the branch hash table.  */
3057 
3058 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3059 branch_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3060 		     struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3061 		     const char *string)
3062 {
3063   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3064      subclass.  */
3065   if (entry == NULL)
3066     {
3067       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry));
3068       if (entry == NULL)
3069 	return entry;
3070     }
3071 
3072   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
3073   entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3074   if (entry != NULL)
3075     {
3076       struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *eh;
3077 
3078       /* Initialize the local fields.  */
3079       eh = (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) entry;
3080       eh->offset = 0;
3081       eh->iter = 0;
3082     }
3083 
3084   return entry;
3085 }
3086 
3087 /* Create an entry in a ppc64 ELF linker hash table.  */
3088 
3089 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3090 link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3091 		   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3092 		   const char *string)
3093 {
3094   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3095      subclass.  */
3096   if (entry == NULL)
3097     {
3098       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry));
3099       if (entry == NULL)
3100 	return entry;
3101     }
3102 
3103   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
3104   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3105   if (entry != NULL)
3106     {
3107       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) entry;
3108 
3109       memset (&eh->u.stub_cache, 0,
3110 	      (sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry)
3111 	       - offsetof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry, u.stub_cache)));
3112 
3113       /* When making function calls, old ABI code references function entry
3114 	 points (dot symbols), while new ABI code references the function
3115 	 descriptor symbol.  We need to make any combination of reference and
3116 	 definition work together, without breaking archive linking.
3117 
3118 	 For a defined function "foo" and an undefined call to "bar":
3119 	 An old object defines "foo" and ".foo", references ".bar" (possibly
3120 	 "bar" too).
3121 	 A new object defines "foo" and references "bar".
3122 
3123 	 A new object thus has no problem with its undefined symbols being
3124 	 satisfied by definitions in an old object.  On the other hand, the
3125 	 old object won't have ".bar" satisfied by a new object.
3126 
3127 	 Keep a list of newly added dot-symbols.  */
3128 
3129       if (string[0] == '.')
3130 	{
3131 	  struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3132 
3133 	  htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) table;
3134 	  eh->u.next_dot_sym = htab->dot_syms;
3135 	  htab->dot_syms = eh;
3136 	}
3137     }
3138 
3139   return entry;
3140 }
3141 
3142 struct tocsave_entry
3143 {
3144   asection *sec;
3145   bfd_vma offset;
3146 };
3147 
3148 static hashval_t
3149 tocsave_htab_hash (const void *p)
3150 {
3151   const struct tocsave_entry *e = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p;
3152   return ((bfd_vma) (intptr_t) e->sec ^ e->offset) >> 3;
3153 }
3154 
3155 static int
3156 tocsave_htab_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2)
3157 {
3158   const struct tocsave_entry *e1 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p1;
3159   const struct tocsave_entry *e2 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p2;
3160   return e1->sec == e2->sec && e1->offset == e2->offset;
3161 }
3162 
3163 /* Destroy a ppc64 ELF linker hash table.  */
3164 
3165 static void
3166 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (bfd *obfd)
3167 {
3168   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3169 
3170   htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) obfd->link.hash;
3171   if (htab->tocsave_htab)
3172     htab_delete (htab->tocsave_htab);
3173   bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->branch_hash_table);
3174   bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3175   _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (obfd);
3176 }
3177 
3178 /* Create a ppc64 ELF linker hash table.  */
3179 
3180 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
3181 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
3182 {
3183   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3184   bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_table);
3185 
3186   htab = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
3187   if (htab == NULL)
3188     return NULL;
3189 
3190   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&htab->elf, abfd, link_hash_newfunc,
3191 				      sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry),
3192 				      PPC64_ELF_DATA))
3193     {
3194       free (htab);
3195       return NULL;
3196     }
3197 
3198   /* Init the stub hash table too.  */
3199   if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_hash_newfunc,
3200 			    sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry)))
3201     {
3202       _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3203       return NULL;
3204     }
3205 
3206   /* And the branch hash table.  */
3207   if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->branch_hash_table, branch_hash_newfunc,
3208 			    sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry)))
3209     {
3210       bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3211       _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3212       return NULL;
3213     }
3214 
3215   htab->tocsave_htab = htab_try_create (1024,
3216 					tocsave_htab_hash,
3217 					tocsave_htab_eq,
3218 					NULL);
3219   if (htab->tocsave_htab == NULL)
3220     {
3221       ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3222       return NULL;
3223     }
3224   htab->elf.root.hash_table_free = ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free;
3225 
3226   /* Initializing two fields of the union is just cosmetic.  We really
3227      only care about glist, but when compiled on a 32-bit host the
3228      bfd_vma fields are larger.  Setting the bfd_vma to zero makes
3229      debugger inspection of these fields look nicer.  */
3230   htab->elf.init_got_refcount.refcount = 0;
3231   htab->elf.init_got_refcount.glist = NULL;
3232   htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
3233   htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
3234   htab->elf.init_got_offset.offset = 0;
3235   htab->elf.init_got_offset.glist = NULL;
3236   htab->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
3237   htab->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
3238 
3239   return &htab->elf.root;
3240 }
3241 
3242 /* Create sections for linker generated code.  */
3243 
3244 static bfd_boolean
3245 create_linkage_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3246 {
3247   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3248   flagword flags;
3249 
3250   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3251 
3252   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY
3253 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3254   if (htab->params->save_restore_funcs)
3255     {
3256       /* Create .sfpr for code to save and restore fp regs.  */
3257       htab->sfpr = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".sfpr",
3258 						       flags);
3259       if (htab->sfpr == NULL
3260 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->sfpr, 2))
3261 	return FALSE;
3262     }
3263 
3264   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
3265     return TRUE;
3266 
3267   /* Create .glink for lazy dynamic linking support.  */
3268   htab->glink = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3269 						    flags);
3270   if (htab->glink == NULL
3271       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->glink, 3))
3272     return FALSE;
3273 
3274   /* The part of .glink used by global entry stubs, separate so that
3275      it can be aligned appropriately without affecting htab->glink.  */
3276   htab->global_entry = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3277 							   flags);
3278   if (htab->global_entry == NULL
3279       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->global_entry, 2))
3280     return FALSE;
3281 
3282   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
3283     {
3284       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3285 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3286       htab->glink_eh_frame = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj,
3287 								 ".eh_frame",
3288 								 flags);
3289       if (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
3290 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->glink_eh_frame, 2))
3291 	return FALSE;
3292     }
3293 
3294   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
3295   htab->elf.iplt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".iplt", flags);
3296   if (htab->elf.iplt == NULL
3297       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->elf.iplt, 3))
3298     return FALSE;
3299 
3300   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3301 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3302   htab->elf.irelplt
3303     = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.iplt", flags);
3304   if (htab->elf.irelplt == NULL
3305       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->elf.irelplt, 3))
3306     return FALSE;
3307 
3308   /* Create branch lookup table for plt_branch stubs.  */
3309   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
3310 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3311   htab->brlt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3312 						   flags);
3313   if (htab->brlt == NULL
3314       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->brlt, 3))
3315     return FALSE;
3316 
3317   /* Local plt entries, put in .branch_lt but a separate section for
3318      convenience.  */
3319   htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3320 						       flags);
3321   if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
3322       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->pltlocal, 3))
3323     return FALSE;
3324 
3325   if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
3326     return TRUE;
3327 
3328   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3329 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3330   htab->relbrlt
3331     = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3332   if (htab->relbrlt == NULL
3333       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->relbrlt, 3))
3334     return FALSE;
3335 
3336   htab->relpltlocal
3337     = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3338   if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
3339       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->relpltlocal, 3))
3340     return FALSE;
3341 
3342   return TRUE;
3343 }
3344 
3345 /* Satisfy the ELF linker by filling in some fields in our fake bfd.  */
3346 
3347 bfd_boolean
3348 ppc64_elf_init_stub_bfd (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3349 			 struct ppc64_elf_params *params)
3350 {
3351   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3352 
3353   elf_elfheader (params->stub_bfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = ELFCLASS64;
3354 
3355 /* Always hook our dynamic sections into the first bfd, which is the
3356    linker created stub bfd.  This ensures that the GOT header is at
3357    the start of the output TOC section.  */
3358   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3359   htab->elf.dynobj = params->stub_bfd;
3360   htab->params = params;
3361 
3362   return create_linkage_sections (htab->elf.dynobj, info);
3363 }
3364 
3365 /* Build a name for an entry in the stub hash table.  */
3366 
3367 static char *
3368 ppc_stub_name (const asection *input_section,
3369 	       const asection *sym_sec,
3370 	       const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3371 	       const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
3372 {
3373   char *stub_name;
3374   ssize_t len;
3375 
3376   /* rel->r_addend is actually 64 bit, but who uses more than +/- 2^31
3377      offsets from a sym as a branch target?  In fact, we could
3378      probably assume the addend is always zero.  */
3379   BFD_ASSERT (((int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff) == rel->r_addend);
3380 
3381   if (h)
3382     {
3383       len = 8 + 1 + strlen (h->elf.root.root.string) + 1 + 8 + 1;
3384       stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3385       if (stub_name == NULL)
3386 	return stub_name;
3387 
3388       len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%s+%x",
3389 		     input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3390 		     h->elf.root.root.string,
3391 		     (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3392     }
3393   else
3394     {
3395       len = 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1;
3396       stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3397       if (stub_name == NULL)
3398 	return stub_name;
3399 
3400       len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%x:%x+%x",
3401 		     input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3402 		     sym_sec->id & 0xffffffff,
3403 		     (int) ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info) & 0xffffffff,
3404 		     (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3405     }
3406   if (len > 2 && stub_name[len - 2] == '+' && stub_name[len - 1] == '0')
3407     stub_name[len - 2] = 0;
3408   return stub_name;
3409 }
3410 
3411 /* Look up an entry in the stub hash.  Stub entries are cached because
3412    creating the stub name takes a bit of time.  */
3413 
3414 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3415 ppc_get_stub_entry (const asection *input_section,
3416 		    const asection *sym_sec,
3417 		    struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3418 		    const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
3419 		    struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3420 {
3421   struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3422   struct map_stub *group;
3423 
3424   /* If this input section is part of a group of sections sharing one
3425      stub section, then use the id of the first section in the group.
3426      Stub names need to include a section id, as there may well be
3427      more than one stub used to reach say, printf, and we need to
3428      distinguish between them.  */
3429   group = htab->sec_info[input_section->id].u.group;
3430   if (group == NULL)
3431     return NULL;
3432 
3433   if (h != NULL && h->u.stub_cache != NULL
3434       && h->u.stub_cache->h == h
3435       && h->u.stub_cache->group == group)
3436     {
3437       stub_entry = h->u.stub_cache;
3438     }
3439   else
3440     {
3441       char *stub_name;
3442 
3443       stub_name = ppc_stub_name (group->link_sec, sym_sec, h, rel);
3444       if (stub_name == NULL)
3445 	return NULL;
3446 
3447       stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
3448 					 stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
3449       if (h != NULL)
3450 	h->u.stub_cache = stub_entry;
3451 
3452       free (stub_name);
3453     }
3454 
3455   return stub_entry;
3456 }
3457 
3458 /* Add a new stub entry to the stub hash.  Not all fields of the new
3459    stub entry are initialised.  */
3460 
3461 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3462 ppc_add_stub (const char *stub_name,
3463 	      asection *section,
3464 	      struct bfd_link_info *info)
3465 {
3466   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3467   struct map_stub *group;
3468   asection *link_sec;
3469   asection *stub_sec;
3470   struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3471 
3472   group = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group;
3473   link_sec = group->link_sec;
3474   stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
3475   if (stub_sec == NULL)
3476     {
3477       size_t namelen;
3478       bfd_size_type len;
3479       char *s_name;
3480 
3481       namelen = strlen (link_sec->name);
3482       len = namelen + sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX);
3483       s_name = bfd_alloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, len);
3484       if (s_name == NULL)
3485 	return NULL;
3486 
3487       memcpy (s_name, link_sec->name, namelen);
3488       memcpy (s_name + namelen, STUB_SUFFIX, sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX));
3489       stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (s_name, link_sec);
3490       if (stub_sec == NULL)
3491 	return NULL;
3492       group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
3493     }
3494 
3495   /* Enter this entry into the linker stub hash table.  */
3496   stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
3497 				     TRUE, FALSE);
3498   if (stub_entry == NULL)
3499     {
3500       /* xgettext:c-format */
3501       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: cannot create stub entry %s"),
3502 			  section->owner, stub_name);
3503       return NULL;
3504     }
3505 
3506   stub_entry->group = group;
3507   stub_entry->stub_offset = 0;
3508   return stub_entry;
3509 }
3510 
3511 /* Create .got and .rela.got sections in ABFD, and .got in dynobj if
3512    not already done.  */
3513 
3514 static bfd_boolean
3515 create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3516 {
3517   asection *got, *relgot;
3518   flagword flags;
3519   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3520 
3521   if (!is_ppc64_elf (abfd))
3522     return FALSE;
3523   if (htab == NULL)
3524     return FALSE;
3525 
3526   if (!htab->elf.sgot
3527       && !_bfd_elf_create_got_section (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3528     return FALSE;
3529 
3530   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3531 	   | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3532 
3533   got = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3534   if (!got
3535       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, got, 3))
3536     return FALSE;
3537 
3538   relgot = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.got",
3539 					       flags | SEC_READONLY);
3540   if (!relgot
3541       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, relgot, 3))
3542     return FALSE;
3543 
3544   ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got = got;
3545   ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->relgot = relgot;
3546   return TRUE;
3547 }
3548 
3549 /* Follow indirect and warning symbol links.  */
3550 
3551 static inline struct bfd_link_hash_entry *
3552 follow_link (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h)
3553 {
3554   while (h->type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3555 	 || h->type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3556     h = h->u.i.link;
3557   return h;
3558 }
3559 
3560 static inline struct elf_link_hash_entry *
3561 elf_follow_link (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3562 {
3563   return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) follow_link (&h->root);
3564 }
3565 
3566 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3567 ppc_follow_link (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h)
3568 {
3569   return (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) follow_link (&h->elf.root);
3570 }
3571 
3572 /* Merge PLT info on FROM with that on TO.  */
3573 
3574 static void
3575 move_plt_plist (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *from,
3576 		struct ppc_link_hash_entry *to)
3577 {
3578   if (from->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3579     {
3580       if (to->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3581 	{
3582 	  struct plt_entry **entp;
3583 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
3584 
3585 	  for (entp = &from->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3586 	    {
3587 	      struct plt_entry *dent;
3588 
3589 	      for (dent = to->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3590 		if (dent->addend == ent->addend)
3591 		  {
3592 		    dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
3593 		    *entp = ent->next;
3594 		    break;
3595 		  }
3596 	      if (dent == NULL)
3597 		entp = &ent->next;
3598 	    }
3599 	  *entp = to->elf.plt.plist;
3600 	}
3601 
3602       to->elf.plt.plist = from->elf.plt.plist;
3603       from->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
3604     }
3605 }
3606 
3607 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
3608 
3609 static void
3610 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3611 				struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
3612 				struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
3613 {
3614   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
3615 
3616   edir = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) dir;
3617   eind = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) ind;
3618 
3619   edir->is_func |= eind->is_func;
3620   edir->is_func_descriptor |= eind->is_func_descriptor;
3621   edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
3622   if (eind->oh != NULL)
3623     edir->oh = ppc_follow_link (eind->oh);
3624 
3625   if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
3626     edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
3627   edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
3628   edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
3629   edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
3630   edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
3631   edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
3632 
3633   /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, don't copy
3634      dyn_relocs, plt/got info, or dynindx.  We used to copy dyn_relocs
3635      in order to simplify readonly_dynrelocs and save a field in the
3636      symbol hash entry, but that means dyn_relocs can't be used in any
3637      tests about a specific symbol, or affect other symbol flags which
3638      are then tested.  */
3639   if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3640     return;
3641 
3642   /* Copy over any dynamic relocs we may have on the indirect sym.  */
3643   if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3644     {
3645       if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3646 	{
3647 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
3648 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3649 
3650 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
3651 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
3652 	  for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
3653 	    {
3654 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
3655 
3656 	      for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
3657 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
3658 		  {
3659 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
3660 		    q->count += p->count;
3661 		    *pp = p->next;
3662 		    break;
3663 		  }
3664 	      if (q == NULL)
3665 		pp = &p->next;
3666 	    }
3667 	  *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
3668 	}
3669 
3670       edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
3671       eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
3672     }
3673 
3674   /* Copy over got entries that we may have already seen to the
3675      symbol which just became indirect.  */
3676   if (eind->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3677     {
3678       if (edir->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3679 	{
3680 	  struct got_entry **entp;
3681 	  struct got_entry *ent;
3682 
3683 	  for (entp = &eind->elf.got.glist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3684 	    {
3685 	      struct got_entry *dent;
3686 
3687 	      for (dent = edir->elf.got.glist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3688 		if (dent->addend == ent->addend
3689 		    && dent->owner == ent->owner
3690 		    && dent->tls_type == ent->tls_type)
3691 		  {
3692 		    dent->got.refcount += ent->got.refcount;
3693 		    *entp = ent->next;
3694 		    break;
3695 		  }
3696 	      if (dent == NULL)
3697 		entp = &ent->next;
3698 	    }
3699 	  *entp = edir->elf.got.glist;
3700 	}
3701 
3702       edir->elf.got.glist = eind->elf.got.glist;
3703       eind->elf.got.glist = NULL;
3704     }
3705 
3706   /* And plt entries.  */
3707   move_plt_plist (eind, edir);
3708 
3709   if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
3710     {
3711       if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
3712 	_bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
3713 				edir->elf.dynstr_index);
3714       edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
3715       edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
3716       eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
3717       eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
3718     }
3719 }
3720 
3721 /* Find the function descriptor hash entry from the given function code
3722    hash entry FH.  Link the entries via their OH fields.  */
3723 
3724 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3725 lookup_fdh (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3726 {
3727   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = fh->oh;
3728 
3729   if (fdh == NULL)
3730     {
3731       const char *fd_name = fh->elf.root.root.string + 1;
3732 
3733       fdh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
3734 	elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, fd_name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
3735       if (fdh == NULL)
3736 	return fdh;
3737 
3738       fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
3739       fdh->oh = fh;
3740       fh->is_func = 1;
3741       fh->oh = fdh;
3742     }
3743 
3744   fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
3745   fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
3746   fdh->oh = fh;
3747   return fdh;
3748 }
3749 
3750 /* Make a fake function descriptor sym for the undefined code sym FH.  */
3751 
3752 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3753 make_fdh (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3754 	  struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
3755 {
3756   bfd *abfd = fh->elf.root.u.undef.abfd;
3757   struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
3758   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
3759   flagword flags = (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
3760 		    ? BSF_WEAK
3761 		    : BSF_GLOBAL);
3762 
3763   if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, abfd,
3764 					 fh->elf.root.root.string + 1,
3765 					 flags, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
3766 					 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh))
3767     return NULL;
3768 
3769   fdh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) bh;
3770   fdh->elf.non_elf = 0;
3771   fdh->fake = 1;
3772   fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
3773   fdh->oh = fh;
3774   fh->is_func = 1;
3775   fh->oh = fdh;
3776   return fdh;
3777 }
3778 
3779 /* Fix function descriptor symbols defined in .opd sections to be
3780    function type.  */
3781 
3782 static bfd_boolean
3783 ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *ibfd,
3784 			   struct bfd_link_info *info,
3785 			   Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
3786 			   const char **name,
3787 			   flagword *flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3788 			   asection **sec,
3789 			   bfd_vma *value)
3790 {
3791   if (*sec != NULL
3792       && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".opd") == 0)
3793     {
3794       asection *code_sec;
3795 
3796       if (!(ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
3797 	    || ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC))
3798 	isym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (isym->st_info), STT_FUNC);
3799 
3800       /* If the symbol is a function defined in .opd, and the function
3801 	 code is in a discarded group, let it appear to be undefined.  */
3802       if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
3803 	  && (*sec)->reloc_count != 0
3804 	  && opd_entry_value (*sec, *value, &code_sec, NULL,
3805 			      FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1
3806 	  && discarded_section (code_sec))
3807 	{
3808 	  *sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
3809 	  isym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
3810 	}
3811     }
3812   else if (*sec != NULL
3813 	   && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".toc") == 0
3814 	   && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_OBJECT)
3815     {
3816       struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3817       if (htab != NULL)
3818 	htab->params->object_in_toc = 1;
3819     }
3820 
3821   if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
3822     {
3823       if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
3824 	set_abiversion (ibfd, 2);
3825       else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 1)
3826 	{
3827 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol '%s' has invalid st_other"
3828 				" for ABI version 1"), *name);
3829 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3830 	  return FALSE;
3831 	}
3832     }
3833 
3834   return TRUE;
3835 }
3836 
3837 /* Merge non-visibility st_other attributes: local entry point.  */
3838 
3839 static void
3840 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3841 				  const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
3842 				  bfd_boolean definition,
3843 				  bfd_boolean dynamic)
3844 {
3845   if (definition && (!dynamic || !h->def_regular))
3846     h->other = ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1))
3847 		| ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other));
3848 }
3849 
3850 /* Hook called on merging a symbol.  We use this to clear "fake" since
3851    we now have a real symbol.  */
3852 
3853 static bfd_boolean
3854 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3855 			const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
3856 			asection **psec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3857 			bfd_boolean newdef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3858 			bfd_boolean olddef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3859 			bfd *oldbfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3860 			const asection *oldsec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3861 {
3862   ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->fake = 0;
3863   if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
3864     ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->non_zero_localentry = 1;
3865   return TRUE;
3866 }
3867 
3868 /* This function makes an old ABI object reference to ".bar" cause the
3869    inclusion of a new ABI object archive that defines "bar".
3870    NAME is a symbol defined in an archive.  Return a symbol in the hash
3871    table that might be satisfied by the archive symbols.  */
3872 
3873 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
3874 ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (bfd *abfd,
3875 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3876 				 const char *name)
3877 {
3878   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3879   char *dot_name;
3880   size_t len;
3881 
3882   h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, name);
3883   if (h != NULL
3884       /* Don't return this sym if it is a fake function descriptor
3885 	 created by add_symbol_adjust.  */
3886       && !((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->fake)
3887     return h;
3888 
3889   if (name[0] == '.')
3890     return h;
3891 
3892   len = strlen (name);
3893   dot_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
3894   if (dot_name == NULL)
3895     return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) -1;
3896   dot_name[0] = '.';
3897   memcpy (dot_name + 1, name, len + 1);
3898   h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, dot_name);
3899   bfd_release (abfd, dot_name);
3900   return h;
3901 }
3902 
3903 /* This function satisfies all old ABI object references to ".bar" if a
3904    new ABI object defines "bar".  Well, at least, undefined dot symbols
3905    are made weak.  This stops later archive searches from including an
3906    object if we already have a function descriptor definition.  It also
3907    prevents the linker complaining about undefined symbols.
3908    We also check and correct mismatched symbol visibility here.  The
3909    most restrictive visibility of the function descriptor and the
3910    function entry symbol is used.  */
3911 
3912 static bfd_boolean
3913 add_symbol_adjust (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3914 {
3915   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3916   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
3917 
3918   if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3919     eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) eh->elf.root.u.i.link;
3920 
3921   if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3922     return TRUE;
3923 
3924   if (eh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.')
3925     abort ();
3926 
3927   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3928   if (htab == NULL)
3929     return FALSE;
3930 
3931   fdh = lookup_fdh (eh, htab);
3932   if (fdh == NULL
3933       && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
3934       && (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
3935 	  || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
3936       && eh->elf.ref_regular)
3937     {
3938       /* Make an undefined function descriptor sym, in order to
3939 	 pull in an --as-needed shared lib.  Archives are handled
3940 	 elsewhere.  */
3941       fdh = make_fdh (info, eh);
3942       if (fdh == NULL)
3943 	return FALSE;
3944     }
3945 
3946   if (fdh != NULL)
3947     {
3948       unsigned entry_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) - 1;
3949       unsigned descr_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (fdh->elf.other) - 1;
3950 
3951       /* Make both descriptor and entry symbol have the most
3952 	 constraining visibility of either symbol.  */
3953       if (entry_vis < descr_vis)
3954 	fdh->elf.other += entry_vis - descr_vis;
3955       else if (entry_vis > descr_vis)
3956 	eh->elf.other += descr_vis - entry_vis;
3957 
3958       /* Propagate reference flags from entry symbol to function
3959 	 descriptor symbol.  */
3960       fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular;
3961       fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic;
3962       fdh->elf.ref_regular |= eh->elf.ref_regular;
3963       fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
3964 
3965       if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
3966 	  && fdh->elf.dynindx == -1
3967 	  && fdh->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden
3968 	  && (bfd_link_dll (info)
3969 	      || fdh->elf.def_dynamic
3970 	      || fdh->elf.ref_dynamic)
3971 	  && (eh->elf.ref_regular
3972 	      || eh->elf.def_regular))
3973 	{
3974 	  if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
3975 	    return FALSE;
3976 	}
3977     }
3978 
3979   return TRUE;
3980 }
3981 
3982 /* Set up opd section info and abiversion for IBFD, and process list
3983    of dot-symbols we made in link_hash_newfunc.  */
3984 
3985 static bfd_boolean
3986 ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3987 {
3988   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3989   struct ppc_link_hash_entry **p, *eh;
3990   asection *opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
3991 
3992   if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0)
3993     {
3994       BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type == sec_normal);
3995       ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type = sec_opd;
3996 
3997       if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
3998 	set_abiversion (ibfd, 1);
3999       else if (abiversion (ibfd) >= 2)
4000 	{
4001 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
4002 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB .opd not allowed in ABI version %d"),
4003 			      ibfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4004 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4005 	  return FALSE;
4006 	}
4007     }
4008 
4009   if (is_ppc64_elf (info->output_bfd))
4010     {
4011       /* For input files without an explicit abiversion in e_flags
4012 	 we should have flagged any with symbol st_other bits set
4013 	 as ELFv1 and above flagged those with .opd as ELFv2.
4014 	 Set the output abiversion if not yet set, and for any input
4015 	 still ambiguous, take its abiversion from the output.
4016 	 Differences in ABI are reported later.  */
4017       if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 0)
4018 	set_abiversion (info->output_bfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4019       else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4020 	set_abiversion (ibfd, abiversion (info->output_bfd));
4021     }
4022 
4023   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4024   if (htab == NULL)
4025     return TRUE;
4026 
4027   if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0
4028       && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0
4029       && (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0
4030       && opd->reloc_count != 0
4031       && !bfd_is_abs_section (opd->output_section)
4032       && info->gc_sections)
4033     {
4034       /* Garbage collection needs some extra help with .opd sections.
4035 	 We don't want to necessarily keep everything referenced by
4036 	 relocs in .opd, as that would keep all functions.  Instead,
4037 	 if we reference an .opd symbol (a function descriptor), we
4038 	 want to keep the function code symbol's section.  This is
4039 	 easy for global symbols, but for local syms we need to keep
4040 	 information about the associated function section.  */
4041       bfd_size_type amt;
4042       asection **opd_sym_map;
4043       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4044       Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs, *rel_end, *rel;
4045 
4046       amt = OPD_NDX (opd->size) * sizeof (*opd_sym_map);
4047       opd_sym_map = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, amt);
4048       if (opd_sym_map == NULL)
4049 	return FALSE;
4050       ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->u.opd.func_sec = opd_sym_map;
4051       relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, opd, NULL, NULL,
4052 					  info->keep_memory);
4053       if (relocs == NULL)
4054 	return FALSE;
4055       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4056       rel_end = relocs + opd->reloc_count - 1;
4057       for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4058 	{
4059 	  enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4060 	  unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4061 
4062 	  if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
4063 	      && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC
4064 	      && r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4065 	    {
4066 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4067 	      asection *s;
4068 
4069 	      isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, ibfd, r_symndx);
4070 	      if (isym == NULL)
4071 		{
4072 		  if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4073 		    free (relocs);
4074 		  return FALSE;
4075 		}
4076 
4077 	      s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, isym->st_shndx);
4078 	      if (s != NULL && s != opd)
4079 		opd_sym_map[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = s;
4080 	    }
4081 	}
4082       if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4083 	free (relocs);
4084     }
4085 
4086   p = &htab->dot_syms;
4087   while ((eh = *p) != NULL)
4088     {
4089       *p = NULL;
4090       if (&eh->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
4091 	;
4092       else if (htab->elf.hgot == NULL
4093 	       && strcmp (eh->elf.root.root.string, ".TOC.") == 0)
4094 	htab->elf.hgot = &eh->elf;
4095       else if (abiversion (ibfd) <= 1)
4096 	{
4097 	  htab->need_func_desc_adj = 1;
4098 	  if (!add_symbol_adjust (eh, info))
4099 	    return FALSE;
4100 	}
4101       p = &eh->u.next_dot_sym;
4102     }
4103   return TRUE;
4104 }
4105 
4106 /* Undo hash table changes when an --as-needed input file is determined
4107    not to be needed.  */
4108 
4109 static bfd_boolean
4110 ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed (bfd *ibfd,
4111 			    struct bfd_link_info *info,
4112 			    enum notice_asneeded_action act)
4113 {
4114   if (act == notice_not_needed)
4115     {
4116       struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4117 
4118       if (htab == NULL)
4119 	return FALSE;
4120 
4121       htab->dot_syms = NULL;
4122     }
4123   return _bfd_elf_notice_as_needed (ibfd, info, act);
4124 }
4125 
4126 /* If --just-symbols against a final linked binary, then assume we need
4127    toc adjusting stubs when calling functions defined there.  */
4128 
4129 static void
4130 ppc64_elf_link_just_syms (asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4131 {
4132   if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
4133       && (sec->owner->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0
4134       && is_ppc64_elf (sec->owner))
4135     {
4136       if (abiversion (sec->owner) >= 2
4137 	  || bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, ".opd") != NULL)
4138 	sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4139     }
4140   _bfd_elf_link_just_syms (sec, info);
4141 }
4142 
4143 static struct plt_entry **
4144 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
4145 		       unsigned long r_symndx, bfd_vma r_addend, int tls_type)
4146 {
4147   struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (abfd);
4148   struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4149   unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
4150 
4151   if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4152     {
4153       bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4154 
4155       size *= (sizeof (*local_got_ents)
4156 	       + sizeof (*local_plt)
4157 	       + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
4158       local_got_ents = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
4159       if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4160 	return NULL;
4161       elf_local_got_ents (abfd) = local_got_ents;
4162     }
4163 
4164   if ((tls_type & (NON_GOT | TLS_EXPLICIT)) == 0)
4165     {
4166       struct got_entry *ent;
4167 
4168       for (ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4169 	if (ent->addend == r_addend
4170 	    && ent->owner == abfd
4171 	    && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4172 	  break;
4173       if (ent == NULL)
4174 	{
4175 	  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4176 	  ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4177 	  if (ent == NULL)
4178 	    return FALSE;
4179 	  ent->next = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
4180 	  ent->addend = r_addend;
4181 	  ent->owner = abfd;
4182 	  ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4183 	  ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4184 	  ent->got.refcount = 0;
4185 	  local_got_ents[r_symndx] = ent;
4186 	}
4187       ent->got.refcount += 1;
4188     }
4189 
4190   local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4191   local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4192   local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
4193 
4194   return local_plt + r_symndx;
4195 }
4196 
4197 static bfd_boolean
4198 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist, bfd_vma addend)
4199 {
4200   struct plt_entry *ent;
4201 
4202   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4203     if (ent->addend == addend)
4204       break;
4205   if (ent == NULL)
4206     {
4207       bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4208       ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4209       if (ent == NULL)
4210 	return FALSE;
4211       ent->next = *plist;
4212       ent->addend = addend;
4213       ent->plt.refcount = 0;
4214       *plist = ent;
4215     }
4216   ent->plt.refcount += 1;
4217   return TRUE;
4218 }
4219 
4220 static bfd_boolean
4221 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4222 {
4223   return (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
4224 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
4225 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
4226 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
4227 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
4228 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR24
4229 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14
4230 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
4231 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
4232 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL);
4233 }
4234 
4235 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call.  */
4236 
4237 static bfd_boolean
4238 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4239 {
4240   return (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
4241 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
4242 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
4243 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS
4244 	  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ);
4245 }
4246 
4247 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
4248    calculate needed space in the global offset table, procedure
4249    linkage table, and dynamic reloc sections.  */
4250 
4251 static bfd_boolean
4252 ppc64_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4253 			asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
4254 {
4255   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4256   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4257   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4258   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
4259   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
4260   asection *sreloc;
4261   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *dottga;
4262   bfd_boolean is_opd;
4263 
4264   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
4265     return TRUE;
4266 
4267   /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
4268      In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
4269      and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
4270      or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
4271      relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
4272      libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate.  */
4273   if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
4274     return TRUE;
4275 
4276   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (abfd));
4277 
4278   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4279   if (htab == NULL)
4280     return FALSE;
4281 
4282   tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4283 			      FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4284   dottga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
4285 				 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4286   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4287   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
4288   sreloc = NULL;
4289   is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd;
4290   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
4291   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4292     {
4293       unsigned long r_symndx;
4294       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4295       enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
4296       int tls_type;
4297       struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *ppc64_sec;
4298       struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
4299 
4300       r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4301       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4302 	h = NULL;
4303       else
4304 	{
4305 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4306 	  h = elf_follow_link (h);
4307 
4308 	  if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
4309 	    sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4310 	}
4311 
4312       tls_type = 0;
4313       ifunc = NULL;
4314       if (h != NULL)
4315 	{
4316 	  if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4317 	    {
4318 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
4319 	      ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
4320 	    }
4321 	}
4322       else
4323 	{
4324 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4325 							  abfd, r_symndx);
4326 	  if (isym == NULL)
4327 	    return FALSE;
4328 
4329 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4330 	    {
4331 	      ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4332 					     rel->r_addend,
4333 					     NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
4334 	      if (ifunc == NULL)
4335 		return FALSE;
4336 	    }
4337 	}
4338 
4339       r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4340       switch (r_type)
4341 	{
4342 	case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
4343 	case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
4344 	  /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
4345 	     its parameter symbol.  */
4346 	  if (h != NULL)
4347 	    ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
4348 	  else
4349 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4350 					rel->r_addend,
4351 					NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4352 	      return FALSE;
4353 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4354 	  break;
4355 
4356 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
4357 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4358 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4359 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4360 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4361 	  goto dogottls;
4362 
4363 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
4364 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4365 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4366 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4367 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4368 	  goto dogottls;
4369 
4370 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
4371 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4372 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4373 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4374 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4375 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4376 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4377 	  goto dogottls;
4378 
4379 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
4380 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4381 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
4382 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4383 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4384 	dogottls:
4385 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4386 	  /* Fall through */
4387 
4388 	case R_PPC64_GOT16:
4389 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
4390 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4391 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
4392 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4393 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4394 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.  */
4395 	  sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4396 	  if (r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16
4397 	      || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16
4398 	      || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS
4399 	      || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS
4400 	      || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16
4401 	      || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16_DS)
4402 	    {
4403 	      htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4404 	      ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4405 	    }
4406 
4407 	  if (ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got == NULL
4408 	      && !create_got_section (abfd, info))
4409 	    return FALSE;
4410 
4411 	  if (h != NULL)
4412 	    {
4413 	      struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
4414 	      struct got_entry *ent;
4415 
4416 	      eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
4417 	      for (ent = eh->elf.got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4418 		if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
4419 		    && ent->owner == abfd
4420 		    && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4421 		  break;
4422 	      if (ent == NULL)
4423 		{
4424 		  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4425 		  ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4426 		  if (ent == NULL)
4427 		    return FALSE;
4428 		  ent->next = eh->elf.got.glist;
4429 		  ent->addend = rel->r_addend;
4430 		  ent->owner = abfd;
4431 		  ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4432 		  ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4433 		  ent->got.refcount = 0;
4434 		  eh->elf.got.glist = ent;
4435 		}
4436 	      ent->got.refcount += 1;
4437 	      eh->tls_mask |= tls_type;
4438 	    }
4439 	  else
4440 	    /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
4441 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4442 					rel->r_addend, tls_type))
4443 	      return FALSE;
4444 
4445 	  /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
4446 	     an ifunc.  */
4447 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1)
4448 	    {
4449 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, rel->r_addend))
4450 		return FALSE;
4451 	    }
4452 	  break;
4453 
4454 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4455 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
4456 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4457 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4458 	case R_PPC64_PLT32:
4459 	case R_PPC64_PLT64:
4460 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  */
4461 	  plt_list = ifunc;
4462 	  if (h != NULL)
4463 	    {
4464 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
4465 	      if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4466 		  && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4467 		((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_func = 1;
4468 	      ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
4469 	      plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4470 	    }
4471 	  if (plt_list == NULL)
4472 	    plt_list = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4473 					      rel->r_addend,
4474 					      NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
4475 	  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4476 	    return FALSE;
4477 	  break;
4478 
4479 	  /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
4480 	     relocation if linking a shared object since they are
4481 	     section relative.  */
4482 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
4483 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
4484 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
4485 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
4486 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
4487 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
4488 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
4489 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
4490 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
4491 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
4492 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
4493 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4494 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
4495 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
4496 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
4497 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
4498 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
4499 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
4500 	  break;
4501 
4502 	  /* Nor do these.  */
4503 	case R_PPC64_REL16:
4504 	case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
4505 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
4506 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
4507 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
4508 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
4509 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
4510 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
4511 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
4512 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
4513 	case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
4514 	  break;
4515 
4516 	  /* Not supported as a dynamic relocation.  */
4517 	case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
4518 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4519 	    {
4520 	      if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
4521 		ppc_howto_init ();
4522 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
4523 	      info->callbacks->einfo (_("%H: %s reloc unsupported "
4524 					"in shared libraries and PIEs\n"),
4525 				      abfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
4526 				      ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
4527 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4528 	      return FALSE;
4529 	    }
4530 	  break;
4531 
4532 	case R_PPC64_TOC16:
4533 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
4534 	  htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4535 	  ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4536 	  /* Fall through.  */
4537 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4538 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
4539 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4540 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4541 	  sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4542 	  break;
4543 
4544 	  /* Marker reloc.  */
4545 	case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
4546 	  break;
4547 
4548 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
4549 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
4550 	case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4551 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
4552 	    return FALSE;
4553 	  break;
4554 
4555 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
4556 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
4557 	case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
4558 	  BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
4559 	  if (h != NULL
4560 	      && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
4561 	    return FALSE;
4562 	  break;
4563 
4564 	case R_PPC64_REL14:
4565 	case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
4566 	case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
4567 	  {
4568 	    asection *dest = NULL;
4569 
4570 	    /* Heuristic: If jumping outside our section, chances are
4571 	       we are going to need a stub.  */
4572 	    if (h != NULL)
4573 	      {
4574 		/* If the sym is weak it may be overridden later, so
4575 		   don't assume we know where a weak sym lives.  */
4576 		if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
4577 		  dest = h->root.u.def.section;
4578 	      }
4579 	    else
4580 	      {
4581 		Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4582 
4583 		isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4584 					      abfd, r_symndx);
4585 		if (isym == NULL)
4586 		  return FALSE;
4587 
4588 		dest = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4589 	      }
4590 
4591 	    if (dest != sec)
4592 	      ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_14bit_branch = 1;
4593 	  }
4594 	  goto rel24;
4595 
4596 	case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
4597 	  ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall = 1;
4598 	  /* Fall through.  */
4599 
4600 	case R_PPC64_REL24:
4601 	case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
4602 	rel24:
4603 	  plt_list = ifunc;
4604 	  if (h != NULL)
4605 	    {
4606 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
4607 	      if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4608 		  && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4609 		((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_func = 1;
4610 
4611 	      if (h == tga || h == dottga)
4612 		{
4613 		  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4614 		  if (rel != relocs
4615 		      && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSGD
4616 			  || ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
4617 		    /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with
4618 		       a marker reloc.  */
4619 		    ;
4620 		  else
4621 		    /* Mark this section as having an old-style call.  */
4622 		    sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
4623 		}
4624 	      plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4625 	    }
4626 
4627 	  /* We may need a .plt entry if the function this reloc
4628 	     refers to is in a shared lib.  */
4629 	  if (plt_list
4630 	      && !update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4631 	    return FALSE;
4632 	  break;
4633 
4634 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
4635 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
4636 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
4637 	case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
4638 	  goto dodyn;
4639 
4640 	case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
4641 	  tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4642 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4643 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4644 	  goto dotlstoc;
4645 
4646 	case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
4647 	  if (rel + 1 < rel_end
4648 	      && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
4649 	      && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
4650 	    tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4651 	  else
4652 	    tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4653 	  goto dotlstoc;
4654 
4655 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
4656 	  tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4657 	  if (rel != relocs
4658 	      && rel[-1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64)
4659 	      && rel[-1].r_offset == rel->r_offset - 8)
4660 	    /* This is the second reloc of a dtpmod, dtprel pair.
4661 	       Don't mark with TLS_DTPREL.  */
4662 	    goto dodyn;
4663 
4664 	dotlstoc:
4665 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4666 	  if (h != NULL)
4667 	    {
4668 	      struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
4669 	      eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
4670 	      eh->tls_mask |= tls_type;
4671 	    }
4672 	  else
4673 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4674 					rel->r_addend, tls_type))
4675 	      return FALSE;
4676 
4677 	  ppc64_sec = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec);
4678 	  if (ppc64_sec->sec_type != sec_toc)
4679 	    {
4680 	      bfd_size_type amt;
4681 
4682 	      /* One extra to simplify get_tls_mask.  */
4683 	      amt = sec->size * sizeof (unsigned) / 8 + sizeof (unsigned);
4684 	      ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4685 	      if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx == NULL)
4686 		return FALSE;
4687 	      amt = sec->size * sizeof (bfd_vma) / 8;
4688 	      ppc64_sec->u.toc.add = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4689 	      if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.add == NULL)
4690 		return FALSE;
4691 	      BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_sec->sec_type == sec_normal);
4692 	      ppc64_sec->sec_type = sec_toc;
4693 	    }
4694 	  BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset % 8 == 0);
4695 	  ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8] = r_symndx;
4696 	  ppc64_sec->u.toc.add[rel->r_offset / 8] = rel->r_addend;
4697 
4698 	  /* Mark the second slot of a GD or LD entry.
4699 	     -1 to indicate GD and -2 to indicate LD.  */
4700 	  if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
4701 	    ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -1;
4702 	  else if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
4703 	    ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -2;
4704 	  goto dodyn;
4705 
4706 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
4707 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
4708 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
4709 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
4710 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
4711 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4712 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
4713 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
4714 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
4715 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
4716 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
4717 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
4718 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4719 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4720 	  goto dodyn;
4721 
4722 	case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
4723 	  if (is_opd
4724 	      && rel + 1 < rel_end
4725 	      && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
4726 	    {
4727 	      if (h != NULL)
4728 		((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_func = 1;
4729 	    }
4730 	  /* Fall through.  */
4731 
4732 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
4733 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
4734 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
4735 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
4736 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
4737 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
4738 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
4739 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
4740 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
4741 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
4742 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
4743 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
4744 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1
4745 	      && rel->r_addend == 0)
4746 	    {
4747 	      /* We may need a .plt entry if this reloc refers to a
4748 		 function in a shared lib.  */
4749 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, rel->r_addend))
4750 		return FALSE;
4751 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
4752 	    }
4753 	  /* Fall through.  */
4754 
4755 	case R_PPC64_REL30:
4756 	case R_PPC64_REL32:
4757 	case R_PPC64_REL64:
4758 	case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
4759 	case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
4760 	case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
4761 	case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
4762 	case R_PPC64_TOC:
4763 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
4764 	    /* We may need a copy reloc.  */
4765 	    h->non_got_ref = 1;
4766 
4767 	  /* Don't propagate .opd relocs.  */
4768 	  if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
4769 	    break;
4770 
4771 	  /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
4772 	     against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
4773 	     against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
4774 	     into the shared library.  However, if we are linking with
4775 	     -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
4776 	     global symbol which is defined in an object we are
4777 	     including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set).  At
4778 	     this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
4779 	     possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
4780 	     later (it is never cleared).  In case of a weak definition,
4781 	     DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
4782 	     a shared library.  We account for that possibility below by
4783 	     storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
4784 	     table entry.  A similar situation occurs when creating
4785 	     shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
4786 	     symbol local.
4787 
4788 	     If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
4789 	     may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
4790 	     dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
4791 	     symbol.  */
4792 	dodyn:
4793 	  if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
4794 	       && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
4795 		   || (h != NULL
4796 		       && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
4797 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
4798 			   || !h->def_regular))))
4799 	      || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4800 		  && !bfd_link_pic (info)
4801 		  && h != NULL
4802 		  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
4803 		      || !h->def_regular))
4804 	      || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
4805 		  && ifunc != NULL))
4806 	    {
4807 	      /* We must copy these reloc types into the output file.
4808 		 Create a reloc section in dynobj and make room for
4809 		 this reloc.  */
4810 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
4811 		{
4812 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
4813 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 3, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
4814 
4815 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
4816 		    return FALSE;
4817 		}
4818 
4819 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
4820 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
4821 	      if (h != NULL)
4822 		{
4823 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4824 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs **head;
4825 
4826 		  head = &((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs;
4827 		  p = *head;
4828 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
4829 		    {
4830 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
4831 		      if (p == NULL)
4832 			return FALSE;
4833 		      p->next = *head;
4834 		      *head = p;
4835 		      p->sec = sec;
4836 		      p->count = 0;
4837 		      p->pc_count = 0;
4838 		    }
4839 		  p->count += 1;
4840 		  if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
4841 		    p->pc_count += 1;
4842 		}
4843 	      else
4844 		{
4845 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
4846 		     We really need local syms available to do this
4847 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
4848 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
4849 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs **head;
4850 		  bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
4851 		  asection *s;
4852 		  void *vpp;
4853 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4854 
4855 		  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4856 						abfd, r_symndx);
4857 		  if (isym == NULL)
4858 		    return FALSE;
4859 
4860 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4861 		  if (s == NULL)
4862 		    s = sec;
4863 
4864 		  vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
4865 		  head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
4866 		  is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
4867 		  p = *head;
4868 		  if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
4869 		    p = p->next;
4870 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
4871 		    {
4872 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
4873 		      if (p == NULL)
4874 			return FALSE;
4875 		      p->next = *head;
4876 		      *head = p;
4877 		      p->sec = sec;
4878 		      p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
4879 		      p->count = 0;
4880 		    }
4881 		  p->count += 1;
4882 		}
4883 	    }
4884 	  break;
4885 
4886 	default:
4887 	  break;
4888 	}
4889     }
4890 
4891   return TRUE;
4892 }
4893 
4894 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
4895    object file when linking.  */
4896 
4897 static bfd_boolean
4898 ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4899 {
4900   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
4901   unsigned long iflags, oflags;
4902 
4903   if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
4904     return TRUE;
4905 
4906   if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc64_elf (obfd))
4907     return TRUE;
4908 
4909   if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
4910     return FALSE;
4911 
4912   iflags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
4913   oflags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
4914 
4915   if (iflags & ~EF_PPC64_ABI)
4916     {
4917       _bfd_error_handler
4918 	/* xgettext:c-format */
4919 	(_("%pB uses unknown e_flags 0x%lx"), ibfd, iflags);
4920       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4921       return FALSE;
4922     }
4923   else if (iflags != oflags && iflags != 0)
4924     {
4925       _bfd_error_handler
4926 	/* xgettext:c-format */
4927 	(_("%pB: ABI version %ld is not compatible with ABI version %ld output"),
4928 	 ibfd, iflags, oflags);
4929       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4930       return FALSE;
4931     }
4932 
4933   if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
4934     return FALSE;
4935 
4936   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
4937   return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
4938 }
4939 
4940 static bfd_boolean
4941 ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
4942 {
4943   /* Print normal ELF private data.  */
4944   _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
4945 
4946   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags != 0)
4947     {
4948       FILE *file = ptr;
4949 
4950       fprintf (file, _("private flags = 0x%lx:"),
4951 	       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
4952 
4953       if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI) != 0)
4954 	fprintf (file, _(" [abiv%ld]"),
4955 		 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI);
4956       fputc ('\n', file);
4957     }
4958 
4959   return TRUE;
4960 }
4961 
4962 /* OFFSET in OPD_SEC specifies a function descriptor.  Return the address
4963    of the code entry point, and its section, which must be in the same
4964    object as OPD_SEC.  Returns (bfd_vma) -1 on error.  */
4965 
4966 static bfd_vma
4967 opd_entry_value (asection *opd_sec,
4968 		 bfd_vma offset,
4969 		 asection **code_sec,
4970 		 bfd_vma *code_off,
4971 		 bfd_boolean in_code_sec)
4972 {
4973   bfd *opd_bfd = opd_sec->owner;
4974   Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
4975   Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi, *look;
4976   bfd_vma val;
4977 
4978   /* No relocs implies we are linking a --just-symbols object, or looking
4979      at a final linked executable with addr2line or somesuch.  */
4980   if (opd_sec->reloc_count == 0)
4981     {
4982       bfd_byte *contents = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents;
4983 
4984       if (contents == NULL)
4985 	{
4986 	  if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (opd_bfd, opd_sec, &contents))
4987 	    return (bfd_vma) -1;
4988 	  ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents = contents;
4989 	}
4990 
4991       /* PR 17512: file: 64b9dfbb.  */
4992       if (offset + 7 >= opd_sec->size || offset + 7 < offset)
4993 	return (bfd_vma) -1;
4994 
4995       val = bfd_get_64 (opd_bfd, contents + offset);
4996       if (code_sec != NULL)
4997 	{
4998 	  asection *sec, *likely = NULL;
4999 
5000 	  if (in_code_sec)
5001 	    {
5002 	      sec = *code_sec;
5003 	      if (sec->vma <= val
5004 		  && val < sec->vma + sec->size)
5005 		likely = sec;
5006 	      else
5007 		val = -1;
5008 	    }
5009 	  else
5010 	    for (sec = opd_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
5011 	      if (sec->vma <= val
5012 		  && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5013 		  && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5014 		likely = sec;
5015 	  if (likely != NULL)
5016 	    {
5017 	      *code_sec = likely;
5018 	      if (code_off != NULL)
5019 		*code_off = val - likely->vma;
5020 	    }
5021 	}
5022       return val;
5023     }
5024 
5025   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (opd_bfd));
5026 
5027   relocs = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.relocs;
5028   if (relocs == NULL)
5029     relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (opd_bfd, opd_sec, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
5030   /* PR 17512: file: df8e1fd6.  */
5031   if (relocs == NULL)
5032     return (bfd_vma) -1;
5033 
5034   /* Go find the opd reloc at the sym address.  */
5035   lo = relocs;
5036   hi = lo + opd_sec->reloc_count - 1; /* ignore last reloc */
5037   val = (bfd_vma) -1;
5038   while (lo < hi)
5039     {
5040       look = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
5041       if (look->r_offset < offset)
5042 	lo = look + 1;
5043       else if (look->r_offset > offset)
5044 	hi = look;
5045       else
5046 	{
5047 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (opd_bfd);
5048 
5049 	  if (ELF64_R_TYPE (look->r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
5050 	      && ELF64_R_TYPE ((look + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5051 	    {
5052 	      unsigned long symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (look->r_info);
5053 	      asection *sec = NULL;
5054 
5055 	      if (symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info
5056 		  && elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd) != NULL)
5057 		{
5058 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5059 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *rh;
5060 
5061 		  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd);
5062 		  rh = sym_hashes[symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
5063 		  if (rh != NULL)
5064 		    {
5065 		      rh = elf_follow_link (rh);
5066 		      if (rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5067 			  && rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5068 			break;
5069 		      if (rh->root.u.def.section->owner == opd_bfd)
5070 			{
5071 			  val = rh->root.u.def.value;
5072 			  sec = rh->root.u.def.section;
5073 			}
5074 		    }
5075 		}
5076 
5077 	      if (sec == NULL)
5078 		{
5079 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5080 
5081 		  if (symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
5082 		    {
5083 		      sym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5084 		      if (sym == NULL)
5085 			{
5086 			  size_t symcnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5087 			  sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5088 						      symcnt, 0,
5089 						      NULL, NULL, NULL);
5090 			  if (sym == NULL)
5091 			    break;
5092 			  symtab_hdr->contents = (bfd_byte *) sym;
5093 			}
5094 		      sym += symndx;
5095 		    }
5096 		  else
5097 		    {
5098 		      sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5099 						  1, symndx,
5100 						  NULL, NULL, NULL);
5101 		      if (sym == NULL)
5102 			break;
5103 		    }
5104 		  sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (opd_bfd, sym->st_shndx);
5105 		  if (sec == NULL)
5106 		    break;
5107 		  BFD_ASSERT ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) == 0);
5108 		  val = sym->st_value;
5109 		}
5110 
5111 	      val += look->r_addend;
5112 	      if (code_off != NULL)
5113 		*code_off = val;
5114 	      if (code_sec != NULL)
5115 		{
5116 		  if (in_code_sec && *code_sec != sec)
5117 		    return -1;
5118 		  else
5119 		    *code_sec = sec;
5120 		}
5121 	      if (sec->output_section != NULL)
5122 		val += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5123 	    }
5124 	  break;
5125 	}
5126     }
5127 
5128   return val;
5129 }
5130 
5131 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
5132    function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
5133    otherwise return zero.  */
5134 
5135 static bfd_size_type
5136 ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
5137 			      bfd_vma *code_off)
5138 {
5139   bfd_size_type size;
5140 
5141   if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
5142 		     | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0)
5143     return 0;
5144 
5145   size = 0;
5146   if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
5147     size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5148 
5149   if (strcmp (sym->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
5150     {
5151       struct _opd_sec_data *opd = get_opd_info (sym->section);
5152       bfd_vma symval = sym->value;
5153 
5154       if (opd != NULL
5155 	  && opd->adjust != NULL
5156 	  && elf_section_data (sym->section)->relocs != NULL)
5157 	{
5158 	  /* opd_entry_value will use cached relocs that have been
5159 	     adjusted, but with raw symbols.  That means both local
5160 	     and global symbols need adjusting.  */
5161 	  long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (symval)];
5162 	  if (adjust == -1)
5163 	    return 0;
5164 	  symval += adjust;
5165 	}
5166 
5167       if (opd_entry_value (sym->section, symval,
5168 			   &sec, code_off, TRUE) == (bfd_vma) -1)
5169 	return 0;
5170       /* An old ABI binary with dot-syms has a size of 24 on the .opd
5171 	 symbol.  This size has nothing to do with the code size of the
5172 	 function, which is what we're supposed to return, but the
5173 	 code size isn't available without looking up the dot-sym.
5174 	 However, doing that would be a waste of time particularly
5175 	 since elf_find_function will look at the dot-sym anyway.
5176 	 Now, elf_find_function will keep the largest size of any
5177 	 function sym found at the code address of interest, so return
5178 	 1 here to avoid it incorrectly caching a larger function size
5179 	 for a small function.  This does mean we return the wrong
5180 	 size for a new-ABI function of size 24, but all that does is
5181 	 disable caching for such functions.  */
5182       if (size == 24)
5183 	size = 1;
5184     }
5185   else
5186     {
5187       if (sym->section != sec)
5188 	return 0;
5189       *code_off = sym->value;
5190     }
5191   if (size == 0)
5192     size = 1;
5193   return size;
5194 }
5195 
5196 /* Return true if symbol is a strong function defined in an ELFv2
5197    object with st_other localentry bits of zero, ie. its local entry
5198    point coincides with its global entry point.  */
5199 
5200 static bfd_boolean
5201 is_elfv2_localentry0 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5202 {
5203   return (h != NULL
5204 	  && h->type == STT_FUNC
5205 	  && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5206 	  && (STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & h->other) == 0
5207 	  && !((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->non_zero_localentry
5208 	  && is_ppc64_elf (h->root.u.def.section->owner)
5209 	  && abiversion (h->root.u.def.section->owner) >= 2);
5210 }
5211 
5212 /* Return true if symbol is defined in a regular object file.  */
5213 
5214 static bfd_boolean
5215 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5216 {
5217   return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5218 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5219 	  && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
5220 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
5221 }
5222 
5223 /* If FDH is a function descriptor symbol, return the associated code
5224    entry symbol if it is defined.  Return NULL otherwise.  */
5225 
5226 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5227 defined_code_entry (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh)
5228 {
5229   if (fdh->is_func_descriptor)
5230     {
5231       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (fdh->oh);
5232       if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5233 	  || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5234 	return fh;
5235     }
5236   return NULL;
5237 }
5238 
5239 /* If FH is a function code entry symbol, return the associated
5240    function descriptor symbol if it is defined.  Return NULL otherwise.  */
5241 
5242 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5243 defined_func_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
5244 {
5245   if (fh->oh != NULL
5246       && fh->oh->is_func_descriptor)
5247     {
5248       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = ppc_follow_link (fh->oh);
5249       if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5250 	  || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5251 	return fdh;
5252     }
5253   return NULL;
5254 }
5255 
5256 static bfd_boolean func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
5257 
5258 /* Garbage collect sections, after first dealing with dot-symbols.  */
5259 
5260 static bfd_boolean
5261 ppc64_elf_gc_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5262 {
5263   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5264 
5265   if (htab != NULL && htab->need_func_desc_adj)
5266     {
5267       elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
5268       htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
5269     }
5270   return bfd_elf_gc_sections (abfd, info);
5271 }
5272 
5273 /* Mark all our entry sym sections, both opd and code section.  */
5274 
5275 static void
5276 ppc64_elf_gc_keep (struct bfd_link_info *info)
5277 {
5278   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5279   struct bfd_sym_chain *sym;
5280 
5281   if (htab == NULL)
5282     return;
5283 
5284   for (sym = info->gc_sym_list; sym != NULL; sym = sym->next)
5285     {
5286       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh;
5287       asection *sec;
5288 
5289       eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
5290 	elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym->name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5291       if (eh == NULL)
5292 	continue;
5293       if (eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5294 	  && eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5295 	continue;
5296 
5297       fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5298       if (fh != NULL)
5299 	{
5300 	  sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5301 	  sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5302 	}
5303       else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5304 	       && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5305 				   eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5306 				   &sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5307 	sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5308 
5309       sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5310       sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5311     }
5312 }
5313 
5314 /* Mark sections containing dynamically referenced symbols.  When
5315    building shared libraries, we must assume that any visible symbol is
5316    referenced.  */
5317 
5318 static bfd_boolean
5319 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5320 {
5321   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
5322   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
5323   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
5324   struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list *d = info->dynamic_list;
5325 
5326   /* Dynamic linking info is on the func descriptor sym.  */
5327   fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5328   if (fdh != NULL)
5329     eh = fdh;
5330 
5331   if ((eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5332        || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5333       && ((eh->elf.ref_dynamic && !eh->elf.forced_local)
5334 	  || ((eh->elf.def_regular || ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (&eh->elf))
5335 	      && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_INTERNAL
5336 	      && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_HIDDEN
5337 	      && (!bfd_link_executable (info)
5338 		  || info->gc_keep_exported
5339 		  || info->export_dynamic
5340 		  || (eh->elf.dynamic
5341 		      && d != NULL
5342 		      && (*d->match) (&d->head, NULL,
5343 				      eh->elf.root.root.string)))
5344 	      && (eh->elf.versioned >= versioned
5345 		  || !bfd_hide_sym_by_version (info->version_info,
5346 					       eh->elf.root.root.string)))))
5347     {
5348       asection *code_sec;
5349       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
5350 
5351       eh->elf.root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5352 
5353       /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5354 	 function code sym section to be marked.  */
5355       fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5356       if (fh != NULL)
5357 	{
5358 	  code_sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5359 	  code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5360 	}
5361       else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5362 	       && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5363 				   eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5364 				   &code_sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5365 	code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5366     }
5367 
5368   return TRUE;
5369 }
5370 
5371 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
5372    relocation.  */
5373 
5374 static asection *
5375 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
5376 			struct bfd_link_info *info,
5377 			Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
5378 			struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5379 			Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
5380 {
5381   asection *rsec;
5382 
5383   /* Syms return NULL if we're marking .opd, so we avoid marking all
5384      function sections, as all functions are referenced in .opd.  */
5385   rsec = NULL;
5386   if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
5387     return rsec;
5388 
5389   if (h != NULL)
5390     {
5391       enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
5392       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh, *fdh;
5393 
5394       r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
5395       switch (r_type)
5396 	{
5397 	case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5398 	case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
5399 	  break;
5400 
5401 	default:
5402 	  switch (h->root.type)
5403 	    {
5404 	    case bfd_link_hash_defined:
5405 	    case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
5406 	      eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
5407 	      fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5408 	      if (fdh != NULL)
5409 		{
5410 		  /* -mcall-aixdesc code references the dot-symbol on
5411 		     a call reloc.  Mark the function descriptor too
5412 		     against garbage collection.  */
5413 		  fdh->elf.mark = 1;
5414 		  if (fdh->elf.is_weakalias)
5415 		    weakdef (&fdh->elf)->mark = 1;
5416 		  eh = fdh;
5417 		}
5418 
5419 	      /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5420 		 function code sym section to be marked.  */
5421 	      fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5422 	      if (fh != NULL)
5423 		{
5424 		  /* They also mark their opd section.  */
5425 		  eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5426 
5427 		  rsec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5428 		}
5429 	      else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5430 		       && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5431 					   eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5432 					   &rsec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5433 		eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5434 	      else
5435 		rsec = h->root.u.def.section;
5436 	      break;
5437 
5438 	    case bfd_link_hash_common:
5439 	      rsec = h->root.u.c.p->section;
5440 	      break;
5441 
5442 	    default:
5443 	      return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
5444 	    }
5445 	}
5446     }
5447   else
5448     {
5449       struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
5450 
5451       rsec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
5452       opd = get_opd_info (rsec);
5453       if (opd != NULL && opd->func_sec != NULL)
5454 	{
5455 	  rsec->gc_mark = 1;
5456 
5457 	  rsec = opd->func_sec[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value + rel->r_addend)];
5458 	}
5459     }
5460 
5461   return rsec;
5462 }
5463 
5464 /* The maximum size of .sfpr.  */
5465 #define SFPR_MAX (218*4)
5466 
5467 struct sfpr_def_parms
5468 {
5469   const char name[12];
5470   unsigned char lo, hi;
5471   bfd_byte *(*write_ent) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5472   bfd_byte *(*write_tail) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5473 };
5474 
5475 /* Auto-generate _save*, _rest* functions in .sfpr.
5476    If STUB_SEC is non-null, define alias symbols in STUB_SEC
5477    instead.  */
5478 
5479 static bfd_boolean
5480 sfpr_define (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5481 	     const struct sfpr_def_parms *parm,
5482 	     asection *stub_sec)
5483 {
5484   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5485   unsigned int i;
5486   size_t len = strlen (parm->name);
5487   bfd_boolean writing = FALSE;
5488   char sym[16];
5489 
5490   if (htab == NULL)
5491     return FALSE;
5492 
5493   memcpy (sym, parm->name, len);
5494   sym[len + 2] = 0;
5495 
5496   for (i = parm->lo; i <= parm->hi; i++)
5497     {
5498       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
5499 
5500       sym[len + 0] = i / 10 + '0';
5501       sym[len + 1] = i % 10 + '0';
5502       h = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
5503 	elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym, writing, TRUE, TRUE);
5504       if (stub_sec != NULL)
5505 	{
5506 	  if (h != NULL
5507 	      && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5508 	      && h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
5509 	    {
5510 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *s;
5511 	      char buf[32];
5512 	      sprintf (buf, "%08x.%s", stub_sec->id & 0xffffffff, sym);
5513 	      s = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, buf, TRUE, TRUE, FALSE);
5514 	      if (s == NULL)
5515 		return FALSE;
5516 	      if (s->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5517 		  || (s->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined
5518 		      && s->root.u.def.section == stub_sec))
5519 		{
5520 		  s->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5521 		  s->root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
5522 		  s->root.u.def.value = (stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
5523 					 + h->elf.root.u.def.value);
5524 		  s->ref_regular = 1;
5525 		  s->def_regular = 1;
5526 		  s->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5527 		  s->forced_local = 1;
5528 		  s->non_elf = 0;
5529 		  s->root.linker_def = 1;
5530 		}
5531 	    }
5532 	  continue;
5533 	}
5534       if (h != NULL)
5535 	{
5536 	  h->save_res = 1;
5537 	  if (!h->elf.def_regular)
5538 	    {
5539 	      h->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5540 	      h->elf.root.u.def.section = htab->sfpr;
5541 	      h->elf.root.u.def.value = htab->sfpr->size;
5542 	      h->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
5543 	      h->elf.def_regular = 1;
5544 	      h->elf.non_elf = 0;
5545 	      _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->elf, TRUE);
5546 	      writing = TRUE;
5547 	      if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5548 		{
5549 		  htab->sfpr->contents
5550 		    = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, SFPR_MAX);
5551 		  if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5552 		    return FALSE;
5553 		}
5554 	    }
5555 	}
5556       if (writing)
5557 	{
5558 	  bfd_byte *p = htab->sfpr->contents + htab->sfpr->size;
5559 	  if (i != parm->hi)
5560 	    p = (*parm->write_ent) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5561 	  else
5562 	    p = (*parm->write_tail) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5563 	  htab->sfpr->size = p - htab->sfpr->contents;
5564 	}
5565     }
5566 
5567   return TRUE;
5568 }
5569 
5570 static bfd_byte *
5571 savegpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5572 {
5573   bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5574   return p + 4;
5575 }
5576 
5577 static bfd_byte *
5578 savegpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5579 {
5580   p = savegpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5581   bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5582   p = p + 4;
5583   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5584   return p + 4;
5585 }
5586 
5587 static bfd_byte *
5588 restgpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5589 {
5590   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5591   return p + 4;
5592 }
5593 
5594 static bfd_byte *
5595 restgpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5596 {
5597   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5598   p = p + 4;
5599   p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5600   bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
5601   p = p + 4;
5602   if (r == 29)
5603     {
5604       p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 30);
5605       p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 31);
5606     }
5607   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5608   return p + 4;
5609 }
5610 
5611 static bfd_byte *
5612 savegpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5613 {
5614   bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5615   return p + 4;
5616 }
5617 
5618 static bfd_byte *
5619 savegpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5620 {
5621   p = savegpr1 (abfd, p, r);
5622   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5623   return p + 4;
5624 }
5625 
5626 static bfd_byte *
5627 restgpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5628 {
5629   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5630   return p + 4;
5631 }
5632 
5633 static bfd_byte *
5634 restgpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5635 {
5636   p = restgpr1 (abfd, p, r);
5637   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5638   return p + 4;
5639 }
5640 
5641 static bfd_byte *
5642 savefpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5643 {
5644   bfd_put_32 (abfd, STFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5645   return p + 4;
5646 }
5647 
5648 static bfd_byte *
5649 savefpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5650 {
5651   p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
5652   bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5653   p = p + 4;
5654   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5655   return p + 4;
5656 }
5657 
5658 static bfd_byte *
5659 restfpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5660 {
5661   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5662   return p + 4;
5663 }
5664 
5665 static bfd_byte *
5666 restfpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5667 {
5668   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5669   p = p + 4;
5670   p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
5671   bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
5672   p = p + 4;
5673   if (r == 29)
5674     {
5675       p = restfpr (abfd, p, 30);
5676       p = restfpr (abfd, p, 31);
5677     }
5678   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5679   return p + 4;
5680 }
5681 
5682 static bfd_byte *
5683 savefpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5684 {
5685   p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
5686   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5687   return p + 4;
5688 }
5689 
5690 static bfd_byte *
5691 restfpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5692 {
5693   p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
5694   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5695   return p + 4;
5696 }
5697 
5698 static bfd_byte *
5699 savevr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5700 {
5701   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
5702   p = p + 4;
5703   bfd_put_32 (abfd, STVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
5704   return p + 4;
5705 }
5706 
5707 static bfd_byte *
5708 savevr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5709 {
5710   p = savevr (abfd, p, r);
5711   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5712   return p + 4;
5713 }
5714 
5715 static bfd_byte *
5716 restvr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5717 {
5718   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
5719   p = p + 4;
5720   bfd_put_32 (abfd, LVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
5721   return p + 4;
5722 }
5723 
5724 static bfd_byte *
5725 restvr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5726 {
5727   p = restvr (abfd, p, r);
5728   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5729   return p + 4;
5730 }
5731 
5732 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to transfer dynamic linking
5733    information on function code symbol entries to their corresponding
5734    function descriptor symbol entries.  */
5735 
5736 static bfd_boolean
5737 func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5738 {
5739   struct bfd_link_info *info;
5740   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
5741   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
5742   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
5743   bfd_boolean force_local;
5744 
5745   fh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
5746   if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5747     return TRUE;
5748 
5749   if (!fh->is_func)
5750     return TRUE;
5751 
5752   if (fh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.'
5753       || fh->elf.root.root.string[1] == '\0')
5754     return TRUE;
5755 
5756   info = inf;
5757   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5758   if (htab == NULL)
5759     return FALSE;
5760 
5761   /* Find the corresponding function descriptor symbol.  */
5762   fdh = lookup_fdh (fh, htab);
5763 
5764   /* Resolve undefined references to dot-symbols as the value
5765      in the function descriptor, if we have one in a regular object.
5766      This is to satisfy cases like ".quad .foo".  Calls to functions
5767      in dynamic objects are handled elsewhere.  */
5768   if ((fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5769        || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5770       && (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5771 	  || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5772       && get_opd_info (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5773       && opd_entry_value (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5774 			  fdh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5775 			  &fh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5776 			  &fh->elf.root.u.def.value, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5777     {
5778       fh->elf.root.type = fdh->elf.root.type;
5779       fh->elf.forced_local = 1;
5780       fh->elf.def_regular = fdh->elf.def_regular;
5781       fh->elf.def_dynamic = fdh->elf.def_dynamic;
5782     }
5783 
5784   if (!fh->elf.dynamic)
5785     {
5786       struct plt_entry *ent;
5787 
5788       for (ent = fh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5789 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5790 	  break;
5791       if (ent == NULL)
5792 	return TRUE;
5793     }
5794 
5795   /* Create a descriptor as undefined if necessary.  */
5796   if (fdh == NULL
5797       && !bfd_link_executable (info)
5798       && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5799 	  || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
5800     {
5801       fdh = make_fdh (info, fh);
5802       if (fdh == NULL)
5803 	return FALSE;
5804     }
5805 
5806   /* We can't support overriding of symbols on a fake descriptor.  */
5807   if (fdh != NULL
5808       && fdh->fake
5809       && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5810 	  || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
5811     _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fdh->elf, TRUE);
5812 
5813   /* Transfer dynamic linking information to the function descriptor.  */
5814   if (fdh != NULL)
5815     {
5816       fdh->elf.ref_regular |= fh->elf.ref_regular;
5817       fdh->elf.ref_dynamic |= fh->elf.ref_dynamic;
5818       fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= fh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
5819       fdh->elf.non_got_ref |= fh->elf.non_got_ref;
5820       fdh->elf.dynamic |= fh->elf.dynamic;
5821       fdh->elf.needs_plt |= (fh->elf.needs_plt
5822 			     || fh->elf.type == STT_FUNC
5823 			     || fh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
5824       move_plt_plist (fh, fdh);
5825 
5826       if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
5827 	  && fh->elf.dynindx != -1)
5828 	if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
5829 	  return FALSE;
5830     }
5831 
5832   /* Now that the info is on the function descriptor, clear the
5833      function code sym info.  Any function code syms for which we
5834      don't have a definition in a regular file, we force local.
5835      This prevents a shared library from exporting syms that have
5836      been imported from another library.  Function code syms that
5837      are really in the library we must leave global to prevent the
5838      linker dragging in a definition from a static library.  */
5839   force_local = (!fh->elf.def_regular
5840 		 || fdh == NULL
5841 		 || !fdh->elf.def_regular
5842 		 || fdh->elf.forced_local);
5843   _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
5844 
5845   return TRUE;
5846 }
5847 
5848 static const struct sfpr_def_parms save_res_funcs[] =
5849   {
5850     { "_savegpr0_", 14, 31, savegpr0, savegpr0_tail },
5851     { "_restgpr0_", 14, 29, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
5852     { "_restgpr0_", 30, 31, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
5853     { "_savegpr1_", 14, 31, savegpr1, savegpr1_tail },
5854     { "_restgpr1_", 14, 31, restgpr1, restgpr1_tail },
5855     { "_savefpr_", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr0_tail },
5856     { "_restfpr_", 14, 29, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
5857     { "_restfpr_", 30, 31, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
5858     { "._savef", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr1_tail },
5859     { "._restf", 14, 31, restfpr, restfpr1_tail },
5860     { "_savevr_", 20, 31, savevr, savevr_tail },
5861     { "_restvr_", 20, 31, restvr, restvr_tail }
5862   };
5863 
5864 /* Called near the start of bfd_elf_size_dynamic_sections.  We use
5865    this hook to a) provide some gcc support functions, and b) transfer
5866    dynamic linking information gathered so far on function code symbol
5867    entries, to their corresponding function descriptor symbol entries.  */
5868 
5869 static bfd_boolean
5870 ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5871 			    struct bfd_link_info *info)
5872 {
5873   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
5874 
5875   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5876   if (htab == NULL)
5877     return FALSE;
5878 
5879   /* Provide any missing _save* and _rest* functions.  */
5880   if (htab->sfpr != NULL)
5881     {
5882       unsigned int i;
5883 
5884       htab->sfpr->size = 0;
5885       for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
5886 	if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], NULL))
5887 	  return FALSE;
5888       if (htab->sfpr->size == 0)
5889 	htab->sfpr->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5890     }
5891 
5892   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
5893     return TRUE;
5894 
5895   if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
5896     {
5897       _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, htab->elf.hgot, TRUE);
5898       /* Make .TOC. defined so as to prevent it being made dynamic.
5899 	 The wrong value here is fixed later in ppc64_elf_set_toc.  */
5900       if (!htab->elf.hgot->def_regular
5901 	  || htab->elf.hgot->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined)
5902 	{
5903 	  htab->elf.hgot->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5904 	  htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = 0;
5905 	  htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5906 	  htab->elf.hgot->def_regular = 1;
5907 	  htab->elf.hgot->root.linker_def = 1;
5908 	}
5909       htab->elf.hgot->type = STT_OBJECT;
5910       htab->elf.hgot->other
5911 	= (htab->elf.hgot->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN;
5912     }
5913 
5914   if (htab->need_func_desc_adj)
5915     {
5916       elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
5917       htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
5918     }
5919 
5920   return TRUE;
5921 }
5922 
5923 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections.  */
5924 
5925 static asection *
5926 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5927 {
5928   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
5929   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5930 
5931   eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
5932   for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5933     {
5934       asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
5935 
5936       if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
5937 	return p->sec;
5938     }
5939   return NULL;
5940 }
5941 
5942 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
5943    aliases, that apply to read-only sections.  Cannot be used after
5944    size_dynamic_sections.  */
5945 
5946 static bfd_boolean
5947 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5948 {
5949   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
5950 
5951   eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
5952   do
5953     {
5954       if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
5955 	return TRUE;
5956       eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) eh->elf.u.alias;
5957     }
5958   while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
5959 
5960   return FALSE;
5961 }
5962 
5963 /* Return whether EH has pc-relative dynamic relocs.  */
5964 
5965 static bfd_boolean
5966 pc_dynrelocs (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh)
5967 {
5968   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5969 
5970   for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5971     if (p->pc_count != 0)
5972       return TRUE;
5973   return FALSE;
5974 }
5975 
5976 /* Return true if a global entry stub will be created for H.  Valid
5977    for ELFv2 before plt entries have been allocated.  */
5978 
5979 static bfd_boolean
5980 global_entry_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5981 {
5982   struct plt_entry *pent;
5983 
5984   if (!h->pointer_equality_needed
5985       || h->def_regular)
5986     return FALSE;
5987 
5988   for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
5989     if (pent->plt.refcount > 0
5990 	&& pent->addend == 0)
5991       return TRUE;
5992 
5993   return FALSE;
5994 }
5995 
5996 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
5997    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
5998    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
5999    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6000    understand.  */
6001 
6002 static bfd_boolean
6003 ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6004 				 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6005 {
6006   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6007   asection *s, *srel;
6008 
6009   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6010   if (htab == NULL)
6011     return FALSE;
6012 
6013   /* Deal with function syms.  */
6014   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6015       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6016       || h->needs_plt)
6017     {
6018       bfd_boolean local = (((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->save_res
6019 			   || SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
6020 			   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
6021       /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
6022 	 function symbol is local and not an ifunc.  We keep dynamic
6023 	 relocs for ifuncs when local rather than always emitting a
6024 	 plt call stub for them and defining the symbol on the call
6025 	 stub.  We can't do that for ELFv1 anyway (a function symbol
6026 	 is defined on a descriptor, not code) and it can be faster at
6027 	 run-time due to not needing to bounce through a stub.  The
6028 	 dyn_relocs for ifuncs will be applied even in a static
6029 	 executable.  */
6030       if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
6031 	  && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6032 	  && local)
6033 	((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6034 
6035       /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
6036 	 won't need a .plt entry.  */
6037       struct plt_entry *ent;
6038       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6039 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6040 	  break;
6041       if (ent == NULL
6042 	  || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6043 	      && local
6044 	      && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
6045 		  || (((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask
6046 		      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
6047 	{
6048 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
6049 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
6050 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6051 	}
6052       else if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) >= 2)
6053 	{
6054 	  /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
6055 	     doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
6056 	     executable on a global entry stub.  A dynamic reloc can
6057 	     be used instead.  The reason we prefer a few more dynamic
6058 	     relocs is that calling via a global entry stub costs a
6059 	     few more instructions, and pointer_equality_needed causes
6060 	     extra work in ld.so when resolving these symbols.  */
6061 	  if (global_entry_stub (h))
6062 	    {
6063 	      if (!readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6064 		{
6065 		  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6066 		  /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
6067 		     isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
6068 		  if (!h->needs_plt)
6069 		    h->plt.plist = NULL;
6070 		}
6071 	      else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
6072 		/* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
6073 		   plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic.  */
6074 		((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6075 	    }
6076 
6077 	  /* ELFv2 function symbols can't have copy relocs.  */
6078 	  return TRUE;
6079 	}
6080       else if (!h->needs_plt
6081 	       && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6082 	{
6083 	  /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol isn't an
6084 	     ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
6085 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
6086 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6087 	  return TRUE;
6088 	}
6089     }
6090   else
6091     h->plt.plist = NULL;
6092 
6093   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
6094      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
6095      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
6096   if (h->is_weakalias)
6097     {
6098       struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
6099       BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6100       h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
6101       h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
6102       if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
6103 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
6104 	((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6105       return TRUE;
6106     }
6107 
6108   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
6109      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
6110      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
6111      be handled correctly by relocate_section.  */
6112   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6113     return TRUE;
6114 
6115   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
6116      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
6117   if (!h->non_got_ref)
6118     return TRUE;
6119 
6120   /* Don't generate a copy reloc for symbols defined in the executable.  */
6121   if (!h->def_dynamic || !h->ref_regular || h->def_regular
6122 
6123       /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, don't generate them either.  */
6124       || info->nocopyreloc
6125 
6126       /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
6127 	 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.  */
6128       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6129 
6130       /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss.  The copy in
6131 	 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
6132 	 definition for the variable.  Text relocations are preferable
6133 	 to an incorrect program.  */
6134       || h->protected_def)
6135     return TRUE;
6136 
6137   if (h->plt.plist != NULL)
6138     {
6139       /* We should never get here, but unfortunately there are versions
6140 	 of gcc out there that improperly (for this ABI) put initialized
6141 	 function pointers, vtable refs and suchlike in read-only
6142 	 sections.  Allow them to proceed, but warn that this might
6143 	 break at runtime.  */
6144       info->callbacks->einfo
6145 	(_("%P: copy reloc against `%pT' requires lazy plt linking; "
6146 	   "avoid setting LD_BIND_NOW=1 or upgrade gcc\n"),
6147 	 h->root.root.string);
6148     }
6149 
6150   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
6151      is not a function.  */
6152 
6153   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
6154      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
6155      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
6156      object will contain position independent code, so all references
6157      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
6158      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
6159      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
6160      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
6161      same memory location for the variable.  */
6162   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
6163     {
6164       s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
6165       srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
6166     }
6167   else
6168     {
6169       s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
6170       srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
6171     }
6172   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
6173     {
6174       /* We must generate a R_PPC64_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
6175 	 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
6176 	 and into the runtime process image.  */
6177       srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
6178       h->needs_copy = 1;
6179     }
6180 
6181   /* We no longer want dyn_relocs.  */
6182   ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6183   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
6184 }
6185 
6186 /* If given a function descriptor symbol, hide both the function code
6187    sym and the descriptor.  */
6188 static void
6189 ppc64_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6190 		       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6191 		       bfd_boolean force_local)
6192 {
6193   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6194   _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
6195 
6196   if (ppc_hash_table (info) == NULL)
6197     return;
6198 
6199   eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6200   if (eh->is_func_descriptor)
6201     {
6202       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = eh->oh;
6203 
6204       if (fh == NULL)
6205 	{
6206 	  const char *p, *q;
6207 	  struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
6208 	  char save;
6209 
6210 	  /* We aren't supposed to use alloca in BFD because on
6211 	     systems which do not have alloca the version in libiberty
6212 	     calls xmalloc, which might cause the program to crash
6213 	     when it runs out of memory.  This function doesn't have a
6214 	     return status, so there's no way to gracefully return an
6215 	     error.  So cheat.  We know that string[-1] can be safely
6216 	     accessed;  It's either a string in an ELF string table,
6217 	     or allocated in an objalloc structure.  */
6218 
6219 	  p = eh->elf.root.root.string - 1;
6220 	  save = *p;
6221 	  *(char *) p = '.';
6222 	  fh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
6223 	    elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
6224 	  *(char *) p = save;
6225 
6226 	  /* Unfortunately, if it so happens that the string we were
6227 	     looking for was allocated immediately before this string,
6228 	     then we overwrote the string terminator.  That's the only
6229 	     reason the lookup should fail.  */
6230 	  if (fh == NULL)
6231 	    {
6232 	      q = eh->elf.root.root.string + strlen (eh->elf.root.root.string);
6233 	      while (q >= eh->elf.root.root.string && *q == *p)
6234 		--q, --p;
6235 	      if (q < eh->elf.root.root.string && *p == '.')
6236 		fh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
6237 		  elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
6238 	    }
6239 	  if (fh != NULL)
6240 	    {
6241 	      eh->oh = fh;
6242 	      fh->oh = eh;
6243 	    }
6244 	}
6245       if (fh != NULL)
6246 	_bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6247     }
6248 }
6249 
6250 static bfd_boolean
6251 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
6252 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
6253 	   asection **symsecp,
6254 	   unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6255 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6256 	   unsigned long r_symndx,
6257 	   bfd *ibfd)
6258 {
6259   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
6260 
6261   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6262     {
6263       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
6264       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6265 
6266       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6267       h = elf_follow_link (h);
6268 
6269       if (hp != NULL)
6270 	*hp = h;
6271 
6272       if (symp != NULL)
6273 	*symp = NULL;
6274 
6275       if (symsecp != NULL)
6276 	{
6277 	  asection *symsec = NULL;
6278 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6279 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6280 	    symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
6281 	  *symsecp = symsec;
6282 	}
6283 
6284       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6285 	{
6286 	  struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6287 
6288 	  eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6289 	  *tls_maskp = &eh->tls_mask;
6290 	}
6291     }
6292   else
6293     {
6294       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6295       Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
6296 
6297       if (locsyms == NULL)
6298 	{
6299 	  locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6300 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
6301 	    locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
6302 					    symtab_hdr->sh_info,
6303 					    0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
6304 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
6305 	    return FALSE;
6306 	  *locsymsp = locsyms;
6307 	}
6308       sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
6309 
6310       if (hp != NULL)
6311 	*hp = NULL;
6312 
6313       if (symp != NULL)
6314 	*symp = sym;
6315 
6316       if (symsecp != NULL)
6317 	*symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
6318 
6319       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6320 	{
6321 	  struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
6322 	  unsigned char *tls_mask;
6323 
6324 	  tls_mask = NULL;
6325 	  lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
6326 	  if (lgot_ents != NULL)
6327 	    {
6328 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6329 		(lgot_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6330 	      unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
6331 		(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6332 	      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
6333 	    }
6334 	  *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
6335 	}
6336     }
6337   return TRUE;
6338 }
6339 
6340 /* Returns TLS_MASKP for the given REL symbol.  Function return is 0 on
6341    error, 2 on a toc GD type suitable for optimization, 3 on a toc LD
6342    type suitable for optimization, and 1 otherwise.  */
6343 
6344 static int
6345 get_tls_mask (unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6346 	      unsigned long *toc_symndx,
6347 	      bfd_vma *toc_addend,
6348 	      Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6349 	      const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6350 	      bfd *ibfd)
6351 {
6352   unsigned long r_symndx;
6353   int next_r;
6354   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6355   Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6356   asection *sec;
6357   bfd_vma off;
6358 
6359   r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6360   if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6361     return 0;
6362 
6363   if ((*tls_maskp != NULL
6364        && (**tls_maskp & TLS_TLS) != 0
6365        && **tls_maskp != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
6366       || sec == NULL
6367       || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) == NULL
6368       || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type != sec_toc)
6369     return 1;
6370 
6371   /* Look inside a TOC section too.  */
6372   if (h != NULL)
6373     {
6374       BFD_ASSERT (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6375       off = h->root.u.def.value;
6376     }
6377   else
6378     off = sym->st_value;
6379   off += rel->r_addend;
6380   BFD_ASSERT (off % 8 == 0);
6381   r_symndx = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8];
6382   next_r = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8 + 1];
6383   if (toc_symndx != NULL)
6384     *toc_symndx = r_symndx;
6385   if (toc_addend != NULL)
6386     *toc_addend = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.add[off / 8];
6387   if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6388     return 0;
6389   if ((h == NULL || is_static_defined (h))
6390       && (next_r == -1 || next_r == -2))
6391     return 1 - next_r;
6392   return 1;
6393 }
6394 
6395 /* Find (or create) an entry in the tocsave hash table.  */
6396 
6397 static struct tocsave_entry *
6398 tocsave_find (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
6399 	      enum insert_option insert,
6400 	      Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6401 	      const Elf_Internal_Rela *irela,
6402 	      bfd *ibfd)
6403 {
6404   unsigned long r_indx;
6405   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6406   Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6407   struct tocsave_entry ent, *p;
6408   hashval_t hash;
6409   struct tocsave_entry **slot;
6410 
6411   r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
6412   if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &ent.sec, NULL, local_syms, r_indx, ibfd))
6413     return NULL;
6414   if (ent.sec == NULL || ent.sec->output_section == NULL)
6415     {
6416       _bfd_error_handler
6417 	(_("%pB: undefined symbol on R_PPC64_TOCSAVE relocation"), ibfd);
6418       return NULL;
6419     }
6420 
6421   if (h != NULL)
6422     ent.offset = h->root.u.def.value;
6423   else
6424     ent.offset = sym->st_value;
6425   ent.offset += irela->r_addend;
6426 
6427   hash = tocsave_htab_hash (&ent);
6428   slot = ((struct tocsave_entry **)
6429 	  htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab->tocsave_htab, &ent, hash, insert));
6430   if (slot == NULL)
6431     return NULL;
6432 
6433   if (*slot == NULL)
6434     {
6435       p = (struct tocsave_entry *) bfd_alloc (ibfd, sizeof (*p));
6436       if (p == NULL)
6437 	return NULL;
6438       *p = ent;
6439       *slot = p;
6440     }
6441   return *slot;
6442 }
6443 
6444 /* Adjust all global syms defined in opd sections.  In gcc generated
6445    code for the old ABI, these will already have been done.  */
6446 
6447 static bfd_boolean
6448 adjust_opd_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6449 {
6450   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6451   asection *sym_sec;
6452   struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
6453 
6454   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6455     return TRUE;
6456 
6457   if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
6458       && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6459     return TRUE;
6460 
6461   eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6462   if (eh->adjust_done)
6463     return TRUE;
6464 
6465   sym_sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
6466   opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
6467   if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
6468     {
6469       long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (eh->elf.root.u.def.value)];
6470       if (adjust == -1)
6471 	{
6472 	  /* This entry has been deleted.  */
6473 	  asection *dsec = ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section;
6474 	  if (dsec == NULL)
6475 	    {
6476 	      for (dsec = sym_sec->owner->sections; dsec; dsec = dsec->next)
6477 		if (discarded_section (dsec))
6478 		  {
6479 		    ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section = dsec;
6480 		    break;
6481 		  }
6482 	    }
6483 	  eh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
6484 	  eh->elf.root.u.def.section = dsec;
6485 	}
6486       else
6487 	eh->elf.root.u.def.value += adjust;
6488       eh->adjust_done = 1;
6489     }
6490   return TRUE;
6491 }
6492 
6493 /* Handles decrementing dynamic reloc counts for the reloc specified by
6494    R_INFO in section SEC.  If LOCAL_SYMS is NULL, then H and SYM
6495    have already been determined.  */
6496 
6497 static bfd_boolean
6498 dec_dynrel_count (bfd_vma r_info,
6499 		  asection *sec,
6500 		  struct bfd_link_info *info,
6501 		  Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6502 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6503 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
6504 {
6505   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
6506   asection *sym_sec = NULL;
6507 
6508   /* Can this reloc be dynamic?  This switch, and later tests here
6509      should be kept in sync with the code in check_relocs.  */
6510   r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (r_info);
6511   switch (r_type)
6512     {
6513     default:
6514       return TRUE;
6515 
6516     case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
6517     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
6518     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
6519     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
6520     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
6521     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
6522     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
6523     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
6524     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
6525     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
6526     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
6527     case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
6528     case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
6529     case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
6530     case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
6531     case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
6532     case R_PPC64_REL30:
6533     case R_PPC64_REL32:
6534     case R_PPC64_REL64:
6535     case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
6536     case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
6537     case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
6538     case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
6539     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
6540     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
6541     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
6542     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
6543     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
6544     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
6545     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
6546     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
6547     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
6548     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
6549     case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
6550     case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
6551     case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
6552     case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
6553     case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
6554     case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
6555     case R_PPC64_TOC:
6556       break;
6557     }
6558 
6559   if (local_syms != NULL)
6560     {
6561       unsigned long r_symndx;
6562       bfd *ibfd = sec->owner;
6563 
6564       r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (r_info);
6565       if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, local_syms, r_symndx, ibfd))
6566 	return FALSE;
6567     }
6568 
6569   if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
6570        && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
6571 	   || (h != NULL
6572 	       && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
6573 		   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6574 		   || !h->def_regular))))
6575       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
6576 	  && !bfd_link_pic (info)
6577 	  && h != NULL
6578 	  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6579 	      || !h->def_regular)))
6580     ;
6581   else
6582     return TRUE;
6583 
6584   if (h != NULL)
6585     {
6586       struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6587       struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
6588       pp = &((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs;
6589 
6590       /* elf_gc_sweep may have already removed all dyn relocs associated
6591 	 with local syms for a given section.  Also, symbol flags are
6592 	 changed by elf_gc_sweep_symbol, confusing the test above.  Don't
6593 	 report a dynreloc miscount.  */
6594       if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
6595 	return TRUE;
6596 
6597       while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
6598 	{
6599 	  if (p->sec == sec)
6600 	    {
6601 	      if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
6602 		p->pc_count -= 1;
6603 	      p->count -= 1;
6604 	      if (p->count == 0)
6605 		*pp = p->next;
6606 	      return TRUE;
6607 	    }
6608 	  pp = &p->next;
6609 	}
6610     }
6611   else
6612     {
6613       struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
6614       struct ppc_dyn_relocs **pp;
6615       void *vpp;
6616       bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
6617 
6618       if (local_syms == NULL)
6619 	sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
6620       if (sym_sec == NULL)
6621 	sym_sec = sec;
6622 
6623       vpp = &elf_section_data (sym_sec)->local_dynrel;
6624       pp = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
6625 
6626       if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
6627 	return TRUE;
6628 
6629       is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
6630       while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
6631 	{
6632 	  if (p->sec == sec && p->ifunc == is_ifunc)
6633 	    {
6634 	      p->count -= 1;
6635 	      if (p->count == 0)
6636 		*pp = p->next;
6637 	      return TRUE;
6638 	    }
6639 	  pp = &p->next;
6640 	}
6641     }
6642 
6643   /* xgettext:c-format */
6644   _bfd_error_handler (_("dynreloc miscount for %pB, section %pA"),
6645 		      sec->owner, sec);
6646   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6647   return FALSE;
6648 }
6649 
6650 /* Remove unused Official Procedure Descriptor entries.  Currently we
6651    only remove those associated with functions in discarded link-once
6652    sections, or weakly defined functions that have been overridden.  It
6653    would be possible to remove many more entries for statically linked
6654    applications.  */
6655 
6656 bfd_boolean
6657 ppc64_elf_edit_opd (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6658 {
6659   bfd *ibfd;
6660   bfd_boolean some_edited = FALSE;
6661   asection *need_pad = NULL;
6662   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6663 
6664   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6665   if (htab == NULL)
6666     return FALSE;
6667 
6668   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
6669     {
6670       asection *sec;
6671       Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
6672       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6673       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
6674       struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
6675       bfd_boolean need_edit, add_aux_fields, broken;
6676       bfd_size_type cnt_16b = 0;
6677 
6678       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
6679 	continue;
6680 
6681       sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
6682       if (sec == NULL || sec->size == 0)
6683 	continue;
6684 
6685       if (sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS)
6686 	continue;
6687 
6688       if (sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
6689 	continue;
6690 
6691       /* Look through the section relocs.  */
6692       if ((sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0 || sec->reloc_count == 0)
6693 	continue;
6694 
6695       local_syms = NULL;
6696       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
6697 
6698       /* Read the relocations.  */
6699       relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
6700 					    info->keep_memory);
6701       if (relstart == NULL)
6702 	return FALSE;
6703 
6704       /* First run through the relocs to check they are sane, and to
6705 	 determine whether we need to edit this opd section.  */
6706       need_edit = FALSE;
6707       broken = FALSE;
6708       need_pad = sec;
6709       relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
6710       for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
6711 	{
6712 	  enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
6713 	  unsigned long r_symndx;
6714 	  asection *sym_sec;
6715 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6716 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6717 	  bfd_vma offset;
6718 
6719 	  /* .opd contains an array of 16 or 24 byte entries.  We're
6720 	     only interested in the reloc pointing to a function entry
6721 	     point.  */
6722 	  offset = rel->r_offset;
6723 	  if (rel + 1 == relend
6724 	      || rel[1].r_offset != offset + 8)
6725 	    {
6726 	      /* If someone messes with .opd alignment then after a
6727 		 "ld -r" we might have padding in the middle of .opd.
6728 		 Also, there's nothing to prevent someone putting
6729 		 something silly in .opd with the assembler.  No .opd
6730 		 optimization for them!  */
6731 	    broken_opd:
6732 	      _bfd_error_handler
6733 		(_("%pB: .opd is not a regular array of opd entries"), ibfd);
6734 	      broken = TRUE;
6735 	      break;
6736 	    }
6737 
6738 	  if ((r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) != R_PPC64_ADDR64
6739 	      || (r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info)) != R_PPC64_TOC)
6740 	    {
6741 	      _bfd_error_handler
6742 		/* xgettext:c-format */
6743 		(_("%pB: unexpected reloc type %u in .opd section"),
6744 		 ibfd, r_type);
6745 	      broken = TRUE;
6746 	      break;
6747 	    }
6748 
6749 	  r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6750 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
6751 			  r_symndx, ibfd))
6752 	    goto error_ret;
6753 
6754 	  if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec->owner == NULL)
6755 	    {
6756 	      const char *sym_name;
6757 	      if (h != NULL)
6758 		sym_name = h->root.root.string;
6759 	      else
6760 		sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym,
6761 					     sym_sec);
6762 
6763 	      _bfd_error_handler
6764 		/* xgettext:c-format */
6765 		(_("%pB: undefined sym `%s' in .opd section"),
6766 		 ibfd, sym_name);
6767 	      broken = TRUE;
6768 	      break;
6769 	    }
6770 
6771 	  /* opd entries are always for functions defined in the
6772 	     current input bfd.  If the symbol isn't defined in the
6773 	     input bfd, then we won't be using the function in this
6774 	     bfd;  It must be defined in a linkonce section in another
6775 	     bfd, or is weak.  It's also possible that we are
6776 	     discarding the function due to a linker script /DISCARD/,
6777 	     which we test for via the output_section.  */
6778 	  if (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
6779 	      || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
6780 	    need_edit = TRUE;
6781 
6782 	  rel += 2;
6783 	  if (rel + 1 == relend
6784 	      || (rel + 2 < relend
6785 		  && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
6786 	    ++rel;
6787 
6788 	  if (rel == relend)
6789 	    {
6790 	      if (sec->size == offset + 24)
6791 		{
6792 		  need_pad = NULL;
6793 		  break;
6794 		}
6795 	      if (sec->size == offset + 16)
6796 		{
6797 		  cnt_16b++;
6798 		  break;
6799 		}
6800 	      goto broken_opd;
6801 	    }
6802 	  else if (rel + 1 < relend
6803 		   && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[0].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
6804 		   && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
6805 	    {
6806 	      if (rel[0].r_offset == offset + 16)
6807 		cnt_16b++;
6808 	      else if (rel[0].r_offset != offset + 24)
6809 		goto broken_opd;
6810 	    }
6811 	  else
6812 	    goto broken_opd;
6813 	}
6814 
6815       add_aux_fields = htab->params->non_overlapping_opd && cnt_16b > 0;
6816 
6817       if (!broken && (need_edit || add_aux_fields))
6818 	{
6819 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *write_rel;
6820 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6821 	  bfd_byte *rptr, *wptr;
6822 	  bfd_byte *new_contents;
6823 	  bfd_size_type amt;
6824 
6825 	  new_contents = NULL;
6826 	  amt = OPD_NDX (sec->size) * sizeof (long);
6827 	  opd = &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
6828 	  opd->adjust = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner, amt);
6829 	  if (opd->adjust == NULL)
6830 	    return FALSE;
6831 
6832 	  /* This seems a waste of time as input .opd sections are all
6833 	     zeros as generated by gcc, but I suppose there's no reason
6834 	     this will always be so.  We might start putting something in
6835 	     the third word of .opd entries.  */
6836 	  if ((sec->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
6837 	    {
6838 	      bfd_byte *loc;
6839 	      if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, sec, &loc))
6840 		{
6841 		  if (loc != NULL)
6842 		    free (loc);
6843 		error_ret:
6844 		  if (local_syms != NULL
6845 		      && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
6846 		    free (local_syms);
6847 		  if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
6848 		    free (relstart);
6849 		  return FALSE;
6850 		}
6851 	      sec->contents = loc;
6852 	      sec->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
6853 	    }
6854 
6855 	  elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
6856 
6857 	  new_contents = sec->contents;
6858 	  if (add_aux_fields)
6859 	    {
6860 	      new_contents = bfd_malloc (sec->size + cnt_16b * 8);
6861 	      if (new_contents == NULL)
6862 		return FALSE;
6863 	      need_pad = NULL;
6864 	    }
6865 	  wptr = new_contents;
6866 	  rptr = sec->contents;
6867 	  write_rel = relstart;
6868 	  for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
6869 	    {
6870 	      unsigned long r_symndx;
6871 	      asection *sym_sec;
6872 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6873 	      struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = NULL;
6874 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6875 	      long opd_ent_size;
6876 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *next_rel;
6877 	      bfd_boolean skip;
6878 
6879 	      r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6880 	      if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
6881 			      r_symndx, ibfd))
6882 		goto error_ret;
6883 
6884 	      next_rel = rel + 2;
6885 	      if (next_rel + 1 == relend
6886 		  || (next_rel + 2 < relend
6887 		      && ELF64_R_TYPE (next_rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
6888 		++next_rel;
6889 
6890 	      /* See if the .opd entry is full 24 byte or
6891 		 16 byte (with fd_aux entry overlapped with next
6892 		 fd_func).  */
6893 	      opd_ent_size = 24;
6894 	      if (next_rel == relend)
6895 		{
6896 		  if (sec->size == rel->r_offset + 16)
6897 		    opd_ent_size = 16;
6898 		}
6899 	      else if (next_rel->r_offset == rel->r_offset + 16)
6900 		opd_ent_size = 16;
6901 
6902 	      if (h != NULL
6903 		  && h->root.root.string[0] == '.')
6904 		{
6905 		  fdh = ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->oh;
6906 		  if (fdh != NULL)
6907 		    {
6908 		      fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
6909 		      if (fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
6910 			  && fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6911 			fdh = NULL;
6912 		    }
6913 		}
6914 
6915 	      skip = (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
6916 		      || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr);
6917 	      if (skip)
6918 		{
6919 		  if (fdh != NULL && sym_sec->owner == ibfd)
6920 		    {
6921 		      /* Arrange for the function descriptor sym
6922 			 to be dropped.  */
6923 		      fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
6924 		      fdh->elf.root.u.def.section = sym_sec;
6925 		    }
6926 		  opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = -1;
6927 
6928 		  if (NO_OPD_RELOCS || bfd_link_relocatable (info))
6929 		    rel = next_rel;
6930 		  else
6931 		    while (1)
6932 		      {
6933 			if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
6934 					       NULL, h, sym))
6935 			  goto error_ret;
6936 
6937 			if (++rel == next_rel)
6938 			  break;
6939 
6940 			r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6941 			if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
6942 					r_symndx, ibfd))
6943 			  goto error_ret;
6944 		      }
6945 		}
6946 	      else
6947 		{
6948 		  /* We'll be keeping this opd entry.  */
6949 		  long adjust;
6950 
6951 		  if (fdh != NULL)
6952 		    {
6953 		      /* Redefine the function descriptor symbol to
6954 			 this location in the opd section.  It is
6955 			 necessary to update the value here rather
6956 			 than using an array of adjustments as we do
6957 			 for local symbols, because various places
6958 			 in the generic ELF code use the value
6959 			 stored in u.def.value.  */
6960 		      fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = wptr - new_contents;
6961 		      fdh->adjust_done = 1;
6962 		    }
6963 
6964 		  /* Local syms are a bit tricky.  We could
6965 		     tweak them as they can be cached, but
6966 		     we'd need to look through the local syms
6967 		     for the function descriptor sym which we
6968 		     don't have at the moment.  So keep an
6969 		     array of adjustments.  */
6970 		  adjust = (wptr - new_contents) - (rptr - sec->contents);
6971 		  opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = adjust;
6972 
6973 		  if (wptr != rptr)
6974 		    memcpy (wptr, rptr, opd_ent_size);
6975 		  wptr += opd_ent_size;
6976 		  if (add_aux_fields && opd_ent_size == 16)
6977 		    {
6978 		      memset (wptr, '\0', 8);
6979 		      wptr += 8;
6980 		    }
6981 
6982 		  /* We need to adjust any reloc offsets to point to the
6983 		     new opd entries.  */
6984 		  for ( ; rel != next_rel; ++rel)
6985 		    {
6986 		      rel->r_offset += adjust;
6987 		      if (write_rel != rel)
6988 			memcpy (write_rel, rel, sizeof (*rel));
6989 		      ++write_rel;
6990 		    }
6991 		}
6992 
6993 	      rptr += opd_ent_size;
6994 	    }
6995 
6996 	  sec->size = wptr - new_contents;
6997 	  sec->reloc_count = write_rel - relstart;
6998 	  if (add_aux_fields)
6999 	    {
7000 	      free (sec->contents);
7001 	      sec->contents = new_contents;
7002 	    }
7003 
7004 	  /* Fudge the header size too, as this is used later in
7005 	     elf_bfd_final_link if we are emitting relocs.  */
7006 	  rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (sec);
7007 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = sec->reloc_count * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
7008 	  some_edited = TRUE;
7009 	}
7010       else if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7011 	free (relstart);
7012 
7013       if (local_syms != NULL
7014 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7015 	{
7016 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
7017 	    free (local_syms);
7018 	  else
7019 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7020 	}
7021     }
7022 
7023   if (some_edited)
7024     elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_opd_syms, NULL);
7025 
7026   /* If we are doing a final link and the last .opd entry is just 16 byte
7027      long, add a 8 byte padding after it.  */
7028   if (need_pad != NULL && !bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7029     {
7030       bfd_byte *p;
7031 
7032       if ((need_pad->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7033 	{
7034 	  BFD_ASSERT (need_pad->size > 0);
7035 
7036 	  p = bfd_malloc (need_pad->size + 8);
7037 	  if (p == NULL)
7038 	    return FALSE;
7039 
7040 	  if (!bfd_get_section_contents (need_pad->owner, need_pad,
7041 					 p, 0, need_pad->size))
7042 	    return FALSE;
7043 
7044 	  need_pad->contents = p;
7045 	  need_pad->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7046 	}
7047       else
7048 	{
7049 	  p = bfd_realloc (need_pad->contents, need_pad->size + 8);
7050 	  if (p == NULL)
7051 	    return FALSE;
7052 
7053 	  need_pad->contents = p;
7054 	}
7055 
7056       memset (need_pad->contents + need_pad->size, 0, 8);
7057       need_pad->size += 8;
7058     }
7059 
7060   return TRUE;
7061 }
7062 
7063 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
7064    defined functions can be converted to direct calls.  */
7065 
7066 bfd_boolean
7067 ppc64_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7068 {
7069   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7070   bfd *ibfd;
7071   asection *sec;
7072   bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
7073 
7074   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7075   if (htab == NULL)
7076     return FALSE;
7077 
7078   /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc.  The limit is
7079      reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
7080      between the call and its destination.  */
7081   if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
7082     {
7083       limit = -htab->params->group_size;
7084       if (limit == 1)
7085 	limit = 0x1e00000;
7086     }
7087   else
7088     {
7089       limit = htab->params->group_size;
7090       if (limit == 1)
7091 	limit = 0x1c00000;
7092     }
7093 
7094   low_vma = -1;
7095   high_vma = 0;
7096   for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7097     if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
7098       {
7099 	if (low_vma > sec->vma)
7100 	  low_vma = sec->vma;
7101 	if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
7102 	  high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
7103       }
7104 
7105   /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
7106      convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
7107      is local.  */
7108   if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
7109     {
7110       htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
7111       return TRUE;
7112     }
7113 
7114   /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
7115      call won't reach.  Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
7116      the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
7117      this will be better than creating trampolines.  Note that this
7118      will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
7119      particular symbol, not just those that won't reach.  The
7120      difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
7121      linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
7122      particular R_PPC64_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
7123      call, for each of the R_PPC64_PLTSEQ and R_PPC64_PLT16* insns in
7124      the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
7125      together except their symbol.  */
7126 
7127   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7128     {
7129       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7130       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7131 
7132       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7133 	continue;
7134 
7135       local_syms = NULL;
7136       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7137 
7138       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7139 	if (ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall
7140 	    && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7141 	  {
7142 	    Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7143 
7144 	    /* Read the relocations.  */
7145 	    relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7146 						  info->keep_memory);
7147 	    if (relstart == NULL)
7148 	      return FALSE;
7149 
7150 	    relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7151 	    for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7152 	      {
7153 		enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7154 		unsigned long r_symndx;
7155 		asection *sym_sec;
7156 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7157 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7158 		unsigned char *tls_maskp;
7159 
7160 		r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7161 		if (r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
7162 		  continue;
7163 
7164 		r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7165 		if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
7166 				r_symndx, ibfd))
7167 		  {
7168 		    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7169 		      free (relstart);
7170 		    if (local_syms != NULL
7171 			&& symtab_hdr->contents != (bfd_byte *) local_syms)
7172 		      free (local_syms);
7173 		    return FALSE;
7174 		  }
7175 
7176 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
7177 		  {
7178 		    bfd_vma from, to;
7179 		    if (h != NULL)
7180 		      to = h->root.u.def.value;
7181 		    else
7182 		      to = sym->st_value;
7183 		    to += (rel->r_addend
7184 			   + sym_sec->output_offset
7185 			   + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
7186 		    from = (rel->r_offset
7187 			    + sec->output_offset
7188 			    + sec->output_section->vma);
7189 		    if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
7190 		      *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
7191 		  }
7192 	      }
7193 	    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7194 	      free (relstart);
7195 	  }
7196 
7197       if (local_syms != NULL
7198 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7199 	{
7200 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
7201 	    free (local_syms);
7202 	  else
7203 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7204 	}
7205     }
7206 
7207   return TRUE;
7208 }
7209 
7210 /* Set htab->tls_get_addr and call the generic ELF tls_setup function.  */
7211 
7212 asection *
7213 ppc64_elf_tls_setup (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7214 {
7215   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7216 
7217   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7218   if (htab == NULL)
7219     return NULL;
7220 
7221   if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 1)
7222     htab->opd_abi = 1;
7223 
7224   if (htab->params->no_multi_toc)
7225     htab->do_multi_toc = 0;
7226   else if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
7227     htab->params->no_multi_toc = 1;
7228 
7229   /* Default to --no-plt-localentry, as this option can cause problems
7230      with symbol interposition.  For example, glibc libpthread.so and
7231      libc.so duplicate many pthread symbols, with a fallback
7232      implementation in libc.so.  In some cases the fallback does more
7233      work than the pthread implementation.  __pthread_condattr_destroy
7234      is one such symbol: the libpthread.so implementation is
7235      localentry:0 while the libc.so implementation is localentry:8.
7236      An app that "cleverly" uses dlopen to only load necessary
7237      libraries at runtime may omit loading libpthread.so when not
7238      running multi-threaded, which then results in the libc.so
7239      fallback symbols being used and ld.so complaining.  Now there
7240      are workarounds in ld (see non_zero_localentry) to detect the
7241      pthread situation, but that may not be the only case where
7242      --plt-localentry can cause trouble.  */
7243   if (htab->params->plt_localentry0 < 0)
7244     htab->params->plt_localentry0 = 0;
7245   if (htab->params->plt_localentry0
7246       && elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "GLIBC_2.26",
7247 			       FALSE, FALSE, FALSE) == NULL)
7248     _bfd_error_handler
7249       (_("warning: --plt-localentry is especially dangerous without "
7250 	 "ld.so support to detect ABI violations"));
7251 
7252   htab->tls_get_addr = ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
7253 			elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
7254 					      FALSE, FALSE, TRUE));
7255   /* Move dynamic linking info to the function descriptor sym.  */
7256   if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7257     func_desc_adjust (&htab->tls_get_addr->elf, info);
7258   htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
7259 			   elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
7260 						 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE));
7261   if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
7262     {
7263       struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *opt_fd, *tga, *tga_fd;
7264 
7265       opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_opt",
7266 				  FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7267       if (opt != NULL)
7268 	func_desc_adjust (opt, info);
7269       opt_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
7270 				     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7271       if (opt_fd != NULL
7272 	  && (opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7273 	      || opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
7274 	{
7275 	  /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
7276 	     signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
7277 	     be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
7278 	     make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
7279 	  tga_fd = &htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf;
7280 	  if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7281 	      && tga_fd != NULL
7282 	      && (tga_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7283 		  || tga_fd->needs_plt)
7284 	      && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga_fd)
7285 		   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga_fd)))
7286 	    {
7287 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
7288 
7289 	      for (ent = tga_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7290 		if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7291 		  break;
7292 	      if (ent != NULL)
7293 		{
7294 		  tga_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7295 		  tga_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7296 		  ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, tga_fd);
7297 		  opt_fd->mark = 1;
7298 		  if (opt_fd->dynindx != -1)
7299 		    {
7300 		      /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations.  */
7301 		      opt_fd->dynindx = -1;
7302 		      _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
7303 					      opt_fd->dynstr_index);
7304 		      if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt_fd))
7305 			return NULL;
7306 		    }
7307 		  htab->tls_get_addr_fd
7308 		    = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) opt_fd;
7309 		  tga = &htab->tls_get_addr->elf;
7310 		  if (opt != NULL && tga != NULL)
7311 		    {
7312 		      tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7313 		      tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7314 		      ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
7315 		      opt->mark = 1;
7316 		      _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7317 						      tga->forced_local);
7318 		      htab->tls_get_addr = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) opt;
7319 		    }
7320 		  htab->tls_get_addr_fd->oh = htab->tls_get_addr;
7321 		  htab->tls_get_addr_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7322 		  if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7323 		    {
7324 		      htab->tls_get_addr->oh = htab->tls_get_addr_fd;
7325 		      htab->tls_get_addr->is_func = 1;
7326 		    }
7327 		}
7328 	    }
7329 	}
7330       else if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt < 0)
7331 	htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt = 0;
7332     }
7333   return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (info->output_bfd, info);
7334 }
7335 
7336 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
7337    HASH1 or HASH2.  */
7338 
7339 static bfd_boolean
7340 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
7341 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7342 			 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash1,
7343 			 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash2)
7344 {
7345   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7346   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7347   unsigned int r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7348 
7349   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
7350     {
7351       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
7352       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7353 
7354       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
7355       h = elf_follow_link (h);
7356       if (h == &hash1->elf || h == &hash2->elf)
7357 	return TRUE;
7358     }
7359   return FALSE;
7360 }
7361 
7362 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
7363    opportunities.  The linker has been hacked (see ppc64elf.em) to do
7364    a preliminary section layout so that we know the TLS segment
7365    offsets.  We can't optimize earlier because some optimizations need
7366    to know the tp offset, and we need to optimize before allocating
7367    dynamic relocations.  */
7368 
7369 bfd_boolean
7370 ppc64_elf_tls_optimize (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7371 {
7372   bfd *ibfd;
7373   asection *sec;
7374   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7375   unsigned char *toc_ref;
7376   int pass;
7377 
7378   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
7379     return TRUE;
7380 
7381   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7382   if (htab == NULL)
7383     return FALSE;
7384 
7385   /* Make two passes over the relocs.  On the first pass, mark toc
7386      entries involved with tls relocs, and check that tls relocs
7387      involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed followed by
7388      such a call.  If they are not, we can't do any tls optimization.
7389      On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to notify
7390      relocate_section that optimization can be done, and adjust got
7391      and plt refcounts.  */
7392   toc_ref = NULL;
7393   for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
7394     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7395       {
7396 	Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = NULL;
7397 	asection *toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
7398 
7399 	for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7400 	  if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7401 	    {
7402 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7403 	      bfd_boolean found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7404 
7405 	      /* Read the relocations.  */
7406 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7407 						    info->keep_memory);
7408 	      if (relstart == NULL)
7409 		{
7410 		  free (toc_ref);
7411 		  return FALSE;
7412 		}
7413 
7414 	      relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7415 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
7416 		{
7417 		  enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7418 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
7419 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7420 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7421 		  asection *sym_sec;
7422 		  unsigned char *tls_mask;
7423 		  unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear, tls_type = 0;
7424 		  bfd_vma value;
7425 		  bfd_boolean ok_tprel, is_local;
7426 		  long toc_ref_index = 0;
7427 		  int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
7428 		  bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
7429 
7430 		  r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7431 		  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_mask, &locsyms,
7432 				  r_symndx, ibfd))
7433 		    {
7434 		    err_free_rel:
7435 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7436 			free (relstart);
7437 		      if (toc_ref != NULL)
7438 			free (toc_ref);
7439 		      if (locsyms != NULL
7440 			  && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents
7441 			      != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
7442 			free (locsyms);
7443 		      return ret;
7444 		    }
7445 
7446 		  if (h != NULL)
7447 		    {
7448 		      if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7449 			  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7450 			value = h->root.u.def.value;
7451 		      else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
7452 			value = 0;
7453 		      else
7454 			{
7455 			  found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7456 			  continue;
7457 			}
7458 		    }
7459 		  else
7460 		    /* Symbols referenced by TLS relocs must be of type
7461 		       STT_TLS.  So no need for .opd local sym adjust.  */
7462 		    value = sym->st_value;
7463 
7464 		  ok_tprel = FALSE;
7465 		  is_local = FALSE;
7466 		  if (h == NULL
7467 		      || !h->def_dynamic)
7468 		    {
7469 		      is_local = TRUE;
7470 		      if (h != NULL
7471 			  && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
7472 			ok_tprel = TRUE;
7473 		      else if (sym_sec != NULL
7474 			       && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
7475 			{
7476 			  value += sym_sec->output_offset;
7477 			  value += sym_sec->output_section->vma;
7478 			  value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7479 			  ok_tprel = (value + TP_OFFSET + ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)
7480 				      < (bfd_vma) 1 << 32);
7481 			}
7482 		    }
7483 
7484 		  r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7485 		  /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
7486 		     without marker relocs, then check that each
7487 		     __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
7488 		     that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
7489 		     setup insn.  If we don't find matching arg setup
7490 		     relocs, don't do any tls optimization.  */
7491 		  if (pass == 0
7492 		      && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
7493 		      && h != NULL
7494 		      && (h == &htab->tls_get_addr->elf
7495 			  || h == &htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf)
7496 		      && !found_tls_get_addr_arg
7497 		      && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
7498 		    {
7499 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
7500 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
7501 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
7502 		      ret = TRUE;
7503 		      goto err_free_rel;
7504 		    }
7505 
7506 		  found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7507 		  switch (r_type)
7508 		    {
7509 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
7510 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7511 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
7512 		      found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
7513 		      /* Fall through.  */
7514 
7515 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7516 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7517 		      /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
7518 			 defined in a shared lib.  Leave them alone if
7519 			 that turns out to be the case.  */
7520 		      if (!is_local)
7521 			continue;
7522 
7523 		      /* LD -> LE */
7524 		      tls_set = 0;
7525 		      tls_clear = TLS_LD;
7526 		      tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7527 		      break;
7528 
7529 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
7530 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7531 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
7532 		      found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
7533 		      /* Fall through. */
7534 
7535 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7536 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7537 		      if (ok_tprel)
7538 			/* GD -> LE */
7539 			tls_set = 0;
7540 		      else
7541 			/* GD -> IE */
7542 			tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPRELGD;
7543 		      tls_clear = TLS_GD;
7544 		      tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7545 		      break;
7546 
7547 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
7548 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
7549 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7550 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7551 		      if (ok_tprel)
7552 			{
7553 			  /* IE -> LE */
7554 			  tls_set = 0;
7555 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
7556 			  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7557 			  break;
7558 			}
7559 		      continue;
7560 
7561 		    case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
7562 		    case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
7563 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
7564 			  && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7565 			{
7566 			  if (pass != 0
7567 			      && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
7568 				  != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ))
7569 			    {
7570 			      r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
7571 			      if (!get_sym_h (&h, NULL, NULL, NULL, &locsyms,
7572 					      r_symndx, ibfd))
7573 				goto err_free_rel;
7574 			      if (h != NULL)
7575 				{
7576 				  struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
7577 
7578 				  for (ent = h->plt.plist;
7579 				       ent != NULL;
7580 				       ent = ent->next)
7581 				    if (ent->addend == rel[1].r_addend)
7582 				      break;
7583 
7584 				  if (ent != NULL
7585 				      && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7586 				    ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
7587 				}
7588 			    }
7589 			  continue;
7590 			}
7591 		      found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
7592 		      /* Fall through.  */
7593 
7594 		    case R_PPC64_TLS:
7595 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16:
7596 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
7597 		      if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec != toc)
7598 			continue;
7599 
7600 		      /* Mark this toc entry as referenced by a TLS
7601 			 code sequence.  We can do that now in the
7602 			 case of R_PPC64_TLS, and after checking for
7603 			 tls_get_addr for the TOC16 relocs.  */
7604 		      if (toc_ref == NULL)
7605 			toc_ref
7606 			  = bfd_zmalloc (toc->output_section->rawsize / 8);
7607 		      if (toc_ref == NULL)
7608 			goto err_free_rel;
7609 
7610 		      if (h != NULL)
7611 			value = h->root.u.def.value;
7612 		      else
7613 			value = sym->st_value;
7614 		      value += rel->r_addend;
7615 		      if (value % 8 != 0)
7616 			continue;
7617 		      BFD_ASSERT (value < toc->size
7618 				  && toc->output_offset % 8 == 0);
7619 		      toc_ref_index = (value + toc->output_offset) / 8;
7620 		      if (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
7621 			  || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
7622 			  || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD)
7623 			{
7624 			  toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
7625 			  continue;
7626 			}
7627 
7628 		      if (pass != 0 && toc_ref[toc_ref_index] == 0)
7629 			continue;
7630 
7631 		      tls_set = 0;
7632 		      tls_clear = 0;
7633 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
7634 		      break;
7635 
7636 		    case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
7637 		      if (pass == 0
7638 			  || sec != toc
7639 			  || toc_ref == NULL
7640 			  || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
7641 			continue;
7642 		      if (ok_tprel)
7643 			{
7644 			  /* IE -> LE */
7645 			  tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
7646 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
7647 			  break;
7648 			}
7649 		      continue;
7650 
7651 		    case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
7652 		      if (pass == 0
7653 			  || sec != toc
7654 			  || toc_ref == NULL
7655 			  || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
7656 			continue;
7657 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
7658 			  && (rel[1].r_info
7659 			      == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64))
7660 			  && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
7661 			{
7662 			  if (ok_tprel)
7663 			    /* GD -> LE */
7664 			    tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD;
7665 			  else
7666 			    /* GD -> IE */
7667 			    tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD | TLS_TPRELGD;
7668 			  tls_clear = TLS_GD;
7669 			}
7670 		      else
7671 			{
7672 			  if (!is_local)
7673 			    continue;
7674 
7675 			  /* LD -> LE */
7676 			  tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
7677 			  tls_clear = TLS_LD;
7678 			}
7679 		      break;
7680 
7681 		    default:
7682 		      continue;
7683 		    }
7684 
7685 		  if (pass == 0)
7686 		    {
7687 		      if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
7688 			  || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
7689 			continue;
7690 
7691 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
7692 			  && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
7693 						      htab->tls_get_addr,
7694 						      htab->tls_get_addr_fd))
7695 			{
7696 			  if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
7697 			    {
7698 			      /* Check for toc tls entries.  */
7699 			      unsigned char *toc_tls;
7700 			      int retval;
7701 
7702 			      retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, NULL, NULL,
7703 						     &locsyms,
7704 						     rel, ibfd);
7705 			      if (retval == 0)
7706 				goto err_free_rel;
7707 			      if (toc_tls != NULL)
7708 				{
7709 				  if ((*toc_tls & TLS_TLS) != 0
7710 				      && ((*toc_tls & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0))
7711 				    found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
7712 				  if (retval > 1)
7713 				    toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
7714 				}
7715 			    }
7716 			  continue;
7717 			}
7718 
7719 		      /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call.  We
7720 			 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
7721 			 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
7722 			 the entire optimization.  */
7723 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
7724 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
7725 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
7726 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
7727 		      ret = TRUE;
7728 		      goto err_free_rel;
7729 		    }
7730 
7731 		  /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
7732 		     without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
7733 		     found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
7734 		     marker for this symbol, then we either have a
7735 		     broken object file or an -mlongcall style
7736 		     indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
7737 		     Disable optimization in this case.  */
7738 		  if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
7739 		      && (tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0
7740 		      && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
7741 		      && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
7742 			  != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
7743 		    continue;
7744 
7745 		  if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
7746 		    {
7747 		      struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
7748 
7749 		      if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7750 			for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr->elf.plt.plist;
7751 			     ent != NULL;
7752 			     ent = ent->next)
7753 			  if (ent->addend == 0)
7754 			    break;
7755 
7756 		      if (ent == NULL && htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL)
7757 			for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist;
7758 			     ent != NULL;
7759 			     ent = ent->next)
7760 			  if (ent->addend == 0)
7761 			    break;
7762 
7763 		      if (ent != NULL
7764 			  && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7765 			ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
7766 		    }
7767 
7768 		  if (tls_clear == 0)
7769 		    continue;
7770 
7771 		  if ((tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0)
7772 		    {
7773 		      struct got_entry *ent;
7774 
7775 		      /* Adjust got entry for this reloc.  */
7776 		      if (h != NULL)
7777 			ent = h->got.glist;
7778 		      else
7779 			ent = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd)[r_symndx];
7780 
7781 		      for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7782 			if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
7783 			    && ent->owner == ibfd
7784 			    && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
7785 			  break;
7786 		      if (ent == NULL)
7787 			abort ();
7788 
7789 		      if (tls_set == 0)
7790 			{
7791 			  /* We managed to get rid of a got entry.  */
7792 			  if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
7793 			    ent->got.refcount -= 1;
7794 			}
7795 		    }
7796 		  else
7797 		    {
7798 		      /* If we got rid of a DTPMOD/DTPREL reloc pair then
7799 			 we'll lose one or two dyn relocs.  */
7800 		      if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
7801 					     NULL, h, sym))
7802 			return FALSE;
7803 
7804 		      if (tls_set == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD))
7805 			{
7806 			  if (!dec_dynrel_count ((rel + 1)->r_info, sec, info,
7807 						 NULL, h, sym))
7808 			    return FALSE;
7809 			}
7810 		    }
7811 
7812 		  *tls_mask |= tls_set;
7813 		  *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
7814 		}
7815 
7816 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7817 		free (relstart);
7818 	    }
7819 
7820 	if (locsyms != NULL
7821 	    && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
7822 	  {
7823 	    if (!info->keep_memory)
7824 	      free (locsyms);
7825 	    else
7826 	      elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents = (unsigned char *) locsyms;
7827 	  }
7828       }
7829 
7830   if (toc_ref != NULL)
7831     free (toc_ref);
7832   htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
7833   return TRUE;
7834 }
7835 
7836 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_edit_toc to adjust
7837    the values of any global symbols in a toc section that has been
7838    edited.  Globals in toc sections should be a rarity, so this function
7839    sets a flag if any are found in toc sections other than the one just
7840    edited, so that further hash table traversals can be avoided.  */
7841 
7842 struct adjust_toc_info
7843 {
7844   asection *toc;
7845   unsigned long *skip;
7846   bfd_boolean global_toc_syms;
7847 };
7848 
7849 enum toc_skip_enum { ref_from_discarded = 1, can_optimize = 2 };
7850 
7851 static bfd_boolean
7852 adjust_toc_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
7853 {
7854   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
7855   struct adjust_toc_info *toc_inf = (struct adjust_toc_info *) inf;
7856   unsigned long i;
7857 
7858   if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
7859       && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7860     return TRUE;
7861 
7862   eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
7863   if (eh->adjust_done)
7864     return TRUE;
7865 
7866   if (eh->elf.root.u.def.section == toc_inf->toc)
7867     {
7868       if (eh->elf.root.u.def.value > toc_inf->toc->rawsize)
7869 	i = toc_inf->toc->rawsize >> 3;
7870       else
7871 	i = eh->elf.root.u.def.value >> 3;
7872 
7873       if ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
7874 	{
7875 	  _bfd_error_handler
7876 	    (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"), eh->elf.root.root.string);
7877 	  do
7878 	    ++i;
7879 	  while ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0);
7880 	  eh->elf.root.u.def.value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
7881 	}
7882 
7883       eh->elf.root.u.def.value -= toc_inf->skip[i];
7884       eh->adjust_done = 1;
7885     }
7886   else if (strcmp (eh->elf.root.u.def.section->name, ".toc") == 0)
7887     toc_inf->global_toc_syms = TRUE;
7888 
7889   return TRUE;
7890 }
7891 
7892 /* Return TRUE iff INSN with a relocation of R_TYPE is one we expect
7893    on a _LO variety toc/got reloc.  */
7894 
7895 static bfd_boolean
7896 ok_lo_toc_insn (unsigned int insn, enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
7897 {
7898   return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */
7899 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7900 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7901 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7902 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7903 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7904 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7905 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7906 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7907 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7908 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7909 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7910 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7911 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7912 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7913 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq,lfq */
7914 	  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lxsd,lxssp,lfdp */
7915 	      /* Exclude lfqu by testing reloc.  If relocs are ever
7916 		 defined for the reduced D field in psq_lu then those
7917 		 will need testing too.  */
7918 	      && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
7919 	  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,lwa */
7920 	      && (insn & 1) == 0)
7921 	  || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 60u << 26 /* stfq */
7922 	  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* lxv,stx{v,sd,ssp},stfdp */
7923 	      /* Exclude stfqu.  psq_stu as above for psq_lu.  */
7924 	      && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
7925 	  || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stq */
7926 	      && (insn & 1) == 0));
7927 }
7928 
7929 /* Examine all relocs referencing .toc sections in order to remove
7930    unused .toc entries.  */
7931 
7932 bfd_boolean
7933 ppc64_elf_edit_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7934 {
7935   bfd *ibfd;
7936   struct adjust_toc_info toc_inf;
7937   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7938 
7939   htab->do_toc_opt = 1;
7940   toc_inf.global_toc_syms = TRUE;
7941   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7942     {
7943       asection *toc, *sec;
7944       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7945       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7946       Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *toc_relocs;
7947       unsigned long *skip, *drop;
7948       unsigned char *used;
7949       unsigned char *keep, last, some_unused;
7950 
7951       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7952 	continue;
7953 
7954       toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
7955       if (toc == NULL
7956 	  || toc->size == 0
7957 	  || toc->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS
7958 	  || discarded_section (toc))
7959 	continue;
7960 
7961       toc_relocs = NULL;
7962       local_syms = NULL;
7963       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7964 
7965       /* Look at sections dropped from the final link.  */
7966       skip = NULL;
7967       relstart = NULL;
7968       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7969 	{
7970 	  if (sec->reloc_count == 0
7971 	      || !discarded_section (sec)
7972 	      || get_opd_info (sec)
7973 	      || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
7974 	      || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
7975 	    continue;
7976 
7977 	  relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
7978 	  if (relstart == NULL)
7979 	    goto error_ret;
7980 
7981 	  /* Run through the relocs to see which toc entries might be
7982 	     unused.  */
7983 	  for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
7984 	    {
7985 	      enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7986 	      unsigned long r_symndx;
7987 	      asection *sym_sec;
7988 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7989 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7990 	      bfd_vma val;
7991 
7992 	      r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7993 	      switch (r_type)
7994 		{
7995 		default:
7996 		  continue;
7997 
7998 		case R_PPC64_TOC16:
7999 		case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8000 		case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8001 		case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8002 		case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8003 		case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8004 		  break;
8005 		}
8006 
8007 	      r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8008 	      if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8009 			      r_symndx, ibfd))
8010 		goto error_ret;
8011 
8012 	      if (sym_sec != toc)
8013 		continue;
8014 
8015 	      if (h != NULL)
8016 		val = h->root.u.def.value;
8017 	      else
8018 		val = sym->st_value;
8019 	      val += rel->r_addend;
8020 
8021 	      if (val >= toc->size)
8022 		continue;
8023 
8024 	      /* Anything in the toc ought to be aligned to 8 bytes.
8025 		 If not, don't mark as unused.  */
8026 	      if (val & 7)
8027 		continue;
8028 
8029 	      if (skip == NULL)
8030 		{
8031 		  skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8032 		  if (skip == NULL)
8033 		    goto error_ret;
8034 		}
8035 
8036 	      skip[val >> 3] = ref_from_discarded;
8037 	    }
8038 
8039 	  if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8040 	    free (relstart);
8041 	}
8042 
8043       /* For largetoc loads of address constants, we can convert
8044 	 .  addis rx,2,addr@got@ha
8045 	 .  ld ry,addr@got@l(rx)
8046 	 to
8047 	 .  addis rx,2,addr@toc@ha
8048 	 .  addi ry,rx,addr@toc@l
8049 	 when addr is within 2G of the toc pointer.  This then means
8050 	 that the word storing "addr" in the toc is no longer needed.  */
8051 
8052       if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_small_toc_reloc
8053 	  && toc->output_section->rawsize < (bfd_vma) 1 << 31
8054 	  && toc->reloc_count != 0)
8055 	{
8056 	  /* Read toc relocs.  */
8057 	  toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
8058 						  info->keep_memory);
8059 	  if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8060 	    goto error_ret;
8061 
8062 	  for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
8063 	    {
8064 	      enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8065 	      unsigned long r_symndx;
8066 	      asection *sym_sec;
8067 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8068 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8069 	      bfd_vma val, addr;
8070 
8071 	      r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8072 	      if (r_type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
8073 		continue;
8074 
8075 	      r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8076 	      if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8077 			      r_symndx, ibfd))
8078 		goto error_ret;
8079 
8080 	      if (sym_sec == NULL
8081 		  || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
8082 		  || discarded_section (sym_sec))
8083 		continue;
8084 
8085 	      if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8086 		continue;
8087 
8088 	      if (h != NULL)
8089 		{
8090 		  if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8091 		    continue;
8092 		  val = h->root.u.def.value;
8093 		}
8094 	      else
8095 		{
8096 		  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8097 		    continue;
8098 		  val = sym->st_value;
8099 		}
8100 	      val += rel->r_addend;
8101 	      val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
8102 
8103 	      /* We don't yet know the exact toc pointer value, but we
8104 		 know it will be somewhere in the toc section.  Don't
8105 		 optimize if the difference from any possible toc
8106 		 pointer is outside [ff..f80008000, 7fff7fff].  */
8107 	      addr = toc->output_section->vma + TOC_BASE_OFF;
8108 	      if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8109 		continue;
8110 
8111 	      addr = toc->output_section->vma + toc->output_section->rawsize;
8112 	      if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8113 		continue;
8114 
8115 	      if (skip == NULL)
8116 		{
8117 		  skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8118 		  if (skip == NULL)
8119 		    goto error_ret;
8120 		}
8121 
8122 	      skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8123 		|= can_optimize | ((rel - toc_relocs) << 2);
8124 	    }
8125 	}
8126 
8127       if (skip == NULL)
8128 	continue;
8129 
8130       used = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*used) * (toc->size + 7) / 8);
8131       if (used == NULL)
8132 	{
8133 	error_ret:
8134 	  if (local_syms != NULL
8135 	      && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
8136 	    free (local_syms);
8137 	  if (sec != NULL
8138 	      && relstart != NULL
8139 	      && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8140 	    free (relstart);
8141 	  if (toc_relocs != NULL
8142 	      && elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
8143 	    free (toc_relocs);
8144 	  if (skip != NULL)
8145 	    free (skip);
8146 	  return FALSE;
8147 	}
8148 
8149       /* Now check all kept sections that might reference the toc.
8150 	 Check the toc itself last.  */
8151       for (sec = (ibfd->sections == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8152 		  : ibfd->sections);
8153 	   sec != NULL;
8154 	   sec = (sec == toc ? NULL
8155 		  : sec->next == NULL ? toc
8156 		  : sec->next == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8157 		  : sec->next))
8158 	{
8159 	  int repeat;
8160 
8161 	  if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8162 	      || discarded_section (sec)
8163 	      || get_opd_info (sec)
8164 	      || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8165 	      || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8166 	    continue;
8167 
8168 	  relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8169 						info->keep_memory);
8170 	  if (relstart == NULL)
8171 	    {
8172 	      free (used);
8173 	      goto error_ret;
8174 	    }
8175 
8176 	  /* Mark toc entries referenced as used.  */
8177 	  do
8178 	    {
8179 	      repeat = 0;
8180 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8181 		{
8182 		  enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8183 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
8184 		  asection *sym_sec;
8185 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8186 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8187 		  bfd_vma val;
8188 		  enum {no_check, check_lo, check_ha} insn_check;
8189 
8190 		  r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8191 		  switch (r_type)
8192 		    {
8193 		    default:
8194 		      insn_check = no_check;
8195 		      break;
8196 
8197 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8198 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8199 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8200 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8201 		    case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
8202 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8203 		      insn_check = check_ha;
8204 		      break;
8205 
8206 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8207 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8208 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
8209 		    case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
8210 		    case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
8211 		    case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
8212 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8213 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8214 		      insn_check = check_lo;
8215 		      break;
8216 		    }
8217 
8218 		  if (insn_check != no_check)
8219 		    {
8220 		      bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
8221 		      unsigned char buf[4];
8222 		      unsigned int insn;
8223 
8224 		      if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf, off, 4))
8225 			{
8226 			  free (used);
8227 			  goto error_ret;
8228 			}
8229 		      insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
8230 		      if (insn_check == check_lo
8231 			  ? !ok_lo_toc_insn (insn, r_type)
8232 			  : ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
8233 			     != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
8234 			{
8235 			  char str[12];
8236 
8237 			  ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->unexpected_toc_insn = 1;
8238 			  sprintf (str, "%#08x", insn);
8239 			  info->callbacks->einfo
8240 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
8241 			    (_("%H: toc optimization is not supported for"
8242 			       " %s instruction\n"),
8243 			     ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset & ~3, str);
8244 			}
8245 		    }
8246 
8247 		  switch (r_type)
8248 		    {
8249 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8250 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8251 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8252 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8253 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8254 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8255 		      /* In case we're taking addresses of toc entries.  */
8256 		    case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
8257 		      break;
8258 
8259 		    default:
8260 		      continue;
8261 		    }
8262 
8263 		  r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8264 		  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8265 				  r_symndx, ibfd))
8266 		    {
8267 		      free (used);
8268 		      goto error_ret;
8269 		    }
8270 
8271 		  if (sym_sec != toc)
8272 		    continue;
8273 
8274 		  if (h != NULL)
8275 		    val = h->root.u.def.value;
8276 		  else
8277 		    val = sym->st_value;
8278 		  val += rel->r_addend;
8279 
8280 		  if (val >= toc->size)
8281 		    continue;
8282 
8283 		  if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
8284 		    {
8285 		      bfd_vma off;
8286 		      unsigned char opc;
8287 
8288 		      switch (r_type)
8289 			{
8290 			case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8291 			  break;
8292 
8293 			case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8294 			  off = rel->r_offset;
8295 			  off += (bfd_big_endian (ibfd) ? -2 : 3);
8296 			  if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, &opc,
8297 							 off, 1))
8298 			    {
8299 			      free (used);
8300 			      goto error_ret;
8301 			    }
8302 			  if ((opc & (0x3f << 2)) == (58u << 2))
8303 			    break;
8304 			  /* Fall through.  */
8305 
8306 			default:
8307 			  /* Wrong sort of reloc, or not a ld.  We may
8308 			     as well clear ref_from_discarded too.  */
8309 			  skip[val >> 3] = 0;
8310 			}
8311 		    }
8312 
8313 		  if (sec != toc)
8314 		    used[val >> 3] = 1;
8315 		  /* For the toc section, we only mark as used if this
8316 		     entry itself isn't unused.  */
8317 		  else if ((used[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8318 			    || !(skip[rel->r_offset >> 3] & ref_from_discarded))
8319 			   && !used[val >> 3])
8320 		    {
8321 		      /* Do all the relocs again, to catch reference
8322 			 chains.  */
8323 		      repeat = 1;
8324 		      used[val >> 3] = 1;
8325 		    }
8326 		}
8327 	    }
8328 	  while (repeat);
8329 
8330 	  if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8331 	    free (relstart);
8332 	}
8333 
8334       /* Merge the used and skip arrays.  Assume that TOC
8335 	 doublewords not appearing as either used or unused belong
8336 	 to an entry more than one doubleword in size.  */
8337       for (drop = skip, keep = used, last = 0, some_unused = 0;
8338 	   drop < skip + (toc->size + 7) / 8;
8339 	   ++drop, ++keep)
8340 	{
8341 	  if (*keep)
8342 	    {
8343 	      *drop &= ~ref_from_discarded;
8344 	      if ((*drop & can_optimize) != 0)
8345 		some_unused = 1;
8346 	      last = 0;
8347 	    }
8348 	  else if ((*drop & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
8349 	    {
8350 	      some_unused = 1;
8351 	      last = ref_from_discarded;
8352 	    }
8353 	  else
8354 	    *drop = last;
8355 	}
8356 
8357       free (used);
8358 
8359       if (some_unused)
8360 	{
8361 	  bfd_byte *contents, *src;
8362 	  unsigned long off;
8363 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8364 	  bfd_boolean local_toc_syms = FALSE;
8365 
8366 	  /* Shuffle the toc contents, and at the same time convert the
8367 	     skip array from booleans into offsets.  */
8368 	  if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, toc, &contents))
8369 	    goto error_ret;
8370 
8371 	  elf_section_data (toc)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
8372 
8373 	  for (src = contents, off = 0, drop = skip;
8374 	       src < contents + toc->size;
8375 	       src += 8, ++drop)
8376 	    {
8377 	      if ((*drop & (can_optimize | ref_from_discarded)) != 0)
8378 		off += 8;
8379 	      else if (off != 0)
8380 		{
8381 		  *drop = off;
8382 		  memcpy (src - off, src, 8);
8383 		}
8384 	    }
8385 	  *drop = off;
8386 	  toc->rawsize = toc->size;
8387 	  toc->size = src - contents - off;
8388 
8389 	  /* Adjust addends for relocs against the toc section sym,
8390 	     and optimize any accesses we can.  */
8391 	  for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
8392 	    {
8393 	      if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8394 		  || discarded_section (sec))
8395 		continue;
8396 
8397 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8398 						    info->keep_memory);
8399 	      if (relstart == NULL)
8400 		goto error_ret;
8401 
8402 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8403 		{
8404 		  enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8405 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
8406 		  asection *sym_sec;
8407 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8408 		  bfd_vma val;
8409 
8410 		  r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8411 		  switch (r_type)
8412 		    {
8413 		    default:
8414 		      continue;
8415 
8416 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8417 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8418 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8419 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8420 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8421 		    case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8422 		    case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
8423 		      break;
8424 		    }
8425 
8426 		  r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8427 		  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8428 				  r_symndx, ibfd))
8429 		    goto error_ret;
8430 
8431 		  if (sym_sec != toc)
8432 		    continue;
8433 
8434 		  if (h != NULL)
8435 		    val = h->root.u.def.value;
8436 		  else
8437 		    {
8438 		      val = sym->st_value;
8439 		      if (val != 0)
8440 			local_toc_syms = TRUE;
8441 		    }
8442 
8443 		  val += rel->r_addend;
8444 
8445 		  if (val > toc->rawsize)
8446 		    val = toc->rawsize;
8447 		  else if ((skip[val >> 3] & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
8448 		    continue;
8449 		  else if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
8450 		    {
8451 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *tocrel
8452 			= toc_relocs + (skip[val >> 3] >> 2);
8453 		      unsigned long tsym = ELF64_R_SYM (tocrel->r_info);
8454 
8455 		      switch (r_type)
8456 			{
8457 			case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8458 			  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
8459 			  break;
8460 
8461 			case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8462 			  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT);
8463 			  break;
8464 
8465 			default:
8466 			  if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
8467 			    ppc_howto_init ();
8468 			  info->callbacks->einfo
8469 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
8470 			    (_("%H: %s references "
8471 			       "optimized away TOC entry\n"),
8472 			     ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
8473 			     ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
8474 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8475 			  goto error_ret;
8476 			}
8477 		      rel->r_addend = tocrel->r_addend;
8478 		      elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
8479 		      continue;
8480 		    }
8481 
8482 		  if (h != NULL || sym->st_value != 0)
8483 		    continue;
8484 
8485 		  rel->r_addend -= skip[val >> 3];
8486 		  elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
8487 		}
8488 
8489 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8490 		free (relstart);
8491 	    }
8492 
8493 	  /* We shouldn't have local or global symbols defined in the TOC,
8494 	     but handle them anyway.  */
8495 	  if (local_syms != NULL)
8496 	    for (sym = local_syms;
8497 		 sym < local_syms + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8498 		 ++sym)
8499 	      if (sym->st_value != 0
8500 		  && bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx) == toc)
8501 		{
8502 		  unsigned long i;
8503 
8504 		  if (sym->st_value > toc->rawsize)
8505 		    i = toc->rawsize >> 3;
8506 		  else
8507 		    i = sym->st_value >> 3;
8508 
8509 		  if ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
8510 		    {
8511 		      if (local_toc_syms)
8512 			_bfd_error_handler
8513 			  (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"),
8514 			   bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym, NULL));
8515 		      do
8516 			++i;
8517 		      while ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)));
8518 		      sym->st_value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
8519 		    }
8520 
8521 		  sym->st_value -= skip[i];
8522 		  symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
8523 		}
8524 
8525 	  /* Adjust any global syms defined in this toc input section.  */
8526 	  if (toc_inf.global_toc_syms)
8527 	    {
8528 	      toc_inf.toc = toc;
8529 	      toc_inf.skip = skip;
8530 	      toc_inf.global_toc_syms = FALSE;
8531 	      elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_toc_syms,
8532 				      &toc_inf);
8533 	    }
8534 
8535 	  if (toc->reloc_count != 0)
8536 	    {
8537 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
8538 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
8539 	      bfd_size_type sz;
8540 
8541 	      /* Remove unused toc relocs, and adjust those we keep.  */
8542 	      if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8543 		toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
8544 							info->keep_memory);
8545 	      if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8546 		goto error_ret;
8547 
8548 	      wrel = toc_relocs;
8549 	      for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
8550 		if ((skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8551 		     & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) == 0)
8552 		  {
8553 		    wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset - skip[rel->r_offset >> 3];
8554 		    wrel->r_info = rel->r_info;
8555 		    wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8556 		    ++wrel;
8557 		  }
8558 		else if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, toc, info,
8559 					    &local_syms, NULL, NULL))
8560 		  goto error_ret;
8561 
8562 	      elf_section_data (toc)->relocs = toc_relocs;
8563 	      toc->reloc_count = wrel - toc_relocs;
8564 	      rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (toc);
8565 	      sz = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
8566 	      rel_hdr->sh_size = toc->reloc_count * sz;
8567 	    }
8568 	}
8569       else if (toc_relocs != NULL
8570 	       && elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
8571 	free (toc_relocs);
8572 
8573       if (local_syms != NULL
8574 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
8575 	{
8576 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
8577 	    free (local_syms);
8578 	  else
8579 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
8580 	}
8581       free (skip);
8582     }
8583 
8584   return TRUE;
8585 }
8586 
8587 /* Return true iff input section I references the TOC using
8588    instructions limited to +/-32k offsets.  */
8589 
8590 bfd_boolean
8591 ppc64_elf_has_small_toc_reloc (asection *i)
8592 {
8593   return (is_ppc64_elf (i->owner)
8594 	  && ppc64_elf_tdata (i->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc);
8595 }
8596 
8597 /* Allocate space for one GOT entry.  */
8598 
8599 static void
8600 allocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8601 	      struct bfd_link_info *info,
8602 	      struct got_entry *gent)
8603 {
8604   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
8605   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
8606   int entsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)
8607 		 ? 16 : 8);
8608   int rentsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & TLS_GD
8609 		  ? 2 : 1) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
8610   asection *got = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->got;
8611 
8612   gent->got.offset = got->size;
8613   got->size += entsize;
8614 
8615   if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8616     {
8617       htab->elf.irelplt->size += rentsize;
8618       htab->got_reli_size += rentsize;
8619     }
8620   else if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
8621 	     && !((gent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
8622 		  && bfd_link_executable (info)
8623 		  && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
8624 	    || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8625 		&& h->dynindx != -1
8626 		&& !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
8627 	   && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
8628     {
8629       asection *relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->relgot;
8630       relgot->size += rentsize;
8631     }
8632 }
8633 
8634 /* This function merges got entries in the same toc group.  */
8635 
8636 static void
8637 merge_got_entries (struct got_entry **pent)
8638 {
8639   struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
8640 
8641   for (ent = *pent; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
8642     if (!ent->is_indirect)
8643       for (ent2 = ent->next; ent2 != NULL; ent2 = ent2->next)
8644 	if (!ent2->is_indirect
8645 	    && ent2->addend == ent->addend
8646 	    && ent2->tls_type == ent->tls_type
8647 	    && elf_gp (ent2->owner) == elf_gp (ent->owner))
8648 	  {
8649 	    ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
8650 	    ent2->got.ent = ent;
8651 	  }
8652 }
8653 
8654 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense.  */
8655 
8656 static bfd_boolean
8657 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
8658 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
8659 {
8660   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
8661 
8662   if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
8663       && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
8664 	   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8665 	  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
8666       && h->dynindx == -1
8667       && !h->forced_local
8668       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
8669     return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
8670   return TRUE;
8671 }
8672 
8673 /* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
8674    dynamic relocs.  */
8675 
8676 static bfd_boolean
8677 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8678 {
8679   struct bfd_link_info *info;
8680   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
8681   asection *s;
8682   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
8683   struct got_entry **pgent, *gent;
8684 
8685   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
8686     return TRUE;
8687 
8688   info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
8689   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
8690   if (htab == NULL)
8691     return FALSE;
8692 
8693   eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
8694   /* Run through the TLS GD got entries first if we're changing them
8695      to TPREL.  */
8696   if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPRELGD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPRELGD))
8697     for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
8698       if (gent->got.refcount > 0
8699 	  && (gent->tls_type & TLS_GD) != 0)
8700 	{
8701 	  /* This was a GD entry that has been converted to TPREL.  If
8702 	     there happens to be a TPREL entry we can use that one.  */
8703 	  struct got_entry *ent;
8704 	  for (ent = h->got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
8705 	    if (ent->got.refcount > 0
8706 		&& (ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
8707 		&& ent->addend == gent->addend
8708 		&& ent->owner == gent->owner)
8709 	      {
8710 		gent->got.refcount = 0;
8711 		break;
8712 	      }
8713 
8714 	  /* If not, then we'll be using our own TPREL entry.  */
8715 	  if (gent->got.refcount != 0)
8716 	    gent->tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
8717 	}
8718 
8719   /* Remove any list entry that won't generate a word in the GOT before
8720      we call merge_got_entries.  Otherwise we risk merging to empty
8721      entries.  */
8722   pgent = &h->got.glist;
8723   while ((gent = *pgent) != NULL)
8724     if (gent->got.refcount > 0)
8725       {
8726 	if ((gent->tls_type & TLS_LD) != 0
8727 	    && !h->def_dynamic)
8728 	  {
8729 	    ppc64_tlsld_got (gent->owner)->got.refcount += 1;
8730 	    *pgent = gent->next;
8731 	  }
8732 	else
8733 	  pgent = &gent->next;
8734       }
8735     else
8736       *pgent = gent->next;
8737 
8738   if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
8739     merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
8740 
8741   for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
8742     if (!gent->is_indirect)
8743       {
8744 	/* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
8745 	if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
8746 	  return FALSE;
8747 
8748 	if (!is_ppc64_elf (gent->owner))
8749 	  abort ();
8750 
8751 	allocate_got (h, info, gent);
8752       }
8753 
8754   /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
8755      IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables.  */
8756   if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8757       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8758     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
8759 
8760   /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local.  */
8761   else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
8762 	   && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
8763     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
8764 
8765   /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
8766      visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so.  */
8767   else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
8768     eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
8769 
8770   if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8771     {
8772       struct elf_dyn_relocs *p, **pp;
8773 
8774       /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
8775 	 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to
8776 	 be defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case,
8777 	 discard space for relocs that have become local due to symbol
8778 	 visibility changes.  */
8779 
8780       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8781 	{
8782 	  /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call
8783 	     insn, or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that
8784 	     can be generated via assembly.  We want calls to
8785 	     protected symbols to resolve directly to the function
8786 	     rather than going via the plt.  If people want function
8787 	     pointer comparisons to work as expected then they should
8788 	     avoid writing weird assembly.  */
8789 	  if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
8790 	    {
8791 	      for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
8792 		{
8793 		  p->count -= p->pc_count;
8794 		  p->pc_count = 0;
8795 		  if (p->count == 0)
8796 		    *pp = p->next;
8797 		  else
8798 		    pp = &p->next;
8799 		}
8800 	    }
8801 
8802 	  if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8803 	    {
8804 	      /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
8805 	      if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
8806 		return FALSE;
8807 	    }
8808 	}
8809       else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8810 	{
8811 	  /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
8812 	     symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
8813 	     dynamic.  */
8814 	  if (h->dynamic_adjusted
8815 	      && !h->def_regular
8816 	      && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
8817 	    {
8818 	      /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
8819 	      if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
8820 		return FALSE;
8821 
8822 	      if (h->dynindx == -1)
8823 		eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
8824 	    }
8825 	  else
8826 	    eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
8827 	}
8828 
8829       /* Finally, allocate space.  */
8830       for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
8831 	{
8832 	  asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
8833 	  if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8834 	    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8835 	  sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
8836 	}
8837     }
8838 
8839   /* We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
8840      a) is dynamic, or
8841      b) is an ifunc, or
8842      c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
8843      d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically.  */
8844   if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
8845       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
8846       || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
8847       || (h->needs_plt
8848 	  && h->def_regular
8849 	  && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8850 	  && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
8851 	  && (((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask
8852 	      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
8853     {
8854       struct plt_entry *pent;
8855       bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
8856       for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
8857 	if (pent->plt.refcount > 0)
8858 	  {
8859 	    if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8860 		|| h->dynindx == -1)
8861 	      {
8862 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8863 		  {
8864 		    s = htab->elf.iplt;
8865 		    pent->plt.offset = s->size;
8866 		    s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
8867 		    s = htab->elf.irelplt;
8868 		  }
8869 		else
8870 		  {
8871 		    s = htab->pltlocal;
8872 		    pent->plt.offset = s->size;
8873 		    s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
8874 		    s = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
8875 		  }
8876 	      }
8877 	    else
8878 	      {
8879 		/* If this is the first .plt entry, make room for the special
8880 		   first entry.  */
8881 		s = htab->elf.splt;
8882 		if (s->size == 0)
8883 		  s->size += PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
8884 
8885 		pent->plt.offset = s->size;
8886 
8887 		/* Make room for this entry.  */
8888 		s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
8889 
8890 		/* Make room for the .glink code.  */
8891 		s = htab->glink;
8892 		if (s->size == 0)
8893 		  s->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab);
8894 		if (htab->opd_abi)
8895 		  {
8896 		    /* We need bigger stubs past index 32767.  */
8897 		    if (s->size >= GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + 32768*2*4)
8898 		      s->size += 4;
8899 		    s->size += 2*4;
8900 		  }
8901 		else
8902 		  s->size += 4;
8903 
8904 		/* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
8905 		s = htab->elf.srelplt;
8906 	      }
8907 	    if (s != NULL)
8908 	      s->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
8909 	    doneone = TRUE;
8910 	  }
8911 	else
8912 	  pent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
8913       if (!doneone)
8914 	{
8915 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
8916 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
8917 	}
8918     }
8919   else
8920     {
8921       h->plt.plist = NULL;
8922       h->needs_plt = 0;
8923     }
8924 
8925   return TRUE;
8926 }
8927 
8928 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
8929 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
8930 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
8931 
8932 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
8933    to set up space for global entry stubs.  These are put in glink,
8934    after the branch table.  */
8935 
8936 static bfd_boolean
8937 size_global_entry_stubs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8938 {
8939   struct bfd_link_info *info;
8940   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
8941   struct plt_entry *pent;
8942   asection *s, *plt;
8943 
8944   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
8945     return TRUE;
8946 
8947   if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
8948     return TRUE;
8949 
8950   if (h->def_regular)
8951     return TRUE;
8952 
8953   info = inf;
8954   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
8955   if (htab == NULL)
8956     return FALSE;
8957 
8958   s = htab->global_entry;
8959   plt = htab->elf.splt;
8960   for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
8961     if (pent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
8962 	&& pent->addend == 0)
8963       {
8964 	/* For ELFv2, if this symbol is not defined in a regular file
8965 	   and we are not generating a shared library or pie, then we
8966 	   need to define the symbol in the executable on a call stub.
8967 	   This is to avoid text relocations.  */
8968 	bfd_vma off, stub_align, stub_off, stub_size;
8969 	unsigned int align_power;
8970 
8971 	stub_size = 16;
8972 	stub_off = s->size;
8973 	if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
8974 	  align_power = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
8975 	else
8976 	  align_power = -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
8977 	/* Setting section alignment is delayed until we know it is
8978 	   non-empty.  Otherwise the .text output section will be
8979 	   aligned at least to plt_stub_align even when no global
8980 	   entry stubs are needed.  */
8981 	if (s->alignment_power < align_power)
8982 	  s->alignment_power = align_power;
8983 	stub_align = (bfd_vma) 1 << align_power;
8984 	if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0
8985 	    || ((((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)
8986 		 - (stub_off & -stub_align))
8987 		> ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)))
8988 	  stub_off = (stub_off + stub_align - 1) & -stub_align;
8989 	off = pent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
8990 	off -= stub_off + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
8991 	/* Note that for --plt-stub-align negative we have a possible
8992 	   dependency between stub offset and size.  Break that
8993 	   dependency by assuming the max stub size when calculating
8994 	   the stub offset.  */
8995 	if (PPC_HA (off) == 0)
8996 	  stub_size -= 4;
8997 	h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
8998 	h->root.u.def.section = s;
8999 	h->root.u.def.value = stub_off;
9000 	s->size = stub_off + stub_size;
9001 	break;
9002       }
9003   return TRUE;
9004 }
9005 
9006 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
9007    read-only sections.  */
9008 
9009 static bfd_boolean
9010 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9011 {
9012   asection *sec;
9013 
9014   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9015     return TRUE;
9016 
9017   sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
9018   if (sec != NULL)
9019     {
9020       struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9021 
9022       info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9023       info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT'"
9024 				" in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
9025 			      sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
9026 
9027       /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal.  */
9028       return FALSE;
9029     }
9030   return TRUE;
9031 }
9032 
9033 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
9034 
9035 static bfd_boolean
9036 ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9037 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9038 {
9039   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9040   bfd *dynobj;
9041   asection *s;
9042   bfd_boolean relocs;
9043   bfd *ibfd;
9044   struct got_entry *first_tlsld;
9045 
9046   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9047   if (htab == NULL)
9048     return FALSE;
9049 
9050   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9051   if (dynobj == NULL)
9052     abort ();
9053 
9054   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9055     {
9056       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
9057       if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
9058 	{
9059 	  s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
9060 	  if (s == NULL)
9061 	    abort ();
9062 	  s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9063 	  s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9064 	}
9065     }
9066 
9067   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
9068      relocs.  */
9069   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9070     {
9071       struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
9072       struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
9073       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
9074       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
9075       unsigned char *lgot_masks;
9076       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9077       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9078 
9079       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9080 	continue;
9081 
9082       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9083 	{
9084 	  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
9085 
9086 	  for (p = elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9087 	    {
9088 	      if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
9089 		  && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
9090 		{
9091 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
9092 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
9093 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
9094 		     the relocs too.  */
9095 		}
9096 	      else if (p->count != 0)
9097 		{
9098 		  asection *srel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9099 		  if (p->ifunc)
9100 		    srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
9101 		  srel->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9102 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
9103 		    info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9104 		}
9105 	    }
9106 	}
9107 
9108       lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9109       if (!lgot_ents)
9110 	continue;
9111 
9112       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9113       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9114       end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
9115       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
9116       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9117       lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
9118       s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9119       for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
9120 	{
9121 	  struct got_entry **pent, *ent;
9122 
9123 	  pent = lgot_ents;
9124 	  while ((ent = *pent) != NULL)
9125 	    if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
9126 	      {
9127 		if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_LD) != 0)
9128 		  {
9129 		    ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd)->got.refcount += 1;
9130 		    *pent = ent->next;
9131 		  }
9132 		else
9133 		  {
9134 		    unsigned int ent_size = 8;
9135 		    unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9136 
9137 		    ent->got.offset = s->size;
9138 		    if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
9139 		      {
9140 			ent_size *= 2;
9141 			rel_size *= 2;
9142 		      }
9143 		    s->size += ent_size;
9144 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
9145 		      {
9146 			htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
9147 			htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
9148 		      }
9149 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
9150 			     && !((ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
9151 				  && bfd_link_executable (info)))
9152 		      {
9153 			asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
9154 			srel->size += rel_size;
9155 		      }
9156 		    pent = &ent->next;
9157 		  }
9158 	      }
9159 	    else
9160 	      *pent = ent->next;
9161 	}
9162 
9163       /* Allocate space for plt calls to local syms.  */
9164       lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
9165       for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
9166 	{
9167 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
9168 
9169 	  for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9170 	    if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
9171 	      {
9172 		if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
9173 		  {
9174 		    s = htab->elf.iplt;
9175 		    ent->plt.offset = s->size;
9176 		    s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9177 		    htab->elf.irelplt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9178 		  }
9179 		else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
9180 			 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
9181 		  ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9182 		else
9183 		  {
9184 		    s = htab->pltlocal;
9185 		    ent->plt.offset = s->size;
9186 		    s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9187 		    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9188 		      htab->relpltlocal->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9189 		  }
9190 	      }
9191 	    else
9192 	      ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9193 	}
9194     }
9195 
9196   /* Allocate global sym .plt and .got entries, and space for global
9197      sym dynamic relocs.  */
9198   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
9199 
9200   if (!htab->opd_abi && !bfd_link_pic (info))
9201     elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, size_global_entry_stubs, info);
9202 
9203   first_tlsld = NULL;
9204   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9205     {
9206       struct got_entry *ent;
9207 
9208       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9209 	continue;
9210 
9211       ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
9212       if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
9213 	{
9214 	  if (!htab->do_multi_toc && first_tlsld != NULL)
9215 	    {
9216 	      ent->is_indirect = TRUE;
9217 	      ent->got.ent = first_tlsld;
9218 	    }
9219 	  else
9220 	    {
9221 	      if (first_tlsld == NULL)
9222 		first_tlsld = ent;
9223 	      s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9224 	      ent->got.offset = s->size;
9225 	      ent->owner = ibfd;
9226 	      s->size += 16;
9227 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9228 		{
9229 		  asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
9230 		  srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9231 		}
9232 	    }
9233 	}
9234       else
9235 	ent->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9236     }
9237 
9238   /* We now have determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
9239      Allocate memory for them.  */
9240   relocs = FALSE;
9241   for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9242     {
9243       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
9244 	continue;
9245 
9246       if (s == htab->brlt || s == htab->relbrlt)
9247 	/* These haven't been allocated yet;  don't strip.  */
9248 	continue;
9249       else if (s == htab->elf.sgot
9250 	       || s == htab->elf.splt
9251 	       || s == htab->elf.iplt
9252 	       || s == htab->pltlocal
9253 	       || s == htab->glink
9254 	       || s == htab->global_entry
9255 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
9256 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9257 	{
9258 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
9259 	     comment below.  */
9260 	}
9261       else if (s == htab->glink_eh_frame)
9262 	{
9263 	  if (!bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
9264 	    /* Not sized yet.  */
9265 	    continue;
9266 	}
9267       else if (CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".rela"))
9268 	{
9269 	  if (s->size != 0)
9270 	    {
9271 	      if (s != htab->elf.srelplt)
9272 		relocs = TRUE;
9273 
9274 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
9275 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
9276 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
9277 	    }
9278 	}
9279       else
9280 	{
9281 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
9282 	  continue;
9283 	}
9284 
9285       if (s->size == 0)
9286 	{
9287 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
9288 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
9289 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
9290 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
9291 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
9292 	     sections.  The linker does that before
9293 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
9294 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
9295 	     into these sections.  */
9296 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
9297 	  continue;
9298 	}
9299 
9300       if (bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
9301 	_bfd_error_handler (_("warning: discarding dynamic section %s"),
9302 			    s->name);
9303 
9304       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
9305 	continue;
9306 
9307       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  We use bfd_zalloc
9308 	 here in case unused entries are not reclaimed before the
9309 	 section's contents are written out.  This should not happen,
9310 	 but this way if it does we get a R_PPC64_NONE reloc in .rela
9311 	 sections instead of garbage.
9312 	 We also rely on the section contents being zero when writing
9313 	 the GOT and .dynrelro.  */
9314       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
9315       if (s->contents == NULL)
9316 	return FALSE;
9317     }
9318 
9319   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9320     {
9321       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9322 	continue;
9323 
9324       s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9325       if (s != NULL && s != htab->elf.sgot)
9326 	{
9327 	  if (s->size == 0)
9328 	    s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
9329 	  else
9330 	    {
9331 	      s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
9332 	      if (s->contents == NULL)
9333 		return FALSE;
9334 	    }
9335 	}
9336       s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
9337       if (s != NULL)
9338 	{
9339 	  if (s->size == 0)
9340 	    s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
9341 	  else
9342 	    {
9343 	      s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
9344 	      if (s->contents == NULL)
9345 		return FALSE;
9346 	      relocs = TRUE;
9347 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
9348 	    }
9349 	}
9350     }
9351 
9352   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9353     {
9354       bfd_boolean tls_opt;
9355 
9356       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
9357 	 values later, in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
9358 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
9359 	 the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
9360 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
9361 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
9362   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
9363 
9364       if (bfd_link_executable (info))
9365 	{
9366 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
9367 	    return FALSE;
9368 	}
9369 
9370       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
9371 	{
9372 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
9373 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
9374 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
9375 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0)
9376 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_GLINK, 0))
9377 	    return FALSE;
9378 	}
9379 
9380       if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && abiversion (output_bfd) <= 1)
9381 	{
9382 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPD, 0)
9383 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPDSZ, 0))
9384 	    return FALSE;
9385 	}
9386 
9387       tls_opt = (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
9388 		 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
9389 		 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL);
9390       if (tls_opt || !htab->opd_abi)
9391 	{
9392 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPT, tls_opt ? PPC64_OPT_TLS : 0))
9393 	    return FALSE;
9394 	}
9395 
9396       if (relocs)
9397 	{
9398 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
9399 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
9400 	      || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)))
9401 	    return FALSE;
9402 
9403 	  /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section,
9404 	     then we need a DT_TEXTREL entry.  */
9405 	  if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
9406 	    elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, maybe_set_textrel, info);
9407 
9408 	  if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
9409 	    {
9410 	      if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
9411 		return FALSE;
9412 	    }
9413 	}
9414     }
9415 #undef add_dynamic_entry
9416 
9417   return TRUE;
9418 }
9419 
9420 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
9421 
9422 static bfd_boolean
9423 ppc64_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
9424 {
9425   if (h->plt.plist != NULL
9426       && !h->def_regular
9427       && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
9428     return FALSE;
9429 
9430   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
9431 }
9432 
9433 /* Determine the type of stub needed, if any, for a call.  */
9434 
9435 static inline enum ppc_stub_type
9436 ppc_type_of_stub (asection *input_sec,
9437 		  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
9438 		  struct ppc_link_hash_entry **hash,
9439 		  struct plt_entry **plt_ent,
9440 		  bfd_vma destination,
9441 		  unsigned long local_off)
9442 {
9443   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h = *hash;
9444   bfd_vma location;
9445   bfd_vma branch_offset;
9446   bfd_vma max_branch_offset;
9447   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9448 
9449   if (h != NULL)
9450     {
9451       struct plt_entry *ent;
9452       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = h;
9453       if (h->oh != NULL
9454 	  && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
9455 	{
9456 	  fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
9457 	  *hash = fdh;
9458 	}
9459 
9460       for (ent = fdh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9461 	if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
9462 	    && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9463 	  {
9464 	    *plt_ent = ent;
9465 	    return ppc_stub_plt_call;
9466 	  }
9467 
9468       /* Here, we know we don't have a plt entry.  If we don't have a
9469 	 either a defined function descriptor or a defined entry symbol
9470 	 in a regular object file, then it is pointless trying to make
9471 	 any other type of stub.  */
9472       if (!is_static_defined (&fdh->elf)
9473 	  && !is_static_defined (&h->elf))
9474 	return ppc_stub_none;
9475     }
9476   else if (elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) != NULL)
9477     {
9478       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_sec->owner);
9479       struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
9480 	elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9481       unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9482 
9483       if (local_plt[r_symndx] != NULL)
9484 	{
9485 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
9486 
9487 	  for (ent = local_plt[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9488 	    if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
9489 		&& ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9490 	      {
9491 		*plt_ent = ent;
9492 		return ppc_stub_plt_call;
9493 	      }
9494 	}
9495     }
9496 
9497   /* Determine where the call point is.  */
9498   location = (input_sec->output_offset
9499 	      + input_sec->output_section->vma
9500 	      + rel->r_offset);
9501 
9502   branch_offset = destination - location;
9503   r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9504 
9505   /* Determine if a long branch stub is needed.  */
9506   max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
9507   if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
9508       || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
9509       || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9510     max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
9511 
9512   if (branch_offset + max_branch_offset >= 2 * max_branch_offset - local_off)
9513     /* We need a stub.  Figure out whether a long_branch or plt_branch
9514        is needed later.  */
9515     return ppc_stub_long_branch;
9516 
9517   return ppc_stub_none;
9518 }
9519 
9520 /* Gets the address of a label (1:) in r11 and builds an offset in r12,
9521    then adds it to r11 (LOAD false) or loads r12 from r11+r12 (LOAD true).
9522    .	mflr	%r12
9523    .	bcl	20,31,1f
9524    .1:	mflr	%r11
9525    .	mtlr	%r12
9526    .	lis	%r12,xxx-1b@highest
9527    .	ori	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
9528    .	sldi	%r12,%r12,32
9529    .	oris	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
9530    .	ori	%r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
9531    .	add/ldx	%r12,%r11,%r12  */
9532 
9533 static bfd_byte *
9534 build_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, bfd_boolean load)
9535 {
9536   bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R12, p);
9537   p += 4;
9538   bfd_put_32 (abfd, BCL_20_31, p);
9539   p += 4;
9540   bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R11, p);
9541   p += 4;
9542   bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R12, p);
9543   p += 4;
9544   if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9545     {
9546       if (load)
9547 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
9548       else
9549 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
9550       p += 4;
9551     }
9552   else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
9553     {
9554       bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDIS_R12_R11 + PPC_HA (off), p);
9555       p += 4;
9556       if (load)
9557 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
9558       else
9559 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
9560       p += 4;
9561     }
9562   else
9563     {
9564       if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
9565 	{
9566 	  bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
9567 	  p += 4;
9568 	}
9569       else
9570 	{
9571 	  bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R12 + ((off >> 48) & 0xffff), p);
9572 	  p += 4;
9573 	  if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
9574 	    {
9575 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
9576 	      p += 4;
9577 	    }
9578 	}
9579       if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
9580 	{
9581 	  bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R12_R12_32, p);
9582 	  p += 4;
9583 	}
9584       if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
9585 	{
9586 	  bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORIS_R12_R12_0 + PPC_HI (off), p);
9587 	  p += 4;
9588 	}
9589       if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
9590 	{
9591 	  bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + PPC_LO (off), p);
9592 	  p += 4;
9593 	}
9594       if (load)
9595 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
9596       else
9597 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
9598       p += 4;
9599     }
9600   return p;
9601 }
9602 
9603 static unsigned int
9604 size_offset (bfd_vma off)
9605 {
9606   unsigned int size;
9607   if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9608     size = 4;
9609   else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
9610     size = 8;
9611   else
9612     {
9613       if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
9614 	size = 4;
9615       else
9616 	{
9617 	  size = 4;
9618 	  if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
9619 	    size += 4;
9620 	}
9621       if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
9622 	size += 4;
9623       if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
9624 	size += 4;
9625       if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
9626 	size += 4;
9627       size += 4;
9628     }
9629   return size + 16;
9630 }
9631 
9632 static unsigned int
9633 num_relocs_for_offset (bfd_vma off)
9634 {
9635   unsigned int num_rel;
9636   if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9637     num_rel = 1;
9638   else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
9639     num_rel = 2;
9640   else
9641     {
9642       num_rel = 1;
9643       if (off + 0x800000000000ULL >= 0x1000000000000ULL
9644 	  && ((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
9645 	num_rel += 1;
9646       if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
9647 	num_rel += 1;
9648       if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
9649 	num_rel += 1;
9650     }
9651   return num_rel;
9652 }
9653 
9654 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
9655 emit_relocs_for_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info, Elf_Internal_Rela *r,
9656 			bfd_vma roff, bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off)
9657 {
9658   bfd_vma relative_targ = targ - (roff - 8);
9659   if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
9660     roff += 2;
9661   r->r_offset = roff;
9662   r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
9663   if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9664     r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16);
9665   else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
9666     {
9667       r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HA);
9668       ++r;
9669       roff += 4;
9670       r->r_offset = roff;
9671       r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
9672       r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
9673     }
9674   else
9675     {
9676       if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
9677 	r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
9678       else
9679 	{
9680 	  r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST);
9681 	  if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
9682 	    {
9683 	      ++r;
9684 	      roff += 4;
9685 	      r->r_offset = roff;
9686 	      r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
9687 	      r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
9688 	    }
9689 	}
9690       if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
9691 	roff += 4;
9692       if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
9693 	{
9694 	  ++r;
9695 	  roff += 4;
9696 	  r->r_offset = roff;
9697 	  r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH);
9698 	  r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
9699 	}
9700       if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
9701 	{
9702 	  ++r;
9703 	  roff += 4;
9704 	  r->r_offset = roff;
9705 	  r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
9706 	  r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
9707 	}
9708     }
9709   return r;
9710 }
9711 
9712 /* Emit .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA.  */
9713 
9714 static bfd_byte *
9715 eh_advance (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *eh, unsigned int delta)
9716 {
9717   delta /= 4;
9718   if (delta < 64)
9719     *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + delta;
9720   else if (delta < 256)
9721     {
9722       *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
9723       *eh++ = delta;
9724     }
9725   else if (delta < 65536)
9726     {
9727       *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
9728       bfd_put_16 (abfd, delta, eh);
9729       eh += 2;
9730     }
9731   else
9732     {
9733       *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
9734       bfd_put_32 (abfd, delta, eh);
9735       eh += 4;
9736     }
9737   return eh;
9738 }
9739 
9740 /* Size of required .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA.  */
9741 
9742 static unsigned int
9743 eh_advance_size (unsigned int delta)
9744 {
9745   if (delta < 64 * 4)
9746     /* DW_CFA_advance_loc+[1..63].  */
9747     return 1;
9748   if (delta < 256 * 4)
9749     /* DW_CFA_advance_loc1, byte.  */
9750     return 2;
9751   if (delta < 65536 * 4)
9752     /* DW_CFA_advance_loc2, 2 bytes.  */
9753     return 3;
9754   /* DW_CFA_advance_loc4, 4 bytes.  */
9755   return 5;
9756 }
9757 
9758 /* With power7 weakly ordered memory model, it is possible for ld.so
9759    to update a plt entry in one thread and have another thread see a
9760    stale zero toc entry.  To avoid this we need some sort of acquire
9761    barrier in the call stub.  One solution is to make the load of the
9762    toc word seem to appear to depend on the load of the function entry
9763    word.  Another solution is to test for r2 being zero, and branch to
9764    the appropriate glink entry if so.
9765 
9766    .	fake dep barrier	compare
9767    .	ld 12,xxx(2)		ld 12,xxx(2)
9768    .	mtctr 12		mtctr 12
9769    .	xor 11,12,12		ld 2,xxx+8(2)
9770    .	add 2,2,11		cmpldi 2,0
9771    .	ld 2,xxx+8(2)		bnectr+
9772    .	bctr			b <glink_entry>
9773 
9774    The solution involving the compare turns out to be faster, so
9775    that's what we use unless the branch won't reach.  */
9776 
9777 #define ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP 0
9778 #define ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE 0
9779 
9780 static inline unsigned int
9781 plt_stub_size (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
9782 	       struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
9783 	       bfd_vma off)
9784 {
9785   unsigned size;
9786 
9787   if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
9788     {
9789       size = 8 + size_offset (off - 8);
9790       if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
9791 	size += 4;
9792       return size;
9793     }
9794 
9795   size = 12;
9796   if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
9797       || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
9798     size += 4;
9799   if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
9800     size += 4;
9801   if (htab->opd_abi)
9802     {
9803       size += 4;
9804       if (htab->params->plt_static_chain)
9805 	size += 4;
9806       if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
9807 	  && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9808 	  && stub_entry->h != NULL
9809 	  && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1)
9810 	size += 8;
9811       if (PPC_HA (off + 8 + 8 * htab->params->plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (off))
9812 	size += 4;
9813     }
9814   if (stub_entry->h != NULL
9815       && (stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
9816 	  || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
9817       && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
9818     {
9819       size += 7 * 4;
9820       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
9821 	size += 6 * 4;
9822     }
9823   return size;
9824 }
9825 
9826 /* Depending on the sign of plt_stub_align:
9827    If positive, return the padding to align to a 2**plt_stub_align
9828    boundary.
9829    If negative, if this stub would cross fewer 2**plt_stub_align
9830    boundaries if we align, then return the padding needed to do so.  */
9831 
9832 static inline unsigned int
9833 plt_stub_pad (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
9834 	      struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
9835 	      bfd_vma plt_off)
9836 {
9837   int stub_align;
9838   unsigned stub_size;
9839   bfd_vma stub_off = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
9840 
9841   if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
9842     {
9843       stub_align = 1 << htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9844       if ((stub_off & (stub_align - 1)) != 0)
9845 	return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
9846       return 0;
9847     }
9848 
9849   stub_align = 1 << -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9850   stub_size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, plt_off);
9851   if (((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align) - (stub_off & -stub_align)
9852       > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align))
9853     return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
9854   return 0;
9855 }
9856 
9857 /* Build a .plt call stub.  */
9858 
9859 static inline bfd_byte *
9860 build_plt_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
9861 		struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
9862 		bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
9863 {
9864   bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
9865   bfd_boolean plt_load_toc = htab->opd_abi;
9866   bfd_boolean plt_static_chain = htab->params->plt_static_chain;
9867   bfd_boolean plt_thread_safe = (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
9868 				 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9869 				 && stub_entry->h != NULL
9870 				 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1);
9871   bfd_boolean use_fake_dep = plt_thread_safe;
9872   bfd_vma cmp_branch_off = 0;
9873 
9874   if (!ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP
9875       && plt_load_toc
9876       && plt_thread_safe
9877       && !((stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
9878 	    || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
9879 	   && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt))
9880     {
9881       bfd_vma pltoff = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
9882       bfd_vma pltindex = ((pltoff - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
9883 			  / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab));
9884       bfd_vma glinkoff = GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + pltindex * 8;
9885       bfd_vma to, from;
9886 
9887       if (pltindex > 32768)
9888 	glinkoff += (pltindex - 32768) * 4;
9889       to = (glinkoff
9890 	    + htab->glink->output_offset
9891 	    + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9892       from = (p - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents
9893 	      + 4 * (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
9894 		     || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
9895 	      + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
9896 	      + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain)
9897 		     != PPC_HA (offset))
9898 	      + 4 * (plt_static_chain != 0)
9899 	      + 20
9900 	      + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
9901 	      + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
9902       cmp_branch_off = to - from;
9903       use_fake_dep = cmp_branch_off + (1 << 25) >= (1 << 26);
9904     }
9905 
9906   if (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
9907     {
9908       if (r != NULL)
9909 	{
9910 	  if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
9911 	      || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
9912 	    r[0].r_offset += 4;
9913 	  r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
9914 	  r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
9915 	  r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
9916 	  r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
9917 	  if (plt_load_toc)
9918 	    {
9919 	      if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
9920 		{
9921 		  r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
9922 		  r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO);
9923 		  r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
9924 		}
9925 	      else
9926 		{
9927 		  r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
9928 		  r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
9929 		  r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
9930 		  if (plt_static_chain)
9931 		    {
9932 		      r[3].r_offset = r[2].r_offset + 4;
9933 		      r[3].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
9934 		      r[3].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 16;
9935 		    }
9936 		}
9937 	    }
9938 	}
9939       if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
9940 	  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
9941 	bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p),	p += 4;
9942       if (plt_load_toc)
9943 	{
9944 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R11_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p),	p += 4;
9945 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p),	p += 4;
9946 	}
9947       else
9948 	{
9949 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p),	p += 4;
9950 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (offset), p),	p += 4;
9951 	}
9952       if (plt_load_toc
9953 	  && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
9954 	{
9955 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R11_R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p),	p += 4;
9956 	  offset = 0;
9957 	}
9958       bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p),				p += 4;
9959       if (plt_load_toc)
9960 	{
9961 	  if (use_fake_dep)
9962 	    {
9963 	      bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R2_R12_R12, p),		p += 4;
9964 	      bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R11_R11_R2, p),		p += 4;
9965 	    }
9966 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
9967 	  if (plt_static_chain)
9968 	    bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
9969 	}
9970     }
9971   else
9972     {
9973       if (r != NULL)
9974 	{
9975 	  if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
9976 	      || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
9977 	    r[0].r_offset += 4;
9978 	  r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
9979 	  if (plt_load_toc)
9980 	    {
9981 	      if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
9982 		{
9983 		  r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
9984 		  r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16);
9985 		  r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
9986 		}
9987 	      else
9988 		{
9989 		  r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
9990 		  r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
9991 		  r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain;
9992 		  if (plt_static_chain)
9993 		    {
9994 		      r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
9995 		      r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
9996 		      r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
9997 		    }
9998 		}
9999 	    }
10000 	}
10001       if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10002 	  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10003 	bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p),	p += 4;
10004       bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p),	p += 4;
10005       if (plt_load_toc
10006 	  && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10007 	{
10008 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p),	p += 4;
10009 	  offset = 0;
10010 	}
10011       bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p),				p += 4;
10012       if (plt_load_toc)
10013 	{
10014 	  if (use_fake_dep)
10015 	    {
10016 	      bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R11_R12_R12, p),		p += 4;
10017 	      bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R2_R2_R11, p),		p += 4;
10018 	    }
10019 	  if (plt_static_chain)
10020 	    bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
10021 	  bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
10022 	}
10023     }
10024   if (plt_load_toc && plt_thread_safe && !use_fake_dep)
10025     {
10026       bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPLDI_R2_0, p),			p += 4;
10027       bfd_put_32 (obfd, BNECTR_P4, p),				p += 4;
10028       bfd_put_32 (obfd, B_DOT | (cmp_branch_off & 0x3fffffc), p), p += 4;
10029     }
10030   else
10031     bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTR, p),					p += 4;
10032   return p;
10033 }
10034 
10035 /* Build a special .plt call stub for __tls_get_addr.  */
10036 
10037 #define LD_R11_0R3	0xe9630000
10038 #define LD_R12_0R3	0xe9830000
10039 #define MR_R0_R3	0x7c601b78
10040 #define CMPDI_R11_0	0x2c2b0000
10041 #define ADD_R3_R12_R13	0x7c6c6a14
10042 #define BEQLR		0x4d820020
10043 #define MR_R3_R0	0x7c030378
10044 #define STD_R11_0R1	0xf9610000
10045 #define BCTRL		0x4e800421
10046 #define LD_R11_0R1	0xe9610000
10047 #define MTLR_R11	0x7d6803a6
10048 
10049 static inline bfd_byte *
10050 build_tls_get_addr_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10051 			 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10052 			 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
10053 {
10054   bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
10055   bfd_byte *loc = p;
10056 
10057   bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R3 + 0, p),		p += 4;
10058   bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R3 + 8, p),		p += 4;
10059   bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R0_R3, p),		p += 4;
10060   bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPDI_R11_0, p),		p += 4;
10061   bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R3_R12_R13, p),		p += 4;
10062   bfd_put_32 (obfd, BEQLR, p),			p += 4;
10063   bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R3_R0, p),		p += 4;
10064   if (r != NULL)
10065     r[0].r_offset += 7 * 4;
10066   if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10067     return build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
10068 
10069   bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R11, p),		p += 4;
10070   bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R11_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p), p += 4;
10071 
10072   if (r != NULL)
10073     r[0].r_offset += 2 * 4;
10074   p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
10075   bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
10076 
10077   bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p),	p += 4;
10078   bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p),	p += 4;
10079   bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R11, p),		p += 4;
10080   bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p),			p += 4;
10081 
10082   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10083       && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
10084     {
10085       bfd_byte *base, *eh;
10086       unsigned int lr_used, delta;
10087 
10088       base = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17;
10089       eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
10090       lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - 20 - loc);
10091       delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
10092       stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 16;
10093       eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
10094       *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
10095       *eh++ = 65;
10096       *eh++ = -(STK_LINKER (htab) / 8) & 0x7f;
10097       *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
10098       *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
10099       *eh++ = 65;
10100       stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
10101     }
10102   return p;
10103 }
10104 
10105 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10106 get_relocs (asection *sec, int count)
10107 {
10108   Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
10109   struct bfd_elf_section_data *elfsec_data;
10110 
10111   elfsec_data = elf_section_data (sec);
10112   relocs = elfsec_data->relocs;
10113   if (relocs == NULL)
10114     {
10115       bfd_size_type relsize;
10116       relsize = sec->reloc_count * sizeof (*relocs);
10117       relocs = bfd_alloc (sec->owner, relsize);
10118       if (relocs == NULL)
10119 	return NULL;
10120       elfsec_data->relocs = relocs;
10121       elfsec_data->rela.hdr = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner,
10122 					  sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
10123       if (elfsec_data->rela.hdr == NULL)
10124 	return NULL;
10125       elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_size = (sec->reloc_count
10126 					* sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
10127       elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10128       sec->reloc_count = 0;
10129     }
10130   relocs += sec->reloc_count;
10131   sec->reloc_count += count;
10132   return relocs;
10133 }
10134 
10135 /* Convert the relocs R[0] thru R[-NUM_REL+1], which are all no-symbol
10136    forms, to the equivalent relocs against the global symbol given by
10137    STUB_ENTRY->H.  */
10138 
10139 static bfd_boolean
10140 use_global_in_relocs (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10141 		      struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10142 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *r, unsigned int num_rel)
10143 {
10144   struct elf_link_hash_entry **hashes;
10145   unsigned long symndx;
10146   struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
10147   bfd_vma symval;
10148 
10149   /* Relocs are always against symbols in their own object file.  Fake
10150      up global sym hashes for the stub bfd (which has no symbols).  */
10151   hashes = elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd);
10152   if (hashes == NULL)
10153     {
10154       bfd_size_type hsize;
10155 
10156       /* When called the first time, stub_globals will contain the
10157 	 total number of symbols seen during stub sizing.  After
10158 	 allocating, stub_globals is used as an index to fill the
10159 	 hashes array.  */
10160       hsize = (htab->stub_globals + 1) * sizeof (*hashes);
10161       hashes = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, hsize);
10162       if (hashes == NULL)
10163 	return FALSE;
10164       elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd) = hashes;
10165       htab->stub_globals = 1;
10166     }
10167   symndx = htab->stub_globals++;
10168   h = stub_entry->h;
10169   hashes[symndx] = &h->elf;
10170   if (h->oh != NULL && h->oh->is_func)
10171     h = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
10172   BFD_ASSERT (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10173 	      || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
10174   symval = (h->elf.root.u.def.value
10175 	    + h->elf.root.u.def.section->output_offset
10176 	    + h->elf.root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
10177   while (num_rel-- != 0)
10178     {
10179       r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (symndx, ELF64_R_TYPE (r->r_info));
10180       if (h->elf.root.u.def.section != stub_entry->target_section)
10181 	{
10182 	  /* H is an opd symbol.  The addend must be zero, and the
10183 	     branch reloc is the only one we can convert.  */
10184 	  r->r_addend = 0;
10185 	  break;
10186 	}
10187       else
10188 	r->r_addend -= symval;
10189       --r;
10190     }
10191   return TRUE;
10192 }
10193 
10194 static bfd_vma
10195 get_r2off (struct bfd_link_info *info,
10196 	   struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry)
10197 {
10198   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
10199   bfd_vma r2off = htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off;
10200 
10201   if (r2off == 0)
10202     {
10203       /* Support linking -R objects.  Get the toc pointer from the
10204 	 opd entry.  */
10205       char buf[8];
10206       if (!htab->opd_abi)
10207 	return r2off;
10208       asection *opd = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section;
10209       bfd_vma opd_off = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.value;
10210 
10211       if (strcmp (opd->name, ".opd") != 0
10212 	  || opd->reloc_count != 0)
10213 	{
10214 	  info->callbacks->einfo
10215 	    (_("%P: cannot find opd entry toc for `%pT'\n"),
10216 	     stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string);
10217 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10218 	  return (bfd_vma) -1;
10219 	}
10220       if (!bfd_get_section_contents (opd->owner, opd, buf, opd_off + 8, 8))
10221 	return (bfd_vma) -1;
10222       r2off = bfd_get_64 (opd->owner, buf);
10223       r2off -= elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
10224     }
10225   r2off -= htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off;
10226   return r2off;
10227 }
10228 
10229 static bfd_boolean
10230 ppc_build_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
10231 {
10232   struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
10233   struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
10234   struct bfd_link_info *info;
10235   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
10236   bfd_byte *loc;
10237   bfd_byte *p, *relp;
10238   bfd_vma targ, off;
10239   Elf_Internal_Rela *r;
10240   asection *plt;
10241   int num_rel;
10242 
10243   /* Massage our args to the form they really have.  */
10244   stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
10245   info = in_arg;
10246 
10247   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
10248   if (htab == NULL)
10249     return FALSE;
10250 
10251   BFD_ASSERT (stub_entry->stub_offset >= stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size);
10252   loc = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents + stub_entry->stub_offset;
10253 
10254   htab->stub_count[stub_entry->stub_type - 1] += 1;
10255   switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
10256     {
10257     case ppc_stub_long_branch:
10258     case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
10259       /* Branches are relative.  This is where we are going to.  */
10260       targ = (stub_entry->target_value
10261 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
10262 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
10263       targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
10264 
10265       /* And this is where we are coming from.  */
10266       off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10267 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10268 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10269       off = targ - off;
10270 
10271       p = loc;
10272       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
10273 	{
10274 	  bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
10275 
10276 	  if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
10277 	    {
10278 	      htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10279 	      return FALSE;
10280 	    }
10281 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
10282 	  p += 4;
10283 	  if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
10284 	    {
10285 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10286 			  ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
10287 	      p += 4;
10288 	    }
10289 	  if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
10290 	    {
10291 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10292 			  ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
10293 	      p += 4;
10294 	    }
10295 	  off -= p - loc;
10296 	}
10297       bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, B_DOT | (off & 0x3fffffc), p);
10298       p += 4;
10299 
10300       if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
10301 	{
10302 	  _bfd_error_handler
10303 	    (_("long branch stub `%s' offset overflow"),
10304 	     stub_entry->root.string);
10305 	  htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10306 	  return FALSE;
10307 	}
10308 
10309       if (info->emitrelocations)
10310 	{
10311 	  r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1);
10312 	  if (r == NULL)
10313 	    return FALSE;
10314 	  r->r_offset = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
10315 	  r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
10316 	  r->r_addend = targ;
10317 	  if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10318 	      && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, 1))
10319 	    return FALSE;
10320 	}
10321       break;
10322 
10323     case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
10324     case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
10325       br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
10326 					 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
10327 					 FALSE, FALSE);
10328       if (br_entry == NULL)
10329 	{
10330 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("can't find branch stub `%s'"),
10331 			      stub_entry->root.string);
10332 	  htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10333 	  return FALSE;
10334 	}
10335 
10336       targ = (stub_entry->target_value
10337 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
10338 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
10339       if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
10340 	targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
10341 
10342       bfd_put_64 (htab->brlt->owner, targ,
10343 		  htab->brlt->contents + br_entry->offset);
10344 
10345       if (br_entry->iter == htab->stub_iteration)
10346 	{
10347 	  br_entry->iter = 0;
10348 
10349 	  if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
10350 	    {
10351 	      /* Create a reloc for the branch lookup table entry.  */
10352 	      Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10353 	      bfd_byte *rl;
10354 
10355 	      rela.r_offset = (br_entry->offset
10356 			       + htab->brlt->output_offset
10357 			       + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
10358 	      rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
10359 	      rela.r_addend = targ;
10360 
10361 	      rl = htab->relbrlt->contents;
10362 	      rl += (htab->relbrlt->reloc_count++
10363 		     * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
10364 	      bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (htab->relbrlt->owner, &rela, rl);
10365 	    }
10366 	  else if (info->emitrelocations)
10367 	    {
10368 	      r = get_relocs (htab->brlt, 1);
10369 	      if (r == NULL)
10370 		return FALSE;
10371 	      /* brlt, being SEC_LINKER_CREATED does not go through the
10372 		 normal reloc processing.  Symbols and offsets are not
10373 		 translated from input file to output file form, so
10374 		 set up the offset per the output file.  */
10375 	      r->r_offset = (br_entry->offset
10376 			     + htab->brlt->output_offset
10377 			     + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
10378 	      r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
10379 	      r->r_addend = targ;
10380 	    }
10381 	}
10382 
10383       targ = (br_entry->offset
10384 	      + htab->brlt->output_offset
10385 	      + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
10386 
10387       off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
10388 	     + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
10389       off = targ - off;
10390 
10391       if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
10392 	{
10393 	  info->callbacks->einfo
10394 	    (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
10395 	     stub_entry->root.string);
10396 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10397 	  htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10398 	  return FALSE;
10399 	}
10400 
10401       if (info->emitrelocations)
10402 	{
10403 	  r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0));
10404 	  if (r == NULL)
10405 	    return FALSE;
10406 	  r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
10407 	  if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
10408 	    r[0].r_offset += 2;
10409 	  if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
10410 	    r[0].r_offset += 4;
10411 	  r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
10412 	  r[0].r_addend = targ;
10413 	  if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10414 	    {
10415 	      r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
10416 	      r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
10417 	      r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10418 	      r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10419 	    }
10420 	}
10421 
10422       p = loc;
10423       if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
10424 	{
10425 	  if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10426 	    {
10427 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10428 			  ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
10429 	      p += 4;
10430 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10431 			  LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
10432 	    }
10433 	  else
10434 	    bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10435 			LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
10436 	}
10437       else
10438 	{
10439 	  bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
10440 
10441 	  if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
10442 	    {
10443 	      htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10444 	      return FALSE;
10445 	    }
10446 
10447 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
10448 	  p += 4;
10449 	  if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10450 	    {
10451 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10452 			  ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
10453 	      p += 4;
10454 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10455 			  LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
10456 	    }
10457 	  else
10458 	    bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
10459 
10460 	  if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
10461 	    {
10462 	      p += 4;
10463 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10464 			  ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
10465 	    }
10466 	  if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
10467 	    {
10468 	      p += 4;
10469 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10470 			  ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
10471 	    }
10472 	}
10473       p += 4;
10474       bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
10475       p += 4;
10476       bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
10477       p += 4;
10478       break;
10479 
10480     case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
10481     case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
10482     case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
10483     case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
10484     case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
10485     case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
10486       p = loc;
10487       off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10488 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10489 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10490       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
10491 	  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
10492 	  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
10493 	{
10494 	  off += 4;
10495 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
10496 	  p += 4;
10497 	}
10498       if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10499 	{
10500 	  targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
10501 	  if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
10502 	    abort ();
10503 
10504 	  plt = htab->elf.splt;
10505 	  if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10506 	      || stub_entry->h == NULL
10507 	      || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
10508 	    {
10509 	      if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
10510 		plt = htab->elf.iplt;
10511 	      else
10512 		plt = htab->pltlocal;
10513 	    }
10514 	  targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
10515 	}
10516       else
10517 	targ = (stub_entry->target_value
10518 		+ stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
10519 		+ stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
10520       off = targ - off;
10521 
10522       relp = p;
10523       num_rel = 0;
10524       /* The notoc stubs calculate their target (either a PLT entry or
10525 	 the global entry point of a function) relative to the PC
10526 	 returned by the "bcl" two instructions past the start of the
10527 	 sequence emitted by build_offset.  The offset is therefore 8
10528 	 less than calculated from the start of the sequence.  */
10529       off -= 8;
10530       p = build_offset (htab->params->stub_bfd, p, off,
10531 			stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc);
10532       if (stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
10533 	{
10534 	  bfd_vma from;
10535 	  num_rel = 1;
10536 	  from = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10537 		  + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10538 		  + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
10539 		  + (p - loc));
10540 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
10541 		      B_DOT | ((targ - from) & 0x3fffffc), p);
10542 	}
10543       else
10544 	{
10545 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
10546 	  p += 4;
10547 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
10548 	}
10549       p += 4;
10550 
10551       if (info->emitrelocations)
10552 	{
10553 	  bfd_vma roff;
10554 	  num_rel += num_relocs_for_offset (off);
10555 	  r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, num_rel);
10556 	  if (r == NULL)
10557 	    return FALSE;
10558 	  roff = relp + 16 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
10559 	  r = emit_relocs_for_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off);
10560 	  if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
10561 	      || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
10562 	    {
10563 	      ++r;
10564 	      roff = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
10565 	      r->r_offset = roff;
10566 	      r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
10567 	      r->r_addend = targ;
10568 	      if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10569 		  && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, num_rel))
10570 		return FALSE;
10571 	    }
10572 	}
10573 
10574       if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10575 	&& htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
10576 	{
10577 	  bfd_byte *base, *eh;
10578 	  unsigned int lr_used, delta;
10579 
10580 	  base = (htab->glink_eh_frame->contents
10581 		  + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17);
10582 	  eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
10583 	  lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
10584 	  if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
10585 	      || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
10586 	      || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
10587 	    lr_used += 4;
10588 	  delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
10589 	  stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
10590 	  eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
10591 	  *eh++ = DW_CFA_register;
10592 	  *eh++ = 65;
10593 	  *eh++ = 12;
10594 	  *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
10595 	  *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
10596 	  *eh++ = 65;
10597 	  stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
10598 	}
10599       break;
10600 
10601     case ppc_stub_plt_call:
10602     case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
10603       if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10604 	  && stub_entry->h->is_func_descriptor
10605 	  && stub_entry->h->oh != NULL)
10606 	{
10607 	  struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (stub_entry->h->oh);
10608 
10609 	  /* If the old-ABI "dot-symbol" is undefined make it weak so
10610 	     we don't get a link error from RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL.  */
10611 	  if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
10612 	      && (stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10613 		  || stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
10614 	    fh->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_undefweak;
10615 	}
10616 
10617       /* Now build the stub.  */
10618       targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
10619       if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
10620 	abort ();
10621 
10622       plt = htab->elf.splt;
10623       if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10624 	  || stub_entry->h == NULL
10625 	  || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
10626 	{
10627 	  if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
10628 	    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
10629 	  else
10630 	    plt = htab->pltlocal;
10631 	}
10632       targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
10633 
10634       off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
10635 	     + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
10636       off = targ - off;
10637 
10638       if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
10639 	{
10640 	  info->callbacks->einfo
10641 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
10642 	    (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
10643 	     stub_entry->h != NULL
10644 	     ? stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string
10645 	     : "<local sym>");
10646 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10647 	  htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10648 	  return FALSE;
10649 	}
10650 
10651       r = NULL;
10652       if (info->emitrelocations)
10653 	{
10654 	  r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
10655 			  ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10656 			   + (htab->opd_abi
10657 			      ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
10658 				     && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
10659 			      : 1)));
10660 	  if (r == NULL)
10661 	    return FALSE;
10662 	  r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
10663 	  if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
10664 	    r[0].r_offset += 2;
10665 	  r[0].r_addend = targ;
10666 	}
10667       if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10668 	  && (stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
10669 	      || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
10670 	  && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
10671 	p = build_tls_get_addr_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
10672       else
10673 	p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
10674       break;
10675 
10676     case ppc_stub_save_res:
10677       return TRUE;
10678 
10679     default:
10680       BFD_FAIL ();
10681       return FALSE;
10682     }
10683 
10684   stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc);
10685 
10686   if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
10687     {
10688       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10689       size_t len1, len2;
10690       char *name;
10691       const char *const stub_str[] = { "long_branch",
10692 				       "long_branch",
10693 				       "long_branch",
10694 				       "long_branch",
10695 				       "plt_branch",
10696 				       "plt_branch",
10697 				       "plt_branch",
10698 				       "plt_branch",
10699 				       "plt_call",
10700 				       "plt_call",
10701 				       "plt_call",
10702 				       "plt_call" };
10703 
10704       len1 = strlen (stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1]);
10705       len2 = strlen (stub_entry->root.string);
10706       name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + 2);
10707       if (name == NULL)
10708 	return FALSE;
10709       memcpy (name, stub_entry->root.string, 9);
10710       memcpy (name + 9, stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1], len1);
10711       memcpy (name + len1 + 9, stub_entry->root.string + 8, len2 - 8 + 1);
10712       h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
10713       if (h == NULL)
10714 	return FALSE;
10715       if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
10716 	{
10717 	  h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
10718 	  h->root.u.def.section = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
10719 	  h->root.u.def.value = stub_entry->stub_offset;
10720 	  h->ref_regular = 1;
10721 	  h->def_regular = 1;
10722 	  h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
10723 	  h->forced_local = 1;
10724 	  h->non_elf = 0;
10725 	  h->root.linker_def = 1;
10726 	}
10727     }
10728 
10729   return TRUE;
10730 }
10731 
10732 /* As above, but don't actually build the stub.  Just bump offset so
10733    we know stub section sizes, and select plt_branch stubs where
10734    long_branch stubs won't do.  */
10735 
10736 static bfd_boolean
10737 ppc_size_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
10738 {
10739   struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
10740   struct bfd_link_info *info;
10741   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
10742   asection *plt;
10743   bfd_vma targ, off, r2off;
10744   unsigned int size, extra, lr_used, delta;
10745 
10746   /* Massage our args to the form they really have.  */
10747   stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
10748   info = in_arg;
10749 
10750   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
10751   if (htab == NULL)
10752     return FALSE;
10753 
10754   /* Make a note of the offset within the stubs for this entry.  */
10755   stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
10756 
10757   if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10758       && stub_entry->h->save_res
10759       && stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10760       && stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
10761     {
10762       /* Don't make stubs to out-of-line register save/restore
10763 	 functions.  Instead, emit copies of the functions.  */
10764       stub_entry->group->needs_save_res = 1;
10765       stub_entry->stub_type = ppc_stub_save_res;
10766       return TRUE;
10767     }
10768 
10769   switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
10770     {
10771     case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
10772     case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
10773       /* Reset the stub type from the plt branch variant in case we now
10774 	 can reach with a shorter stub.  */
10775       stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
10776       /* Fall through.  */
10777     case ppc_stub_long_branch:
10778     case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
10779       targ = (stub_entry->target_value
10780 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
10781 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
10782       targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
10783       off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10784 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10785 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10786 
10787       size = 4;
10788       r2off = 0;
10789       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
10790 	{
10791 	  r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
10792 	  if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
10793 	    {
10794 	      htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10795 	      return FALSE;
10796 	    }
10797 	  size = 8;
10798 	  if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
10799 	    size += 4;
10800 	  if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
10801 	    size += 4;
10802 	  off += size - 4;
10803 	}
10804       off = targ - off;
10805 
10806       /* If the branch offset is too big, use a ppc_stub_plt_branch.
10807 	 Do the same for -R objects without function descriptors.  */
10808       if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
10809 	   && r2off == 0
10810 	   && htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off == 0)
10811 	  || off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
10812 	{
10813 	  struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
10814 
10815 	  br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
10816 					     stub_entry->root.string + 9,
10817 					     TRUE, FALSE);
10818 	  if (br_entry == NULL)
10819 	    {
10820 	      _bfd_error_handler (_("can't build branch stub `%s'"),
10821 				  stub_entry->root.string);
10822 	      htab->stub_error = TRUE;
10823 	      return FALSE;
10824 	    }
10825 
10826 	  if (br_entry->iter != htab->stub_iteration)
10827 	    {
10828 	      br_entry->iter = htab->stub_iteration;
10829 	      br_entry->offset = htab->brlt->size;
10830 	      htab->brlt->size += 8;
10831 
10832 	      if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
10833 		htab->relbrlt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10834 	      else if (info->emitrelocations)
10835 		{
10836 		  htab->brlt->reloc_count += 1;
10837 		  htab->brlt->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
10838 		}
10839 	    }
10840 
10841 	  targ = (br_entry->offset
10842 		  + htab->brlt->output_offset
10843 		  + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
10844 	  off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
10845 		 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
10846 	  off = targ - off;
10847 
10848 	  if (info->emitrelocations)
10849 	    {
10850 	      stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
10851 		+= 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0);
10852 	      stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
10853 	    }
10854 
10855 	  stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_plt_branch - ppc_stub_long_branch;
10856 	  if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
10857 	    {
10858 	      size = 12;
10859 	      if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10860 		size = 16;
10861 	    }
10862 	  else
10863 	    {
10864 	      size = 16;
10865 	      if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10866 		size += 4;
10867 
10868 	      if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
10869 		size += 4;
10870 	      if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
10871 		size += 4;
10872 	    }
10873 	}
10874       else if (info->emitrelocations)
10875 	{
10876 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += 1;
10877 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
10878 	}
10879       break;
10880 
10881     case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
10882     case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
10883       stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
10884       /* Fall through.  */
10885     case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
10886     case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
10887       off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10888 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10889 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10890       size = 0;
10891       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
10892 	size = 4;
10893       off += size;
10894       targ = (stub_entry->target_value
10895 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
10896 	      + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
10897       off = targ - off;
10898 
10899       if (info->emitrelocations)
10900 	{
10901 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
10902 	    += num_relocs_for_offset (off);
10903 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
10904 	}
10905 
10906       extra = size_offset (off - 8);
10907       /* Include branch insn plus those in the offset sequence.  */
10908       size += 4 + extra;
10909       /* The branch insn is at the end, or "extra" bytes along.  So
10910 	 its offset will be "extra" bytes less that that already
10911 	 calculated.  */
10912       off -= extra;
10913 
10914       /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
10915 	 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12.  */
10916       lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
10917       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
10918 	lr_used += 4;
10919       /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
10920 	 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
10921 	 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65.  */
10922       delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
10923       stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
10924       stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
10925 
10926       /* If the branch can't reach, use a plt_branch.  */
10927       if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
10928 	{
10929 	  stub_entry->stub_type += (ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
10930 				    - ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc);
10931 	  size += 4;
10932 	}
10933       else if (info->emitrelocations)
10934 	stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count +=1;
10935       break;
10936 
10937     case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
10938     case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
10939       off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10940 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10941 	     + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10942       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
10943 	off += 4;
10944       targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
10945       if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
10946 	abort ();
10947 
10948       plt = htab->elf.splt;
10949       if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10950 	  || stub_entry->h == NULL
10951 	  || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
10952 	{
10953 	  if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
10954 	    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
10955 	  else
10956 	    plt = htab->pltlocal;
10957 	}
10958       targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
10959       off = targ - off;
10960 
10961       if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
10962 	{
10963 	  unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
10964 
10965 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
10966 	  stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
10967 	  off -= pad;
10968 	}
10969 
10970       if (info->emitrelocations)
10971 	{
10972 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
10973 	    += num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
10974 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
10975 	}
10976 
10977       size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
10978 
10979       /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
10980 	 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12.  */
10981       lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
10982       if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
10983 	lr_used += 4;
10984       /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
10985 	 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
10986 	 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65.  */
10987       delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
10988       stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
10989       stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
10990       break;
10991 
10992     case ppc_stub_plt_call:
10993     case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
10994       targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~(bfd_vma) 1;
10995       if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
10996 	abort ();
10997       plt = htab->elf.splt;
10998       if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10999 	  || stub_entry->h == NULL
11000 	  || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11001 	{
11002 	  if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11003 	    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11004 	  else
11005 	    plt = htab->pltlocal;
11006 	}
11007       targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11008 
11009       off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11010 	     + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11011       off = targ - off;
11012 
11013       if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
11014 	{
11015 	  unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
11016 
11017 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
11018 	  stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
11019 	}
11020 
11021       if (info->emitrelocations)
11022 	{
11023 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
11024 	    += ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11025 		+ (htab->opd_abi
11026 		   ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
11027 			  && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
11028 		   : 1));
11029 	  stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11030 	}
11031 
11032       size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
11033 
11034       if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11035 	  && (stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
11036 	      || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
11037 	  && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
11038 	  && stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11039 	{
11040 	  /* After the bctrl, lr has been modified so we need to
11041 	     emit .eh_frame info saying the return address is
11042 	     on the stack.  In fact we put the EH info specifying
11043 	     that the return address is on the stack *at* the
11044 	     call rather than after it, because the EH info for a
11045 	     call needs to be specified by that point.
11046 	     See libgcc/unwind-dw2.c execute_cfa_program.  */
11047 	  lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 20;
11048 	  /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc
11049 	     or variant, DW_CFA_offset_externed_sf, 65, -stackoff,
11050 	     DW_CFA_advance_loc+4, DW_CFA_restore_extended, 65.  */
11051 	  delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11052 	  stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
11053 	  stub_entry->group->lr_restore = size - 4;
11054 	}
11055       break;
11056 
11057     default:
11058       BFD_FAIL ();
11059       return FALSE;
11060     }
11061 
11062   stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += size;
11063   return TRUE;
11064 }
11065 
11066 /* Set up various things so that we can make a list of input sections
11067    for each output section included in the link.  Returns -1 on error,
11068    0 when no stubs will be needed, and 1 on success.  */
11069 
11070 int
11071 ppc64_elf_setup_section_lists (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11072 {
11073   unsigned int id;
11074   bfd_size_type amt;
11075   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11076 
11077   if (htab == NULL)
11078     return -1;
11079 
11080   htab->sec_info_arr_size = _bfd_section_id;
11081   amt = sizeof (*htab->sec_info) * (htab->sec_info_arr_size);
11082   htab->sec_info = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
11083   if (htab->sec_info == NULL)
11084     return -1;
11085 
11086   /* Set toc_off for com, und, abs and ind sections.  */
11087   for (id = 0; id < 3; id++)
11088     htab->sec_info[id].toc_off = TOC_BASE_OFF;
11089 
11090   return 1;
11091 }
11092 
11093 /* Set up for first pass at multitoc partitioning.  */
11094 
11095 void
11096 ppc64_elf_start_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11097 {
11098   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11099 
11100   htab->toc_curr = ppc64_elf_set_toc (info, info->output_bfd);
11101   htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
11102   htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
11103 }
11104 
11105 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each TOC input section
11106    and linker generated GOT section.  Group input bfds such that the toc
11107    within a group is less than 64k in size.  */
11108 
11109 bfd_boolean
11110 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
11111 {
11112   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11113   bfd_vma addr, off, limit;
11114 
11115   if (htab == NULL)
11116     return FALSE;
11117 
11118   if (!htab->second_toc_pass)
11119     {
11120       /* Keep track of the first .toc or .got section for this input bfd.  */
11121       bfd_boolean new_bfd = htab->toc_bfd != isec->owner;
11122 
11123       if (new_bfd)
11124 	{
11125 	  htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
11126 	  htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
11127 	}
11128 
11129       addr = isec->output_offset + isec->output_section->vma;
11130       off = addr - htab->toc_curr;
11131       limit = 0x80008000;
11132       if (ppc64_elf_tdata (isec->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc)
11133 	limit = 0x10000;
11134       if (off + isec->size > limit)
11135 	{
11136 	  addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
11137 		  + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
11138 	  htab->toc_curr = addr;
11139 	  htab->toc_curr &= -TOC_BASE_ALIGN;
11140 	}
11141 
11142       /* toc_curr is the base address of this toc group.  Set elf_gp
11143 	 for the input section to be the offset relative to the
11144 	 output toc base plus 0x8000.  Making the input elf_gp an
11145 	 offset allows us to move the toc as a whole without
11146 	 recalculating input elf_gp.  */
11147       off = htab->toc_curr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
11148       off += TOC_BASE_OFF;
11149 
11150       /* Die if someone uses a linker script that doesn't keep input
11151 	 file .toc and .got together.  */
11152       if (new_bfd
11153 	  && elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0
11154 	  && elf_gp (isec->owner) != off)
11155 	return FALSE;
11156 
11157       elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
11158       return TRUE;
11159     }
11160 
11161   /* During the second pass toc_first_sec points to the start of
11162      a toc group, and toc_curr is used to track the old elf_gp.
11163      We use toc_bfd to ensure we only look at each bfd once.  */
11164   if (htab->toc_bfd == isec->owner)
11165     return TRUE;
11166   htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
11167 
11168   if (htab->toc_first_sec == NULL
11169       || htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (isec->owner))
11170     {
11171       htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
11172       htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
11173     }
11174   addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
11175 	  + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
11176   off = addr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF;
11177   elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
11178 
11179   return TRUE;
11180 }
11181 
11182 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to merge GOT entries for global
11183    symbol H.  */
11184 
11185 static bfd_boolean
11186 merge_global_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11187 {
11188   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
11189     return TRUE;
11190 
11191   merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
11192 
11193   return TRUE;
11194 }
11195 
11196 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to allocate GOT entries for global
11197    symbol H.  */
11198 
11199 static bfd_boolean
11200 reallocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
11201 {
11202   struct got_entry *gent;
11203 
11204   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
11205     return TRUE;
11206 
11207   for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
11208     if (!gent->is_indirect)
11209       allocate_got (h, (struct bfd_link_info *) inf, gent);
11210   return TRUE;
11211 }
11212 
11213 /* Called on the first multitoc pass after the last call to
11214    ppc64_elf_next_toc_section.  This function removes duplicate GOT
11215    entries.  */
11216 
11217 bfd_boolean
11218 ppc64_elf_layout_multitoc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11219 {
11220   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11221   struct bfd *ibfd, *ibfd2;
11222   bfd_boolean done_something;
11223 
11224   htab->multi_toc_needed = htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
11225 
11226   if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
11227     return FALSE;
11228 
11229   /* Merge global sym got entries within a toc group.  */
11230   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, merge_global_got, info);
11231 
11232   /* And tlsld_got.  */
11233   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
11234     {
11235       struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
11236 
11237       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
11238 	continue;
11239 
11240       ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
11241       if (!ent->is_indirect
11242 	  && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
11243 	{
11244 	  for (ibfd2 = ibfd->link.next; ibfd2 != NULL; ibfd2 = ibfd2->link.next)
11245 	    {
11246 	      if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd2))
11247 		continue;
11248 
11249 	      ent2 = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd2);
11250 	      if (!ent2->is_indirect
11251 		  && ent2->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
11252 		  && elf_gp (ibfd2) == elf_gp (ibfd))
11253 		{
11254 		  ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
11255 		  ent2->got.ent = ent;
11256 		}
11257 	    }
11258 	}
11259     }
11260 
11261   /* Zap sizes of got sections.  */
11262   htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize = htab->elf.irelplt->size;
11263   htab->elf.irelplt->size -= htab->got_reli_size;
11264   htab->got_reli_size = 0;
11265 
11266   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
11267     {
11268       asection *got, *relgot;
11269 
11270       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
11271 	continue;
11272 
11273       got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
11274       if (got != NULL)
11275 	{
11276 	  got->rawsize = got->size;
11277 	  got->size = 0;
11278 	  relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
11279 	  relgot->rawsize = relgot->size;
11280 	  relgot->size = 0;
11281 	}
11282     }
11283 
11284   /* Now reallocate the got, local syms first.  We don't need to
11285      allocate section contents again since we never increase size.  */
11286   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
11287     {
11288       struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
11289       struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
11290       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
11291       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
11292       unsigned char *lgot_masks;
11293       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
11294       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
11295       asection *s;
11296 
11297       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
11298 	continue;
11299 
11300       lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
11301       if (!lgot_ents)
11302 	continue;
11303 
11304       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
11305       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
11306       end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
11307       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
11308       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
11309       lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
11310       s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
11311       for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
11312 	{
11313 	  struct got_entry *ent;
11314 
11315 	  for (ent = *lgot_ents; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
11316 	    {
11317 	      unsigned int ent_size = 8;
11318 	      unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11319 
11320 	      ent->got.offset = s->size;
11321 	      if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
11322 		{
11323 		  ent_size *= 2;
11324 		  rel_size *= 2;
11325 		}
11326 	      s->size += ent_size;
11327 	      if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
11328 		{
11329 		  htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
11330 		  htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
11331 		}
11332 	      else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
11333 		       && !((ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
11334 			    && bfd_link_executable (info)))
11335 		{
11336 		  asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
11337 		  srel->size += rel_size;
11338 		}
11339 	    }
11340 	}
11341     }
11342 
11343   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, reallocate_got, info);
11344 
11345   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
11346     {
11347       struct got_entry *ent;
11348 
11349       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
11350 	continue;
11351 
11352       ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
11353       if (!ent->is_indirect
11354 	  && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
11355 	{
11356 	  asection *s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
11357 	  ent->got.offset = s->size;
11358 	  s->size += 16;
11359 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
11360 	    {
11361 	      asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
11362 	      srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11363 	    }
11364 	}
11365     }
11366 
11367   done_something = htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize != htab->elf.irelplt->size;
11368   if (!done_something)
11369     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
11370       {
11371 	asection *got;
11372 
11373 	if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
11374 	  continue;
11375 
11376 	got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
11377 	if (got != NULL)
11378 	  {
11379 	    done_something = got->rawsize != got->size;
11380 	    if (done_something)
11381 	      break;
11382 	  }
11383       }
11384 
11385   if (done_something)
11386     (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
11387 
11388   /* Set up for second pass over toc sections to recalculate elf_gp
11389      on input sections.  */
11390   htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
11391   htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
11392   htab->second_toc_pass = TRUE;
11393   return done_something;
11394 }
11395 
11396 /* Called after second pass of multitoc partitioning.  */
11397 
11398 void
11399 ppc64_elf_finish_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11400 {
11401   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11402 
11403   /* After the second pass, toc_curr tracks the TOC offset used
11404      for code sections below in ppc64_elf_next_input_section.  */
11405   htab->toc_curr = TOC_BASE_OFF;
11406 }
11407 
11408 /* No toc references were found in ISEC.  If the code in ISEC makes no
11409    calls, then there's no need to use toc adjusting stubs when branching
11410    into ISEC.  Actually, indirect calls from ISEC are OK as they will
11411    load r2.  Returns -1 on error, 0 for no stub needed, 1 for stub
11412    needed, and 2 if a cyclical call-graph was found but no other reason
11413    for a stub was detected.  If called from the top level, a return of
11414    2 means the same as a return of 0.  */
11415 
11416 static int
11417 toc_adjusting_stub_needed (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
11418 {
11419   int ret;
11420 
11421   /* Mark this section as checked.  */
11422   isec->call_check_done = 1;
11423 
11424   /* We know none of our code bearing sections will need toc stubs.  */
11425   if ((isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
11426     return 0;
11427 
11428   if (isec->size == 0)
11429     return 0;
11430 
11431   if (isec->output_section == NULL)
11432     return 0;
11433 
11434   ret = 0;
11435   if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
11436     {
11437       Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
11438       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
11439       struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11440 
11441       relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (isec->owner, isec, NULL, NULL,
11442 					    info->keep_memory);
11443       if (relstart == NULL)
11444 	return -1;
11445 
11446       /* Look for branches to outside of this section.  */
11447       local_syms = NULL;
11448       htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11449       if (htab == NULL)
11450 	return -1;
11451 
11452       for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + isec->reloc_count; ++rel)
11453 	{
11454 	  enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
11455 	  unsigned long r_symndx;
11456 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11457 	  struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
11458 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
11459 	  asection *sym_sec;
11460 	  struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
11461 	  bfd_vma sym_value;
11462 	  bfd_vma dest;
11463 
11464 	  r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
11465 	  if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
11466 	      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
11467 	      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
11468 	      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
11469 	      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
11470 	      && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
11471 	    continue;
11472 
11473 	  r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
11474 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms, r_symndx,
11475 			  isec->owner))
11476 	    {
11477 	      ret = -1;
11478 	      break;
11479 	    }
11480 
11481 	  /* Calls to dynamic lib functions go through a plt call stub
11482 	     that uses r2.  */
11483 	  eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
11484 	  if (eh != NULL
11485 	      && (eh->elf.plt.plist != NULL
11486 		  || (eh->oh != NULL
11487 		      && ppc_follow_link (eh->oh)->elf.plt.plist != NULL)))
11488 	    {
11489 	      ret = 1;
11490 	      break;
11491 	    }
11492 
11493 	  if (sym_sec == NULL)
11494 	    /* Ignore other undefined symbols.  */
11495 	    continue;
11496 
11497 	  /* Assume branches to other sections not included in the
11498 	     link need stubs too, to cover -R and absolute syms.  */
11499 	  if (sym_sec->output_section == NULL)
11500 	    {
11501 	      ret = 1;
11502 	      break;
11503 	    }
11504 
11505 	  if (h == NULL)
11506 	    sym_value = sym->st_value;
11507 	  else
11508 	    {
11509 	      if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
11510 		  && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
11511 		abort ();
11512 	      sym_value = h->root.u.def.value;
11513 	    }
11514 	  sym_value += rel->r_addend;
11515 
11516 	  /* If this branch reloc uses an opd sym, find the code section.  */
11517 	  opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
11518 	  if (opd != NULL)
11519 	    {
11520 	      if (h == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
11521 		{
11522 		  long adjust;
11523 
11524 		  adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
11525 		  if (adjust == -1)
11526 		    /* Assume deleted functions won't ever be called.  */
11527 		    continue;
11528 		  sym_value += adjust;
11529 		}
11530 
11531 	      dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
11532 				      &sym_sec, NULL, FALSE);
11533 	      if (dest == (bfd_vma) -1)
11534 		continue;
11535 	    }
11536 	  else
11537 	    dest = (sym_value
11538 		    + sym_sec->output_offset
11539 		    + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
11540 
11541 	  /* Ignore branch to self.  */
11542 	  if (sym_sec == isec)
11543 	    continue;
11544 
11545 	  /* If the called function uses the toc, we need a stub.  */
11546 	  if (sym_sec->has_toc_reloc
11547 	      || sym_sec->makes_toc_func_call)
11548 	    {
11549 	      ret = 1;
11550 	      break;
11551 	    }
11552 
11553 	  /* Assume any branch that needs a long branch stub might in fact
11554 	     need a plt_branch stub.  A plt_branch stub uses r2.  */
11555 	  else if (dest - (isec->output_offset
11556 			   + isec->output_section->vma
11557 			   + rel->r_offset) + (1 << 25)
11558 		   >= (2u << 25) - PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h
11559 							     ? h->other
11560 							     : sym->st_other))
11561 	    {
11562 	      ret = 1;
11563 	      break;
11564 	    }
11565 
11566 	  /* If calling back to a section in the process of being
11567 	     tested, we can't say for sure that no toc adjusting stubs
11568 	     are needed, so don't return zero.  */
11569 	  else if (sym_sec->call_check_in_progress)
11570 	    ret = 2;
11571 
11572 	  /* Branches to another section that itself doesn't have any TOC
11573 	     references are OK.  Recursively call ourselves to check.  */
11574 	  else if (!sym_sec->call_check_done)
11575 	    {
11576 	      int recur;
11577 
11578 	      /* Mark current section as indeterminate, so that other
11579 		 sections that call back to current won't be marked as
11580 		 known.  */
11581 	      isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
11582 	      recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, sym_sec);
11583 	      isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
11584 
11585 	      if (recur != 0)
11586 		{
11587 		  ret = recur;
11588 		  if (recur != 2)
11589 		    break;
11590 		}
11591 	    }
11592 	}
11593 
11594       if (local_syms != NULL
11595 	  && (elf_symtab_hdr (isec->owner).contents
11596 	      != (unsigned char *) local_syms))
11597 	free (local_syms);
11598       if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != relstart)
11599 	free (relstart);
11600     }
11601 
11602   if ((ret & 1) == 0
11603       && isec->map_head.s != NULL
11604       && (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
11605 	  || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
11606     {
11607       if (isec->map_head.s->has_toc_reloc
11608 	  || isec->map_head.s->makes_toc_func_call)
11609 	ret = 1;
11610       else if (!isec->map_head.s->call_check_done)
11611 	{
11612 	  int recur;
11613 	  isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
11614 	  recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec->map_head.s);
11615 	  isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
11616 	  if (recur != 0)
11617 	    ret = recur;
11618 	}
11619     }
11620 
11621   if (ret == 1)
11622     isec->makes_toc_func_call = 1;
11623 
11624   return ret;
11625 }
11626 
11627 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each input section,
11628    in the order that input sections are linked into output sections.
11629    Build lists of input sections to determine groupings between which
11630    we may insert linker stubs.  */
11631 
11632 bfd_boolean
11633 ppc64_elf_next_input_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
11634 {
11635   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11636 
11637   if (htab == NULL)
11638     return FALSE;
11639 
11640   if ((isec->output_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
11641       && isec->output_section->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
11642     {
11643       /* This happens to make the list in reverse order,
11644 	 which is what we want.  */
11645       htab->sec_info[isec->id].u.list
11646 	= htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list;
11647       htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list = isec;
11648     }
11649 
11650   if (htab->multi_toc_needed)
11651     {
11652       /* Analyse sections that aren't already flagged as needing a
11653 	 valid toc pointer.  Exclude .fixup for the linux kernel.
11654 	 .fixup contains branches, but only back to the function that
11655 	 hit an exception.  */
11656       if (!(isec->has_toc_reloc
11657 	    || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
11658 	    || strcmp (isec->name, ".fixup") == 0
11659 	    || isec->call_check_done))
11660 	{
11661 	  if (toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec) < 0)
11662 	    return FALSE;
11663 	}
11664       /* Make all sections use the TOC assigned for this object file.
11665 	 This will be wrong for pasted sections;  We fix that in
11666 	 check_pasted_section().  */
11667       if (elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0)
11668 	htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
11669     }
11670 
11671   htab->sec_info[isec->id].toc_off = htab->toc_curr;
11672   return TRUE;
11673 }
11674 
11675 /* Check that all .init and .fini sections use the same toc, if they
11676    have toc relocs.  */
11677 
11678 static bfd_boolean
11679 check_pasted_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, const char *name)
11680 {
11681   asection *o = bfd_get_section_by_name (info->output_bfd, name);
11682 
11683   if (o != NULL)
11684     {
11685       struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11686       bfd_vma toc_off = 0;
11687       asection *i;
11688 
11689       for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
11690 	if (i->has_toc_reloc)
11691 	  {
11692 	    if (toc_off == 0)
11693 	      toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
11694 	    else if (toc_off != htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off)
11695 	      return FALSE;
11696 	  }
11697 
11698       if (toc_off == 0)
11699 	for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
11700 	  if (i->makes_toc_func_call)
11701 	    {
11702 	      toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
11703 	      break;
11704 	    }
11705 
11706       /* Make sure the whole pasted function uses the same toc offset.  */
11707       if (toc_off != 0)
11708 	for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
11709 	  htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off = toc_off;
11710     }
11711   return TRUE;
11712 }
11713 
11714 bfd_boolean
11715 ppc64_elf_check_init_fini (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11716 {
11717   return (check_pasted_section (info, ".init")
11718 	  & check_pasted_section (info, ".fini"));
11719 }
11720 
11721 /* See whether we can group stub sections together.  Grouping stub
11722    sections may result in fewer stubs.  More importantly, we need to
11723    put all .init* and .fini* stubs at the beginning of the .init or
11724    .fini output sections respectively, because glibc splits the
11725    _init and _fini functions into multiple parts.  Putting a stub in
11726    the middle of a function is not a good idea.  */
11727 
11728 static bfd_boolean
11729 group_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
11730 		bfd_size_type stub_group_size,
11731 		bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch)
11732 {
11733   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11734   asection *osec;
11735   bfd_boolean suppress_size_errors;
11736 
11737   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11738   if (htab == NULL)
11739     return FALSE;
11740 
11741   suppress_size_errors = FALSE;
11742   if (stub_group_size == 1)
11743     {
11744       /* Default values.  */
11745       if (stubs_always_before_branch)
11746 	stub_group_size = 0x1e00000;
11747       else
11748 	stub_group_size = 0x1c00000;
11749       suppress_size_errors = TRUE;
11750     }
11751 
11752   for (osec = info->output_bfd->sections; osec != NULL; osec = osec->next)
11753     {
11754       asection *tail;
11755 
11756       if (osec->id >= htab->sec_info_arr_size)
11757 	continue;
11758 
11759       tail = htab->sec_info[osec->id].u.list;
11760       while (tail != NULL)
11761 	{
11762 	  asection *curr;
11763 	  asection *prev;
11764 	  bfd_size_type total;
11765 	  bfd_boolean big_sec;
11766 	  bfd_vma curr_toc;
11767 	  struct map_stub *group;
11768 	  bfd_size_type group_size;
11769 
11770 	  curr = tail;
11771 	  total = tail->size;
11772 	  group_size = (ppc64_elf_section_data (tail) != NULL
11773 			&& ppc64_elf_section_data (tail)->has_14bit_branch
11774 			? stub_group_size >> 10 : stub_group_size);
11775 
11776 	  big_sec = total > group_size;
11777 	  if (big_sec && !suppress_size_errors)
11778 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
11779 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB section %pA exceeds stub group size"),
11780 				tail->owner, tail);
11781 	  curr_toc = htab->sec_info[tail->id].toc_off;
11782 
11783 	  while ((prev = htab->sec_info[curr->id].u.list) != NULL
11784 		 && ((total += curr->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
11785 		     < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
11786 			&& ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
11787 			? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10) : group_size))
11788 		 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
11789 	    curr = prev;
11790 
11791 	  /* OK, the size from the start of CURR to the end is less
11792 	     than group_size and thus can be handled by one stub
11793 	     section.  (or the tail section is itself larger than
11794 	     group_size, in which case we may be toast.)  We should
11795 	     really be keeping track of the total size of stubs added
11796 	     here, as stubs contribute to the final output section
11797 	     size.  That's a little tricky, and this way will only
11798 	     break if stubs added make the total size more than 2^25,
11799 	     ie. for the default stub_group_size, if stubs total more
11800 	     than 2097152 bytes, or nearly 75000 plt call stubs.  */
11801 	  group = bfd_alloc (curr->owner, sizeof (*group));
11802 	  if (group == NULL)
11803 	    return FALSE;
11804 	  group->link_sec = curr;
11805 	  group->stub_sec = NULL;
11806 	  group->needs_save_res = 0;
11807 	  group->lr_restore = 0;
11808 	  group->eh_size = 0;
11809 	  group->eh_base = 0;
11810 	  group->next = htab->group;
11811 	  htab->group = group;
11812 	  do
11813 	    {
11814 	      prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
11815 	      /* Set up this stub group.  */
11816 	      htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
11817 	    }
11818 	  while (tail != curr && (tail = prev) != NULL);
11819 
11820 	  /* But wait, there's more!  Input sections up to group_size
11821 	     bytes before the stub section can be handled by it too.
11822 	     Don't do this if we have a really large section after the
11823 	     stubs, as adding more stubs increases the chance that
11824 	     branches may not reach into the stub section.  */
11825 	  if (!stubs_always_before_branch && !big_sec)
11826 	    {
11827 	      total = 0;
11828 	      while (prev != NULL
11829 		     && ((total += tail->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
11830 			 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
11831 			    && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
11832 			    ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10)
11833 			    : group_size))
11834 		     && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
11835 		{
11836 		  tail = prev;
11837 		  prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
11838 		  htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
11839 		}
11840 	    }
11841 	  tail = prev;
11842 	}
11843     }
11844   return TRUE;
11845 }
11846 
11847 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
11848 {
11849   0, 0, 0, 16,				/* length.  */
11850   0, 0, 0, 0,				/* id.  */
11851   1,					/* CIE version.  */
11852   'z', 'R', 0,				/* Augmentation string.  */
11853   4,					/* Code alignment.  */
11854   0x78,					/* Data alignment.  */
11855   65,					/* RA reg.  */
11856   1,					/* Augmentation size.  */
11857   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4,	/* FDE encoding.  */
11858   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0			/* def_cfa: r1 offset 0.  */
11859 };
11860 
11861 /* Stripping output sections is normally done before dynamic section
11862    symbols have been allocated.  This function is called later, and
11863    handles cases like htab->brlt which is mapped to its own output
11864    section.  */
11865 
11866 static void
11867 maybe_strip_output (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
11868 {
11869   if (isec->size == 0
11870       && isec->output_section->size == 0
11871       && !(isec->output_section->flags & SEC_KEEP)
11872       && !bfd_section_removed_from_list (info->output_bfd,
11873 					 isec->output_section)
11874       && elf_section_data (isec->output_section)->dynindx == 0)
11875     {
11876       isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
11877       bfd_section_list_remove (info->output_bfd, isec->output_section);
11878       info->output_bfd->section_count--;
11879     }
11880 }
11881 
11882 /* Determine and set the size of the stub section for a final link.
11883 
11884    The basic idea here is to examine all the relocations looking for
11885    PC-relative calls to a target that is unreachable with a "bl"
11886    instruction.  */
11887 
11888 bfd_boolean
11889 ppc64_elf_size_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11890 {
11891   bfd_size_type stub_group_size;
11892   bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch;
11893   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11894 
11895   if (htab == NULL)
11896     return FALSE;
11897 
11898   if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1 && !bfd_link_executable (info))
11899     htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 1;
11900   if (!htab->opd_abi)
11901     htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 0;
11902   else if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1)
11903     {
11904       static const char *const thread_starter[] =
11905 	{
11906 	  "pthread_create",
11907 	  /* libstdc++ */
11908 	  "_ZNSt6thread15_M_start_threadESt10shared_ptrINS_10_Impl_baseEE",
11909 	  /* librt */
11910 	  "aio_init", "aio_read", "aio_write", "aio_fsync", "lio_listio",
11911 	  "mq_notify", "create_timer",
11912 	  /* libanl */
11913 	  "getaddrinfo_a",
11914 	  /* libgomp */
11915 	  "GOMP_parallel",
11916 	  "GOMP_parallel_start",
11917 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_static",
11918 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_static_start",
11919 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic",
11920 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic_start",
11921 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided",
11922 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided_start",
11923 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime",
11924 	  "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime_start",
11925 	  "GOMP_parallel_sections",
11926 	  "GOMP_parallel_sections_start",
11927 	  /* libgo */
11928 	  "__go_go",
11929 	};
11930       unsigned i;
11931 
11932       for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (thread_starter); i++)
11933 	{
11934 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11935 	  h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, thread_starter[i],
11936 				    FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
11937 	  htab->params->plt_thread_safe = h != NULL && h->ref_regular;
11938 	  if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe)
11939 	    break;
11940 	}
11941     }
11942   stubs_always_before_branch = htab->params->group_size < 0;
11943   if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
11944     stub_group_size = -htab->params->group_size;
11945   else
11946     stub_group_size = htab->params->group_size;
11947 
11948   if (!group_sections (info, stub_group_size, stubs_always_before_branch))
11949     return FALSE;
11950 
11951 #define STUB_SHRINK_ITER 20
11952   /* Loop until no stubs added.  After iteration 20 of this loop we may
11953      exit on a stub section shrinking.  This is to break out of a
11954      pathological case where adding stubs on one iteration decreases
11955      section gaps (perhaps due to alignment), which then requires
11956      fewer or smaller stubs on the next iteration.  */
11957 
11958   while (1)
11959     {
11960       bfd *input_bfd;
11961       unsigned int bfd_indx;
11962       struct map_stub *group;
11963 
11964       htab->stub_iteration += 1;
11965 
11966       for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds, bfd_indx = 0;
11967 	   input_bfd != NULL;
11968 	   input_bfd = input_bfd->link.next, bfd_indx++)
11969 	{
11970 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
11971 	  asection *section;
11972 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
11973 
11974 	  if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
11975 	    continue;
11976 
11977 	  /* We'll need the symbol table in a second.  */
11978 	  symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
11979 	  if (symtab_hdr->sh_info == 0)
11980 	    continue;
11981 
11982 	  /* Walk over each section attached to the input bfd.  */
11983 	  for (section = input_bfd->sections;
11984 	       section != NULL;
11985 	       section = section->next)
11986 	    {
11987 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irelaend, *irela;
11988 
11989 	      /* If there aren't any relocs, then there's nothing more
11990 		 to do.  */
11991 	      if ((section->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
11992 		  || (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
11993 		  || (section->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0
11994 		  || (section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
11995 		  || section->reloc_count == 0)
11996 		continue;
11997 
11998 	      /* If this section is a link-once section that will be
11999 		 discarded, then don't create any stubs.  */
12000 	      if (section->output_section == NULL
12001 		  || section->output_section->owner != info->output_bfd)
12002 		continue;
12003 
12004 	      /* Get the relocs.  */
12005 	      internal_relocs
12006 		= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (input_bfd, section, NULL, NULL,
12007 					     info->keep_memory);
12008 	      if (internal_relocs == NULL)
12009 		goto error_ret_free_local;
12010 
12011 	      /* Now examine each relocation.  */
12012 	      irela = internal_relocs;
12013 	      irelaend = irela + section->reloc_count;
12014 	      for (; irela < irelaend; irela++)
12015 		{
12016 		  enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
12017 		  unsigned int r_indx;
12018 		  enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
12019 		  struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
12020 		  asection *sym_sec, *code_sec;
12021 		  bfd_vma sym_value, code_value;
12022 		  bfd_vma destination;
12023 		  unsigned long local_off;
12024 		  bfd_boolean ok_dest;
12025 		  struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash;
12026 		  struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
12027 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12028 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
12029 		  char *stub_name;
12030 		  const asection *id_sec;
12031 		  struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
12032 		  struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
12033 
12034 		  r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (irela->r_info);
12035 		  r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
12036 
12037 		  if (r_type >= R_PPC64_max)
12038 		    {
12039 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12040 		      goto error_ret_free_internal;
12041 		    }
12042 
12043 		  /* Only look for stubs on branch instructions.  */
12044 		  if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
12045 		      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
12046 		      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
12047 		      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
12048 		      && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
12049 		    continue;
12050 
12051 		  /* Now determine the call target, its name, value,
12052 		     section.  */
12053 		  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
12054 				  r_indx, input_bfd))
12055 		    goto error_ret_free_internal;
12056 		  hash = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
12057 
12058 		  ok_dest = FALSE;
12059 		  fdh = NULL;
12060 		  sym_value = 0;
12061 		  if (hash == NULL)
12062 		    {
12063 		      sym_value = sym->st_value;
12064 		      if (sym_sec != NULL
12065 			  && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
12066 			ok_dest = TRUE;
12067 		    }
12068 		  else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12069 			   || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12070 		    {
12071 		      sym_value = hash->elf.root.u.def.value;
12072 		      if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
12073 			ok_dest = TRUE;
12074 		    }
12075 		  else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
12076 			   || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
12077 		    {
12078 		      /* Recognise an old ABI func code entry sym, and
12079 			 use the func descriptor sym instead if it is
12080 			 defined.  */
12081 		      if (hash->elf.root.root.string[0] == '.'
12082 			  && hash->oh != NULL)
12083 			{
12084 			  fdh = ppc_follow_link (hash->oh);
12085 			  if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12086 			      || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12087 			    {
12088 			      sym_sec = fdh->elf.root.u.def.section;
12089 			      sym_value = fdh->elf.root.u.def.value;
12090 			      if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
12091 				ok_dest = TRUE;
12092 			    }
12093 			  else
12094 			    fdh = NULL;
12095 			}
12096 		    }
12097 		  else
12098 		    {
12099 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12100 		      goto error_ret_free_internal;
12101 		    }
12102 
12103 		  destination = 0;
12104 		  local_off = 0;
12105 		  if (ok_dest)
12106 		    {
12107 		      sym_value += irela->r_addend;
12108 		      destination = (sym_value
12109 				     + sym_sec->output_offset
12110 				     + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
12111 		      local_off = PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (hash
12112 							    ? hash->elf.other
12113 							    : sym->st_other);
12114 		    }
12115 
12116 		  code_sec = sym_sec;
12117 		  code_value = sym_value;
12118 		  opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
12119 		  if (opd != NULL)
12120 		    {
12121 		      bfd_vma dest;
12122 
12123 		      if (hash == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
12124 			{
12125 			  long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
12126 			  if (adjust == -1)
12127 			    continue;
12128 			  code_value += adjust;
12129 			  sym_value += adjust;
12130 			}
12131 		      dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
12132 					      &code_sec, &code_value, FALSE);
12133 		      if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
12134 			{
12135 			  destination = dest;
12136 			  if (fdh != NULL)
12137 			    {
12138 			      /* Fixup old ABI sym to point at code
12139 				 entry.  */
12140 			      hash->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defweak;
12141 			      hash->elf.root.u.def.section = code_sec;
12142 			      hash->elf.root.u.def.value = code_value;
12143 			    }
12144 			}
12145 		    }
12146 
12147 		  /* Determine what (if any) linker stub is needed.  */
12148 		  plt_ent = NULL;
12149 		  stub_type = ppc_type_of_stub (section, irela, &hash,
12150 						&plt_ent, destination,
12151 						local_off);
12152 
12153 		  if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
12154 		    {
12155 		      if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
12156 			stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
12157 		      else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
12158 			       || (code_sec != NULL
12159 				   && code_sec->output_section != NULL
12160 				   && (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
12161 					& STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
12162 				       != 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
12163 			stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc;
12164 		    }
12165 		  else if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call)
12166 		    {
12167 		      /* Check whether we need a TOC adjusting stub.
12168 			 Since the linker pastes together pieces from
12169 			 different object files when creating the
12170 			 _init and _fini functions, it may be that a
12171 			 call to what looks like a local sym is in
12172 			 fact a call needing a TOC adjustment.  */
12173 		      if ((code_sec != NULL
12174 			   && code_sec->output_section != NULL
12175 			   && (htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].toc_off
12176 			       != htab->sec_info[section->id].toc_off)
12177 			   && (code_sec->has_toc_reloc
12178 			       || code_sec->makes_toc_func_call))
12179 			  || (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
12180 			       & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
12181 			      == 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT))
12182 			stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off;
12183 		    }
12184 
12185 		  if (stub_type == ppc_stub_none)
12186 		    continue;
12187 
12188 		  /* __tls_get_addr calls might be eliminated.  */
12189 		  if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call
12190 		      && stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
12191 		      && hash != NULL
12192 		      && (hash == htab->tls_get_addr
12193 			  || hash == htab->tls_get_addr_fd)
12194 		      && section->has_tls_reloc
12195 		      && irela != internal_relocs)
12196 		    {
12197 		      /* Get tls info.  */
12198 		      unsigned char *tls_mask;
12199 
12200 		      if (!get_tls_mask (&tls_mask, NULL, NULL, &local_syms,
12201 					 irela - 1, input_bfd))
12202 			goto error_ret_free_internal;
12203 		      if ((*tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0)
12204 			continue;
12205 		    }
12206 
12207 		  if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
12208 		    {
12209 		      if (!htab->opd_abi
12210 			  && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
12211 			  && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&hash->elf))
12212 			htab->has_plt_localentry0 = 1;
12213 		      else if (irela + 1 < irelaend
12214 			       && irela[1].r_offset == irela->r_offset + 4
12215 			       && (ELF64_R_TYPE (irela[1].r_info)
12216 				   == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE))
12217 			{
12218 			  if (!tocsave_find (htab, INSERT,
12219 					     &local_syms, irela + 1, input_bfd))
12220 			    goto error_ret_free_internal;
12221 			}
12222 		      else
12223 			stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save;
12224 		    }
12225 
12226 		  /* Support for grouping stub sections.  */
12227 		  id_sec = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group->link_sec;
12228 
12229 		  /* Get the name of this stub.  */
12230 		  stub_name = ppc_stub_name (id_sec, sym_sec, hash, irela);
12231 		  if (!stub_name)
12232 		    goto error_ret_free_internal;
12233 
12234 		  stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
12235 						     stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
12236 		  if (stub_entry != NULL)
12237 		    {
12238 		      enum ppc_stub_type old_type;
12239 		      /* A stub has already been created, but it may
12240 			 not be the required type.  We shouldn't be
12241 			 transitioning from plt_call to long_branch
12242 			 stubs or vice versa, but we might be
12243 			 upgrading from plt_call to plt_call_r2save or
12244 			 from long_branch to long_branch_r2off.  */
12245 		      free (stub_name);
12246 		      old_type = stub_entry->stub_type;
12247 		      switch (old_type)
12248 			{
12249 			default:
12250 			  abort ();
12251 
12252 			case ppc_stub_save_res:
12253 			  continue;
12254 
12255 			case ppc_stub_plt_call:
12256 			case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
12257 			case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
12258 			case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
12259 			  if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
12260 			    continue;
12261 			  else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
12262 			    {
12263 			      if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
12264 				stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
12265 			    }
12266 			  else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
12267 			    {
12268 			      if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
12269 				stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
12270 			    }
12271 			  else
12272 			    abort ();
12273 			  break;
12274 
12275 			case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
12276 			case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
12277 			case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
12278 			case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
12279 			  old_type += (ppc_stub_long_branch
12280 				       - ppc_stub_plt_branch);
12281 			  /* Fall through.  */
12282 			case ppc_stub_long_branch:
12283 			case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
12284 			case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
12285 			case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
12286 			  if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch)
12287 			    continue;
12288 			  else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
12289 			    {
12290 			      if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
12291 				stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
12292 			    }
12293 			  else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
12294 			    {
12295 			      if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
12296 				stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
12297 			    }
12298 			  else
12299 			    abort ();
12300 			  break;
12301 			}
12302 		      if (old_type < stub_type)
12303 			stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
12304 		      continue;
12305 		    }
12306 
12307 		  stub_entry = ppc_add_stub (stub_name, section, info);
12308 		  if (stub_entry == NULL)
12309 		    {
12310 		      free (stub_name);
12311 		    error_ret_free_internal:
12312 		      if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs == NULL)
12313 			free (internal_relocs);
12314 		    error_ret_free_local:
12315 		      if (local_syms != NULL
12316 			  && (symtab_hdr->contents
12317 			      != (unsigned char *) local_syms))
12318 			free (local_syms);
12319 		      return FALSE;
12320 		    }
12321 
12322 		  stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
12323 		  if (stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
12324 		      && stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
12325 		    {
12326 		      stub_entry->target_value = sym_value;
12327 		      stub_entry->target_section = sym_sec;
12328 		    }
12329 		  else
12330 		    {
12331 		      stub_entry->target_value = code_value;
12332 		      stub_entry->target_section = code_sec;
12333 		    }
12334 		  stub_entry->h = hash;
12335 		  stub_entry->plt_ent = plt_ent;
12336 		  stub_entry->symtype
12337 		    = hash ? hash->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
12338 		  stub_entry->other = hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other;
12339 
12340 		  if (hash != NULL
12341 		      && (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12342 			  || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
12343 		    htab->stub_globals += 1;
12344 		}
12345 
12346 	      /* We're done with the internal relocs, free them.  */
12347 	      if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs != internal_relocs)
12348 		free (internal_relocs);
12349 	    }
12350 
12351 	  if (local_syms != NULL
12352 	      && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
12353 	    {
12354 	      if (!info->keep_memory)
12355 		free (local_syms);
12356 	      else
12357 		symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
12358 	    }
12359 	}
12360 
12361       /* We may have added some stubs.  Find out the new size of the
12362 	 stub sections.  */
12363       for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
12364 	{
12365 	  group->lr_restore = 0;
12366 	  group->eh_size = 0;
12367 	  if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
12368 	    {
12369 	      asection *stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
12370 
12371 	      if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
12372 		  || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size)
12373 		/* Past STUB_SHRINK_ITER, rawsize is the max size seen.  */
12374 		stub_sec->rawsize = stub_sec->size;
12375 	      stub_sec->size = 0;
12376 	      stub_sec->reloc_count = 0;
12377 	      stub_sec->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
12378 	    }
12379 	}
12380 
12381       if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
12382 	  || htab->brlt->rawsize < htab->brlt->size)
12383 	htab->brlt->rawsize = htab->brlt->size;
12384       htab->brlt->size = 0;
12385       htab->brlt->reloc_count = 0;
12386       htab->brlt->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
12387       if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
12388 	htab->relbrlt->size = 0;
12389 
12390       bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_size_one_stub, info);
12391 
12392       for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
12393 	if (group->needs_save_res)
12394 	  group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
12395 
12396       if (info->emitrelocations
12397 	  && htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
12398 	{
12399 	  htab->glink->reloc_count = 1;
12400 	  htab->glink->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
12401 	}
12402 
12403       if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
12404 	  && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
12405 	  && htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->size > 8)
12406 	{
12407 	  size_t size = 0, align = 4;
12408 
12409 	  for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
12410 	    if (group->eh_size != 0)
12411 	      size += (group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align;
12412 	  if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
12413 	    size += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
12414 	  if (size != 0)
12415 	    size += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
12416 	  align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
12417 	  size = (size + align - 1) & -align;
12418 	  htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize = htab->glink_eh_frame->size;
12419 	  htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size;
12420 	}
12421 
12422       if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
12423 	for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
12424 	  if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
12425 	    {
12426 	      int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
12427 	      group->stub_sec->size
12428 		= (group->stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
12429 	    }
12430 
12431       for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
12432 	if (group->stub_sec != NULL
12433 	    && group->stub_sec->rawsize != group->stub_sec->size
12434 	    && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
12435 		|| group->stub_sec->rawsize < group->stub_sec->size))
12436 	  break;
12437 
12438       if (group == NULL
12439 	  && (htab->brlt->rawsize == htab->brlt->size
12440 	      || (htab->stub_iteration > STUB_SHRINK_ITER
12441 		  && htab->brlt->rawsize > htab->brlt->size))
12442 	  && (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
12443 	      || htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize == htab->glink_eh_frame->size))
12444 	break;
12445 
12446       /* Ask the linker to do its stuff.  */
12447       (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
12448     }
12449 
12450   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
12451       && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
12452     {
12453       bfd_vma val;
12454       bfd_byte *p, *last_fde;
12455       size_t last_fde_len, size, align, pad;
12456       struct map_stub *group;
12457 
12458       /* It is necessary to at least have a rough outline of the
12459 	 linker generated CIEs and FDEs written before
12460 	 bfd_elf_discard_info is run, in order for these FDEs to be
12461 	 indexed in .eh_frame_hdr.  */
12462       p = bfd_zalloc (htab->glink_eh_frame->owner, htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
12463       if (p == NULL)
12464 	return FALSE;
12465       htab->glink_eh_frame->contents = p;
12466       last_fde = p;
12467       align = 4;
12468 
12469       memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
12470       /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian).  */
12471       last_fde_len = ((sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
12472       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
12473       p += last_fde_len + 4;
12474 
12475       for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
12476 	if (group->eh_size != 0)
12477 	  {
12478 	    group->eh_base = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
12479 	    last_fde = p;
12480 	    last_fde_len = ((group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
12481 	    /* FDE length.  */
12482 	    bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
12483 	    p += 4;
12484 	    /* CIE pointer.  */
12485 	    val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
12486 	    bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
12487 	    p += 4;
12488 	    /* Offset to stub section, written later.  */
12489 	    p += 4;
12490 	    /* stub section size.  */
12491 	    bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, group->stub_sec->size, p);
12492 	    p += 4;
12493 	    /* Augmentation.  */
12494 	    p += 1;
12495 	    /* Make sure we don't have all nops.  This is enough for
12496 	       elf-eh-frame.c to detect the last non-nop opcode.  */
12497 	    p[group->eh_size - 1] = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
12498 	    p = last_fde + last_fde_len + 4;
12499 	  }
12500       if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
12501 	{
12502 	  last_fde = p;
12503 	  last_fde_len = ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
12504 	  /* FDE length.  */
12505 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
12506 	  p += 4;
12507 	  /* CIE pointer.  */
12508 	  val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
12509 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
12510 	  p += 4;
12511 	  /* Offset to .glink, written later.  */
12512 	  p += 4;
12513 	  /* .glink size.  */
12514 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size - 8, p);
12515 	  p += 4;
12516 	  /* Augmentation.  */
12517 	  p += 1;
12518 
12519 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
12520 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
12521 	  *p++ = 65;
12522 	  *p++ = htab->opd_abi ? 12 : 0;
12523 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + (htab->opd_abi ? 5 : 7);
12524 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
12525 	  *p++ = 65;
12526 	  p += ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 24;
12527 	}
12528       /* Subsume any padding into the last FDE if user .eh_frame
12529 	 sections are aligned more than glink_eh_frame.  Otherwise any
12530 	 zero padding will be seen as a terminator.  */
12531       align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
12532       size = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
12533       pad = ((size + align - 1) & -align) - size;
12534       htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size + pad;
12535       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len + pad, last_fde);
12536     }
12537 
12538   maybe_strip_output (info, htab->brlt);
12539   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL)
12540     maybe_strip_output (info, htab->glink_eh_frame);
12541 
12542   return TRUE;
12543 }
12544 
12545 /* Called after we have determined section placement.  If sections
12546    move, we'll be called again.  Provide a value for TOCstart.  */
12547 
12548 bfd_vma
12549 ppc64_elf_set_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *obfd)
12550 {
12551   asection *s;
12552   bfd_vma TOCstart, adjust;
12553 
12554   if (info != NULL)
12555     {
12556       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12557       struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
12558 
12559       if (is_elf_hash_table (htab)
12560 	  && htab->hgot != NULL)
12561 	h = htab->hgot;
12562       else
12563 	{
12564 	  h = elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, ".TOC.", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
12565 	  if (is_elf_hash_table (htab))
12566 	    htab->hgot = h;
12567 	}
12568       if (h != NULL
12569 	  && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12570 	  && !h->root.linker_def
12571 	  && (!is_elf_hash_table (htab)
12572 	      || h->def_regular))
12573 	{
12574 	  TOCstart = (h->root.u.def.value - TOC_BASE_OFF
12575 		      + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
12576 		      + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
12577 	  _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
12578 	  return TOCstart;
12579 	}
12580     }
12581 
12582   /* The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, .plt in that
12583      order.  The TOC starts where the first of these sections starts.  */
12584   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".got");
12585   if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12586     s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".toc");
12587   if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12588     s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".tocbss");
12589   if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12590     s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".plt");
12591   if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12592     {
12593       /* This may happen for
12594 	 o  references to TOC base (SYM@toc / TOC[tc0]) without a
12595 	 .toc directive
12596 	 o  bad linker script
12597 	 o --gc-sections and empty TOC sections
12598 
12599 	 FIXME: Warn user?  */
12600 
12601       /* Look for a likely section.  We probably won't even be
12602 	 using TOCstart.  */
12603       for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12604 	if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_READONLY
12605 			 | SEC_EXCLUDE))
12606 	    == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
12607 	  break;
12608       if (s == NULL)
12609 	for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12610 	  if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_EXCLUDE))
12611 	      == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
12612 	    break;
12613       if (s == NULL)
12614 	for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12615 	  if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY | SEC_EXCLUDE))
12616 	      == SEC_ALLOC)
12617 	    break;
12618       if (s == NULL)
12619 	for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12620 	  if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_ALLOC)
12621 	    break;
12622     }
12623 
12624   TOCstart = 0;
12625   if (s != NULL)
12626     TOCstart = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
12627 
12628   /* Force alignment.  */
12629   adjust = TOCstart & (TOC_BASE_ALIGN - 1);
12630   TOCstart -= adjust;
12631   _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
12632 
12633   if (info != NULL && s != NULL)
12634     {
12635       struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12636 
12637       if (htab != NULL)
12638 	{
12639 	  if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
12640 	    {
12641 	      htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust;
12642 	      htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = s;
12643 	    }
12644 	}
12645       else
12646 	{
12647 	  struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
12648 	  _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, obfd, ".TOC.", BSF_GLOBAL,
12649 					    s, TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust,
12650 					    NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh);
12651 	}
12652     }
12653   return TOCstart;
12654 }
12655 
12656 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_build_stubs to
12657    write out any global entry stubs, and PLT relocations.  */
12658 
12659 static bfd_boolean
12660 build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
12661 {
12662   struct bfd_link_info *info;
12663   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12664   struct plt_entry *ent;
12665   asection *s;
12666 
12667   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12668     return TRUE;
12669 
12670   info = inf;
12671   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12672   if (htab == NULL)
12673     return FALSE;
12674 
12675   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
12676     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12677       {
12678 	/* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage
12679 	   table.  Set it up.  */
12680 	Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
12681 	asection *plt, *relplt;
12682 	bfd_byte *loc;
12683 
12684 	if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
12685 	    || h->dynindx == -1)
12686 	  {
12687 	    if (!(h->def_regular
12688 		  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12689 		      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)))
12690 	      continue;
12691 	    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12692 	      {
12693 		plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12694 		relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
12695 		htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
12696 		if (htab->opd_abi)
12697 		  rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
12698 		else
12699 		  rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
12700 	      }
12701 	    else
12702 	      {
12703 		plt = htab->pltlocal;
12704 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
12705 		  {
12706 		    relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
12707 		    if (htab->opd_abi)
12708 		      rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
12709 		    else
12710 		      rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
12711 		  }
12712 		else
12713 		  relplt = NULL;
12714 	      }
12715 	    rela.r_addend = (h->root.u.def.value
12716 			     + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
12717 			     + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
12718 			     + ent->addend);
12719 
12720 	    if (relplt == NULL)
12721 	      {
12722 		loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
12723 		bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
12724 		if (htab->opd_abi)
12725 		  {
12726 		    bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12727 		    toc += htab->sec_info[h->root.u.def.section->id].toc_off;
12728 		    bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
12729 		  }
12730 	      }
12731 	    else
12732 	      {
12733 		rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
12734 				 + plt->output_offset
12735 				 + ent->plt.offset);
12736 		loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
12737 					  * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
12738 		bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
12739 	      }
12740 	  }
12741 	else
12742 	  {
12743 	    rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
12744 			     + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
12745 			     + ent->plt.offset);
12746 	    rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
12747 	    rela.r_addend = ent->addend;
12748 	    loc = (htab->elf.srelplt->contents
12749 		   + ((ent->plt.offset - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
12750 		      / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)));
12751 	    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
12752 	      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
12753 	    bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
12754 	  }
12755       }
12756 
12757   if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
12758     return TRUE;
12759 
12760   if (h->def_regular)
12761     return TRUE;
12762 
12763   s = htab->global_entry;
12764   if (s == NULL || s->size == 0)
12765     return TRUE;
12766 
12767   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
12768     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
12769 	&& ent->addend == 0)
12770       {
12771 	bfd_byte *p;
12772 	asection *plt;
12773 	bfd_vma off;
12774 
12775 	p = s->contents + h->root.u.def.value;
12776 	plt = htab->elf.splt;
12777 	if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
12778 	    || h->dynindx == -1)
12779 	  {
12780 	    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12781 	      plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12782 	    else
12783 	      plt = htab->pltlocal;
12784 	  }
12785 	off = ent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
12786 	off -= h->root.u.def.value + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
12787 
12788 	if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 3) != 0)
12789 	  {
12790 	    info->callbacks->einfo
12791 	      (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
12792 	       h->root.root.string);
12793 	    bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12794 	    htab->stub_error = TRUE;
12795 	  }
12796 
12797 	htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1] += 1;
12798 	if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
12799 	  {
12800 	    size_t len = strlen (h->root.root.string);
12801 	    char *name = bfd_malloc (sizeof "12345678.global_entry." + len);
12802 
12803 	    if (name == NULL)
12804 	      return FALSE;
12805 
12806 	    sprintf (name, "%08x.global_entry.%s", s->id, h->root.root.string);
12807 	    h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
12808 	    if (h == NULL)
12809 	      return FALSE;
12810 	    if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
12811 	      {
12812 		h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
12813 		h->root.u.def.section = s;
12814 		h->root.u.def.value = p - s->contents;
12815 		h->ref_regular = 1;
12816 		h->def_regular = 1;
12817 		h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
12818 		h->forced_local = 1;
12819 		h->non_elf = 0;
12820 		h->root.linker_def = 1;
12821 	      }
12822 	  }
12823 
12824 	if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
12825 	  {
12826 	    bfd_put_32 (s->owner, ADDIS_R12_R12 | PPC_HA (off), p);
12827 	    p += 4;
12828 	  }
12829 	bfd_put_32 (s->owner, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
12830 	p += 4;
12831 	bfd_put_32 (s->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
12832 	p += 4;
12833 	bfd_put_32 (s->owner, BCTR, p);
12834 	break;
12835       }
12836   return TRUE;
12837 }
12838 
12839 /* Write PLT relocs for locals.  */
12840 
12841 static bfd_boolean
12842 write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12843 {
12844   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12845   bfd *ibfd;
12846 
12847   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12848     {
12849       struct got_entry **lgot_ents, **end_lgot_ents;
12850       struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
12851       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12852       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
12853       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
12854       struct plt_entry *ent;
12855 
12856       if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12857 	continue;
12858 
12859       lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
12860       if (!lgot_ents)
12861 	continue;
12862 
12863       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
12864       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
12865       end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
12866       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
12867       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
12868       for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
12869 	for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
12870 	  if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12871 	    {
12872 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
12873 	      asection *sym_sec;
12874 	      asection *plt, *relplt;
12875 	      bfd_byte *loc;
12876 	      bfd_vma val;
12877 
12878 	      if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
12879 			      lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
12880 		{
12881 		  if (local_syms != NULL
12882 		      && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
12883 		    free (local_syms);
12884 		  return FALSE;
12885 		}
12886 
12887 	      val = sym->st_value + ent->addend;
12888 	      if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12889 		val += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (sym->st_other);
12890 	      if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
12891 		val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
12892 
12893 	      if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12894 		{
12895 		  htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
12896 		  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
12897 		  relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
12898 		}
12899 	      else
12900 		{
12901 		  plt = htab->pltlocal;
12902 		  relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
12903 		}
12904 
12905 	      if (relplt == NULL)
12906 		{
12907 		  loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
12908 		  bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
12909 		  if (htab->opd_abi)
12910 		    {
12911 		      bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (ibfd);
12912 		      bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
12913 		    }
12914 		}
12915 	      else
12916 		{
12917 		  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
12918 		  rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
12919 				   + plt->output_offset
12920 				   + plt->output_section->vma);
12921 		  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
12922 		    {
12923 		      if (htab->opd_abi)
12924 			rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
12925 		      else
12926 			rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
12927 		    }
12928 		  else
12929 		    {
12930 		      if (htab->opd_abi)
12931 			rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
12932 		      else
12933 			rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
12934 		    }
12935 		  rela.r_addend = val;
12936 		  loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
12937 					    * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
12938 		  bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
12939 		}
12940 	    }
12941 
12942       if (local_syms != NULL
12943 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
12944 	{
12945 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
12946 	    free (local_syms);
12947 	  else
12948 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
12949 	}
12950     }
12951   return TRUE;
12952 }
12953 
12954 /* Build all the stubs associated with the current output file.
12955    The stubs are kept in a hash table attached to the main linker
12956    hash table.  This function is called via gldelf64ppc_finish.  */
12957 
12958 bfd_boolean
12959 ppc64_elf_build_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12960 		       char **stats)
12961 {
12962   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12963   struct map_stub *group;
12964   asection *stub_sec;
12965   bfd_byte *p;
12966   int stub_sec_count = 0;
12967 
12968   if (htab == NULL)
12969     return FALSE;
12970 
12971   /* Allocate memory to hold the linker stubs.  */
12972   for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
12973     {
12974       group->eh_size = 0;
12975       group->lr_restore = 0;
12976       if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL
12977 	  && stub_sec->size != 0)
12978 	{
12979 	  stub_sec->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd,
12980 					   stub_sec->size);
12981 	  if (stub_sec->contents == NULL)
12982 	    return FALSE;
12983 	  stub_sec->size = 0;
12984 	}
12985     }
12986 
12987   if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
12988     {
12989       unsigned int indx;
12990       bfd_vma plt0;
12991 
12992       /* Build the .glink plt call stub.  */
12993       if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
12994 	{
12995 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12996 	  h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
12997 				    TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
12998 	  if (h == NULL)
12999 	    return FALSE;
13000 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
13001 	    {
13002 	      h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
13003 	      h->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
13004 	      h->root.u.def.value = 8;
13005 	      h->ref_regular = 1;
13006 	      h->def_regular = 1;
13007 	      h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
13008 	      h->forced_local = 1;
13009 	      h->non_elf = 0;
13010 	      h->root.linker_def = 1;
13011 	    }
13012 	}
13013       plt0 = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
13014 	      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
13015 	      - 16);
13016       if (info->emitrelocations)
13017 	{
13018 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *r = get_relocs (htab->glink, 1);
13019 	  if (r == NULL)
13020 	    return FALSE;
13021 	  r->r_offset = (htab->glink->output_offset
13022 			 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
13023 	  r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL64);
13024 	  r->r_addend = plt0;
13025 	}
13026       p = htab->glink->contents;
13027       plt0 -= htab->glink->output_section->vma + htab->glink->output_offset;
13028       bfd_put_64 (htab->glink->owner, plt0, p);
13029       p += 8;
13030       if (htab->opd_abi)
13031 	{
13032 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R12, p);
13033 	  p += 4;
13034 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
13035 	  p += 4;
13036 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
13037 	  p += 4;
13038 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
13039 	  p += 4;
13040 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R12, p);
13041 	  p += 4;
13042 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
13043 	  p += 4;
13044 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
13045 	  p += 4;
13046 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | 8, p);
13047 	  p += 4;
13048 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
13049 	  p += 4;
13050 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 16, p);
13051 	  p += 4;
13052 	}
13053       else
13054 	{
13055 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R0, p);
13056 	  p += 4;
13057 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
13058 	  p += 4;
13059 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
13060 	  p += 4;
13061 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, STD_R2_0R1 + 24, p);
13062 	  p += 4;
13063 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
13064 	  p += 4;
13065 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R0, p);
13066 	  p += 4;
13067 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SUB_R12_R12_R11, p);
13068 	  p += 4;
13069 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
13070 	  p += 4;
13071 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADDI_R0_R12 | (-48 & 0xffff), p);
13072 	  p += 4;
13073 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
13074 	  p += 4;
13075 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SRDI_R0_R0_2, p);
13076 	  p += 4;
13077 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
13078 	  p += 4;
13079 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 8, p);
13080 	  p += 4;
13081 	}
13082       bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCTR, p);
13083       p += 4;
13084       BFD_ASSERT (p == htab->glink->contents + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab));
13085 
13086       /* Build the .glink lazy link call stubs.  */
13087       indx = 0;
13088       while (p < htab->glink->contents + htab->glink->size)
13089 	{
13090 	  if (htab->opd_abi)
13091 	    {
13092 	      if (indx < 0x8000)
13093 		{
13094 		  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LI_R0_0 | indx, p);
13095 		  p += 4;
13096 		}
13097 	      else
13098 		{
13099 		  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LIS_R0_0 | PPC_HI (indx), p);
13100 		  p += 4;
13101 		  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ORI_R0_R0_0 | PPC_LO (indx),
13102 			      p);
13103 		  p += 4;
13104 		}
13105 	    }
13106 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner,
13107 		      B_DOT | ((htab->glink->contents - p + 8) & 0x3fffffc), p);
13108 	  indx++;
13109 	  p += 4;
13110 	}
13111     }
13112 
13113   /* Build .glink global entry stubs, and PLT relocs for globals.  */
13114   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt, info);
13115 
13116   if (!write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (info))
13117     return FALSE;
13118 
13119   if (htab->brlt != NULL && htab->brlt->size != 0)
13120     {
13121       htab->brlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->brlt->owner,
13122 					 htab->brlt->size);
13123       if (htab->brlt->contents == NULL)
13124 	return FALSE;
13125     }
13126   if (htab->relbrlt != NULL && htab->relbrlt->size != 0)
13127     {
13128       htab->relbrlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->relbrlt->owner,
13129 					    htab->relbrlt->size);
13130       if (htab->relbrlt->contents == NULL)
13131 	return FALSE;
13132     }
13133 
13134   /* Build the stubs as directed by the stub hash table.  */
13135   bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_build_one_stub, info);
13136 
13137   for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13138     if (group->needs_save_res)
13139       group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
13140 
13141   if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13142     htab->relbrlt->reloc_count = 0;
13143 
13144   if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
13145     for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13146       if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
13147 	{
13148 	  int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
13149 	  stub_sec->size = (stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
13150 	}
13151 
13152   for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13153     if (group->needs_save_res)
13154       {
13155 	stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
13156 	memcpy (stub_sec->contents + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size,
13157 		htab->sfpr->contents, htab->sfpr->size);
13158 	if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
13159 	  {
13160 	    unsigned int i;
13161 
13162 	    for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
13163 	      if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], stub_sec))
13164 		return FALSE;
13165 	  }
13166       }
13167 
13168   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13169       && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
13170     {
13171       bfd_vma val;
13172       size_t align = 4;
13173 
13174       p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13175       p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
13176 
13177       for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13178 	if (group->eh_size != 0)
13179 	  {
13180 	    /* Offset to stub section.  */
13181 	    val = (group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
13182 		   + group->stub_sec->output_offset);
13183 	    val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
13184 		    + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
13185 		    + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
13186 	    if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
13187 	      {
13188 		_bfd_error_handler
13189 		  (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
13190 		   group->stub_sec->name);
13191 		return FALSE;
13192 	      }
13193 	    bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
13194 	    p += (group->eh_size + 17 + 3) & -4;
13195 	  }
13196       if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13197 	{
13198 	  /* Offset to .glink.  */
13199 	  val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
13200 		 + htab->glink->output_offset
13201 		 + 8);
13202 	  val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
13203 		  + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
13204 		  + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
13205 	  if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
13206 	    {
13207 	      _bfd_error_handler
13208 		(_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
13209 		 htab->glink->name);
13210 	      return FALSE;
13211 	    }
13212 	  bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
13213 	  p += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
13214 	}
13215     }
13216 
13217   for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13218     if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
13219       {
13220 	stub_sec_count += 1;
13221 	if (stub_sec->rawsize != stub_sec->size
13222 	    && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13223 		|| stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size))
13224 	  break;
13225       }
13226 
13227   if (group != NULL)
13228     {
13229       htab->stub_error = TRUE;
13230       _bfd_error_handler (_("stubs don't match calculated size"));
13231     }
13232 
13233   if (htab->stub_error)
13234     return FALSE;
13235 
13236   if (stats != NULL)
13237     {
13238       size_t len;
13239       *stats = bfd_malloc (500);
13240       if (*stats == NULL)
13241 	return FALSE;
13242 
13243       len = sprintf (*stats,
13244 		     ngettext ("linker stubs in %u group\n",
13245 			       "linker stubs in %u groups\n",
13246 			       stub_sec_count),
13247 		     stub_sec_count);
13248       sprintf (*stats + len, _("  branch         %lu\n"
13249 			       "  branch toc adj %lu\n"
13250 			       "  branch notoc   %lu\n"
13251 			       "  branch both    %lu\n"
13252 			       "  long branch    %lu\n"
13253 			       "  long toc adj   %lu\n"
13254 			       "  long notoc     %lu\n"
13255 			       "  long both      %lu\n"
13256 			       "  plt call       %lu\n"
13257 			       "  plt call save  %lu\n"
13258 			       "  plt call notoc %lu\n"
13259 			       "  plt call both  %lu\n"
13260 			       "  global entry   %lu"),
13261 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch - 1],
13262 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off - 1],
13263 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc - 1],
13264 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_both - 1],
13265 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch - 1],
13266 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off - 1],
13267 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc - 1],
13268 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_both - 1],
13269 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call - 1],
13270 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save - 1],
13271 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc - 1],
13272 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_both - 1],
13273 	       htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1]);
13274     }
13275   return TRUE;
13276 }
13277 
13278 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
13279    discarded sections.  */
13280 
13281 static unsigned int
13282 ppc64_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
13283 {
13284   if (strcmp (".opd", sec->name) == 0)
13285     return 0;
13286 
13287   if (strcmp (".toc", sec->name) == 0)
13288     return 0;
13289 
13290   if (strcmp (".toc1", sec->name) == 0)
13291     return 0;
13292 
13293   return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
13294 }
13295 
13296 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
13297    to handle the relocations for a section.
13298 
13299    The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
13300    actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
13301    zero.
13302 
13303    This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
13304    necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
13305    relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
13306    necessary.
13307 
13308    This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
13309    address or the reloc symbol index.
13310 
13311    LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
13312 
13313    LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
13314    corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
13315 
13316    The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
13317    via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
13318 
13319    When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
13320    STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially.  The output symbol is
13321    going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
13322    section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
13323    accordingly.  */
13324 
13325 static bfd_boolean
13326 ppc64_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
13327 			    struct bfd_link_info *info,
13328 			    bfd *input_bfd,
13329 			    asection *input_section,
13330 			    bfd_byte *contents,
13331 			    Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
13332 			    Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
13333 			    asection **local_sections)
13334 {
13335   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
13336   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13337   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
13338   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
13339   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
13340   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
13341   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
13342   bfd_byte *loc;
13343   struct got_entry **local_got_ents;
13344   bfd_vma TOCstart;
13345   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
13346   bfd_boolean is_opd;
13347   /* Assume 'at' branch hints.  */
13348   bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
13349   bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
13350 
13351   /* Initialize howto table if needed.  */
13352   if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
13353     ppc_howto_init ();
13354 
13355   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13356   if (htab == NULL)
13357     return FALSE;
13358 
13359   /* Don't relocate stub sections.  */
13360   if (input_section->owner == htab->params->stub_bfd)
13361     return TRUE;
13362 
13363   if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
13364     {
13365       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
13366       return FALSE;
13367     }
13368 
13369   local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (input_bfd);
13370   TOCstart = elf_gp (output_bfd);
13371   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
13372   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
13373   is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_type == sec_opd;
13374 
13375   rel = wrel = relocs;
13376   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
13377   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
13378     {
13379       enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
13380       bfd_vma addend;
13381       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
13382       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
13383       asection *sec;
13384       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h_elf;
13385       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
13386       struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
13387       const char *sym_name;
13388       unsigned long r_symndx, toc_symndx;
13389       bfd_vma toc_addend;
13390       unsigned char tls_mask, tls_gd, tls_type;
13391       unsigned char sym_type;
13392       bfd_vma relocation;
13393       bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
13394       bfd_boolean warned;
13395       enum { DEST_NORMAL, DEST_OPD, DEST_STUB } reloc_dest;
13396       unsigned int insn;
13397       unsigned int mask;
13398       struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
13399       bfd_vma max_br_offset;
13400       bfd_vma from;
13401       Elf_Internal_Rela orig_rel;
13402       reloc_howto_type *howto;
13403       struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
13404 
13405     again:
13406       orig_rel = *rel;
13407 
13408       r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
13409       r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
13410 
13411       /* For old style R_PPC64_TOC relocs with a zero symbol, use the
13412 	 symbol of the previous ADDR64 reloc.  The symbol gives us the
13413 	 proper TOC base to use.  */
13414       if (rel->r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC)
13415 	  && wrel != relocs
13416 	  && ELF64_R_TYPE (wrel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
13417 	  && is_opd)
13418 	r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (wrel[-1].r_info);
13419 
13420       sym = NULL;
13421       sec = NULL;
13422       h_elf = NULL;
13423       sym_name = NULL;
13424       unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
13425       warned = FALSE;
13426 
13427       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
13428 	{
13429 	  /* It's a local symbol.  */
13430 	  struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
13431 
13432 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
13433 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
13434 	  sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
13435 	  sym_type = ELF64_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
13436 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
13437 	  opd = get_opd_info (sec);
13438 	  if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
13439 	    {
13440 	      long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value
13441 						 + rel->r_addend)];
13442 	      if (adjust == -1)
13443 		relocation = 0;
13444 	      else
13445 		{
13446 		  /* If this is a relocation against the opd section sym
13447 		     and we have edited .opd, adjust the reloc addend so
13448 		     that ld -r and ld --emit-relocs output is correct.
13449 		     If it is a reloc against some other .opd symbol,
13450 		     then the symbol value will be adjusted later.  */
13451 		  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
13452 		    rel->r_addend += adjust;
13453 		  else
13454 		    relocation += adjust;
13455 		}
13456 	    }
13457 	}
13458       else
13459 	{
13460 	  bfd_boolean ignored;
13461 
13462 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
13463 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
13464 				   h_elf, sec, relocation,
13465 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
13466 	  sym_name = h_elf->root.root.string;
13467 	  sym_type = h_elf->type;
13468 	  if (sec != NULL
13469 	      && sec->owner == output_bfd
13470 	      && strcmp (sec->name, ".opd") == 0)
13471 	    {
13472 	      /* This is a symbol defined in a linker script.  All
13473 		 such are defined in output sections, even those
13474 		 defined by simple assignment from a symbol defined in
13475 		 an input section.  Transfer the symbol to an
13476 		 appropriate input .opd section, so that a branch to
13477 		 this symbol will be mapped to the location specified
13478 		 by the opd entry.  */
13479 	      struct bfd_link_order *lo;
13480 	      for (lo = sec->map_head.link_order; lo != NULL; lo = lo->next)
13481 		if (lo->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
13482 		  {
13483 		    asection *isec = lo->u.indirect.section;
13484 		    if (h_elf->root.u.def.value >= isec->output_offset
13485 			&& h_elf->root.u.def.value < (isec->output_offset
13486 						      + isec->size))
13487 		      {
13488 			h_elf->root.u.def.value -= isec->output_offset;
13489 			h_elf->root.u.def.section = isec;
13490 			sec = isec;
13491 			break;
13492 		      }
13493 		  }
13494 	    }
13495 	}
13496       h = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h_elf;
13497 
13498       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
13499 	{
13500 	  _bfd_clear_contents (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type],
13501 			       input_bfd, input_section,
13502 			       contents, rel->r_offset);
13503 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
13504 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
13505 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
13506 
13507 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
13508 	     symbols defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
13509 	     non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
13510 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
13511 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
13512 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
13513 	    wrel--;
13514 
13515 	  continue;
13516 	}
13517 
13518       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
13519 	goto copy_reloc;
13520 
13521       if (h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
13522 	{
13523 	  relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
13524 	  sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
13525 	  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
13526 	}
13527 
13528       /* TLS optimizations.  Replace instruction sequences and relocs
13529 	 based on information we collected in tls_optimize.  We edit
13530 	 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
13531 	 for the final instruction stream.  */
13532       tls_mask = 0;
13533       tls_gd = 0;
13534       toc_symndx = 0;
13535       if (h != NULL)
13536 	tls_mask = h->tls_mask;
13537       else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
13538 	{
13539 	  struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
13540 	    (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
13541 	  unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
13542 	    (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
13543 	  tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
13544 	}
13545       if (((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0 || tls_mask == (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
13546 	  && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
13547 	      || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
13548 	      || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
13549 	{
13550 	  /* Check for toc tls entries.  */
13551 	  unsigned char *toc_tls;
13552 
13553 	  if (!get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
13554 			     &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
13555 	    return FALSE;
13556 
13557 	  if (toc_tls)
13558 	    tls_mask = *toc_tls;
13559 	}
13560 
13561       /* Check that tls relocs are used with tls syms, and non-tls
13562 	 relocs are used with non-tls syms.  */
13563       if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
13564 	  && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE
13565 	  && (h == NULL
13566 	      || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13567 	      || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13568 	  && (IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type)
13569 	      != (sym_type == STT_TLS
13570 		  || (sym_type == STT_SECTION
13571 		      && (sec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0))))
13572 	{
13573 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13574 	      && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
13575 		  || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
13576 		  || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
13577 	    /* R_PPC64_TLS is OK against a symbol in the TOC.  */
13578 	    ;
13579 	  else
13580 	    info->callbacks->einfo
13581 	      (!IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type)
13582 	       /* xgettext:c-format */
13583 	       ? _("%H: %s used with TLS symbol `%pT'\n")
13584 	       /* xgettext:c-format */
13585 	       : _("%H: %s used with non-TLS symbol `%pT'\n"),
13586 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
13587 	       ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
13588 	       sym_name);
13589 	}
13590 
13591       /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane.  */
13592       if (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS != R_PPC64_TOC16_DS + 1
13593 	  || R_PPC64_TOC16_LO != R_PPC64_TOC16 + 1
13594 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
13595 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
13596 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
13597 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
13598 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS & 3)
13599 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS & 3)
13600 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
13601 	  || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
13602 	abort ();
13603 
13604       switch (r_type)
13605 	{
13606 	default:
13607 	  break;
13608 
13609 	case R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT:
13610 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
13611 	  if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 58u << 26)
13612 	    abort ();
13613 	  insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
13614 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
13615 	  r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
13616 	  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13617 	  break;
13618 
13619 	case R_PPC64_TOC16:
13620 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
13621 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
13622 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
13623 	  {
13624 	    /* Check for toc tls entries.  */
13625 	    unsigned char *toc_tls;
13626 	    int retval;
13627 
13628 	    retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
13629 				   &local_syms, rel, input_bfd);
13630 	    if (retval == 0)
13631 	      return FALSE;
13632 
13633 	    if (toc_tls)
13634 	      {
13635 		tls_mask = *toc_tls;
13636 		if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_DS
13637 		    || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS)
13638 		  {
13639 		    if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13640 			&& (tls_mask & (TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL)) == 0)
13641 		      goto toctprel;
13642 		  }
13643 		else
13644 		  {
13645 		    /* If we found a GD reloc pair, then we might be
13646 		       doing a GD->IE transition.  */
13647 		    if (retval == 2)
13648 		      {
13649 			tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
13650 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13651 			    && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
13652 			  goto tls_ldgd_opt;
13653 		      }
13654 		    else if (retval == 3)
13655 		      {
13656 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13657 			    && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
13658 			  goto tls_ldgd_opt;
13659 		      }
13660 		  }
13661 	      }
13662 	  }
13663 	  break;
13664 
13665 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
13666 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
13667 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13668 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
13669 	    {
13670 	      rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
13671 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
13672 	      r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
13673 	      rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13674 	    }
13675 	  break;
13676 
13677 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
13678 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
13679 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13680 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
13681 	    {
13682 	    toctprel:
13683 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
13684 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
13685 	      insn &= 31 << 21;
13686 	      insn |= 0x3c0d0000;	/* addis 0,13,0 */
13687 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
13688 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
13689 	      r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
13690 	      if (toc_symndx != 0)
13691 		{
13692 		  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
13693 		  rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
13694 		  /* We changed the symbol.  Start over in order to
13695 		     get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
13696 		  goto again;
13697 		}
13698 	      else
13699 		rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13700 	    }
13701 	  break;
13702 
13703 	case R_PPC64_TLS:
13704 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
13705 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
13706 	    {
13707 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
13708 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 13);
13709 	      if (insn == 0)
13710 		abort ();
13711 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
13712 	      /* Was PPC64_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
13713 		 PPC64_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word.  */
13714 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
13715 	      r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
13716 	      if (toc_symndx != 0)
13717 		{
13718 		  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
13719 		  rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
13720 		  /* We changed the symbol.  Start over in order to
13721 		     get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
13722 		  goto again;
13723 		}
13724 	      else
13725 		rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13726 	    }
13727 	  break;
13728 
13729 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
13730 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
13731 	  tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
13732 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
13733 	    goto tls_gdld_hi;
13734 	  break;
13735 
13736 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
13737 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
13738 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
13739 	    {
13740 	    tls_gdld_hi:
13741 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
13742 		r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
13743 			  + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
13744 	      else
13745 		{
13746 		  rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
13747 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
13748 		  r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
13749 		}
13750 	      rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13751 	    }
13752 	  break;
13753 
13754 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
13755 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
13756 	  tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
13757 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
13758 	    goto tls_ldgd_opt;
13759 	  break;
13760 
13761 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
13762 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
13763 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
13764 	    {
13765 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
13766 	      bfd_vma offset;
13767 
13768 	    tls_ldgd_opt:
13769 	      offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
13770 	      /* If not using the newer R_PPC64_TLSGD/LD to mark
13771 		 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
13772 		 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
13773 		 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
13774 		 the current reloc.  Edit both insns.  */
13775 	      if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
13776 		  && rel + 1 < relend
13777 		  && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
13778 					      htab->tls_get_addr,
13779 					      htab->tls_get_addr_fd))
13780 		offset = rel[1].r_offset;
13781 	      /* We read the low GOT_TLS (or TOC16) insn because we
13782 		 need to keep the destination reg.  It may be
13783 		 something other than the usual r3, and moved to r3
13784 		 before the call by intervening code.  */
13785 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
13786 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
13787 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
13788 		{
13789 		  /* IE */
13790 		  insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
13791 		  insn1 |= 58 << 26;	/* ld */
13792 		  insn2 = 0x7c636a14;	/* add 3,3,13 */
13793 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
13794 		    rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
13795 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0)
13796 		    r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
13797 			      + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
13798 		  else
13799 		    r_type += R_PPC64_TOC16_DS - R_PPC64_TOC16;
13800 		  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13801 		}
13802 	      else
13803 		{
13804 		  /* LE */
13805 		  insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
13806 		  insn1 |= 0x3c0d0000;	/* addis r,13,0 */
13807 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
13808 		  if (tls_gd == 0)
13809 		    {
13810 		      /* Was an LD reloc.  */
13811 		      if (toc_symndx)
13812 			sec = local_sections[toc_symndx];
13813 		      for (r_symndx = 0;
13814 			   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
13815 			   r_symndx++)
13816 			if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
13817 			  break;
13818 		      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
13819 			r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
13820 		      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
13821 		      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
13822 			rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
13823 					  + sec->output_offset
13824 					  + sec->output_section->vma);
13825 		    }
13826 		  else if (toc_symndx != 0)
13827 		    {
13828 		      r_symndx = toc_symndx;
13829 		      rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
13830 		    }
13831 		  r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
13832 		  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13833 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
13834 		    {
13835 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx,
13836 						    R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO);
13837 		      rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
13838 		      rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
13839 		    }
13840 		}
13841 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
13842 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
13843 	      if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
13844 		{
13845 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
13846 		  if (offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
13847 		    {
13848 		      insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
13849 		      if (insn2 == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
13850 			bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
13851 		    }
13852 		}
13853 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) == 0
13854 		  && (tls_gd == 0 || toc_symndx != 0))
13855 		{
13856 		  /* We changed the symbol.  Start over in order
13857 		     to get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
13858 		  goto again;
13859 		}
13860 	    }
13861 	  break;
13862 
13863 	case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
13864 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
13865 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
13866 	    {
13867 	      unsigned int insn2;
13868 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
13869 
13870 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
13871 		{
13872 		  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
13873 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
13874 		  break;
13875 		}
13876 
13877 	      if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
13878 		bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
13879 
13880 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPRELGD) != 0)
13881 		{
13882 		  /* IE */
13883 		  r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
13884 		  insn2 = 0x7c636a14;	/* add 3,3,13 */
13885 		}
13886 	      else
13887 		{
13888 		  /* LE */
13889 		  if (toc_symndx != 0)
13890 		    {
13891 		      r_symndx = toc_symndx;
13892 		      rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
13893 		    }
13894 		  r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
13895 		  rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
13896 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
13897 		}
13898 	      rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13899 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
13900 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
13901 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
13902 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
13903 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPRELGD) == 0 && toc_symndx != 0)
13904 		goto again;
13905 	    }
13906 	  break;
13907 
13908 	case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
13909 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
13910 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
13911 	    {
13912 	      unsigned int insn2;
13913 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
13914 
13915 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
13916 		{
13917 		  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
13918 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
13919 		  break;
13920 		}
13921 
13922 	      if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
13923 		bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
13924 
13925 	      if (toc_symndx)
13926 		sec = local_sections[toc_symndx];
13927 	      for (r_symndx = 0;
13928 		   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
13929 		   r_symndx++)
13930 		if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
13931 		  break;
13932 	      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
13933 		r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
13934 	      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
13935 	      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
13936 		rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
13937 				  + sec->output_offset
13938 				  + sec->output_section->vma);
13939 
13940 	      r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
13941 	      rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13942 	      rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
13943 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
13944 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
13945 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
13946 	      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
13947 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
13948 	      goto again;
13949 	    }
13950 	  break;
13951 
13952 	case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
13953 	  if (rel + 1 < relend
13954 	      && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
13955 	      && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
13956 	    {
13957 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
13958 		{
13959 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_NONE);
13960 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPRELGD) != 0)
13961 		    r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
13962 		  else
13963 		    {
13964 		      bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
13965 		      r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
13966 		    }
13967 		  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13968 		}
13969 	    }
13970 	  else
13971 	    {
13972 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
13973 		{
13974 		  bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
13975 		  r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
13976 		  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13977 		}
13978 	    }
13979 	  break;
13980 
13981 	case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
13982 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
13983 	    {
13984 	      r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
13985 	      rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
13986 	    }
13987 	  break;
13988 
13989 	case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
13990 	  relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
13991 	  if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
13992 	      && !info->traditional_format
13993 	      && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
13994 	    {
13995 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
13996 
13997 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
13998 	      insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
13999 	      if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
14000 		  && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
14001 		{
14002 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
14003 			      LIS_R2 + PPC_HA (relocation),
14004 			      contents + rel->r_offset);
14005 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
14006 			      ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
14007 			      contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14008 		}
14009 	    }
14010 	  else
14011 	    {
14012 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
14013 			     + input_section->output_offset
14014 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
14015 	      if (relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
14016 		{
14017 		  unsigned int insn1, insn2;
14018 
14019 		  insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
14020 		  insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14021 		  if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
14022 		      && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
14023 		    {
14024 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
14025 				  ADDIS_R2_R12 + PPC_HA (relocation),
14026 				  contents + rel->r_offset);
14027 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
14028 				  ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
14029 				  contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14030 		    }
14031 		}
14032 	    }
14033 	  break;
14034 
14035 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
14036 	  /* If we are generating a non-PIC executable, edit
14037 	     .	0:	addis 2,12,.TOC.-0b@ha
14038 	     .		addi 2,2,.TOC.-0b@l
14039 	     used by ELFv2 global entry points to set up r2, to
14040 	     .		lis 2,.TOC.@ha
14041 	     .		addi 2,2,.TOC.@l
14042 	     if .TOC. is in range.  */
14043 	  if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
14044 	      && !info->traditional_format
14045 	      && !htab->opd_abi
14046 	      && rel->r_addend == d_offset
14047 	      && h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot
14048 	      && rel + 1 < relend
14049 	      && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_REL16_LO)
14050 	      && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
14051 	      && rel[1].r_addend == rel->r_addend + 4
14052 	      && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
14053 	    {
14054 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
14055 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset - d_offset;
14056 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
14057 	      insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
14058 	      if ((insn1 & 0xffff0000) == ADDIS_R2_R12
14059 		  && (insn2 & 0xffff0000) == ADDI_R2_R2)
14060 		{
14061 		  r_type = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
14062 		  rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14063 		  rel->r_addend -= d_offset;
14064 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO);
14065 		  rel[1].r_addend -= d_offset + 4;
14066 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, LIS_R2, contents + offset);
14067 		}
14068 	    }
14069 	  break;
14070 	}
14071 
14072       /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn.  */
14073       insn = 0;
14074       max_br_offset = 1 << 25;
14075       addend = rel->r_addend;
14076       reloc_dest = DEST_NORMAL;
14077       switch (r_type)
14078 	{
14079 	default:
14080 	  break;
14081 
14082 	case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
14083 	  if (relocation + addend == (rel->r_offset
14084 				      + input_section->output_offset
14085 				      + input_section->output_section->vma)
14086 	      && tocsave_find (htab, NO_INSERT,
14087 			       &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
14088 	    {
14089 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
14090 	      if (insn == NOP
14091 		  || insn == CROR_151515 || insn == CROR_313131)
14092 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
14093 			    STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
14094 			    contents + rel->r_offset);
14095 	    }
14096 	  break;
14097 
14098 	  /* Branch taken prediction relocations.  */
14099 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
14100 	case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
14101 	  insn = 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field.  */
14102 	  /* Fall through.  */
14103 
14104 	  /* Branch not taken prediction relocations.  */
14105 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
14106 	case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
14107 	  insn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
14108 			      contents + rel->r_offset) & ~(0x01 << 21);
14109 	  /* Fall through.  */
14110 
14111 	case R_PPC64_REL14:
14112 	  max_br_offset = 1 << 15;
14113 	  /* Fall through.  */
14114 
14115 	case R_PPC64_REL24:
14116 	case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
14117 	case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
14118 	  /* Calls to functions with a different TOC, such as calls to
14119 	     shared objects, need to alter the TOC pointer.  This is
14120 	     done using a linkage stub.  A REL24 branching to these
14121 	     linkage stubs needs to be followed by a nop, as the nop
14122 	     will be replaced with an instruction to restore the TOC
14123 	     base pointer.  */
14124 	  fdh = h;
14125 	  if (h != NULL
14126 	      && h->oh != NULL
14127 	      && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
14128 	    fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
14129 	  stub_entry = ppc_get_stub_entry (input_section, sec, fdh, &orig_rel,
14130 					   htab);
14131 	  if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
14132 	      && stub_entry != NULL
14133 	      && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
14134 	      && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
14135 	    stub_entry = NULL;
14136 
14137 	  if (stub_entry != NULL
14138 	      && ((stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
14139 		   && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
14140 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
14141 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
14142 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
14143 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both))
14144 	    {
14145 	      bfd_boolean can_plt_call = FALSE;
14146 
14147 	      if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
14148 		  && !htab->opd_abi
14149 		  && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
14150 		  && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&h->elf))
14151 		{
14152 		  /* The function doesn't use or change r2.  */
14153 		  can_plt_call = TRUE;
14154 		}
14155 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
14156 		{
14157 		  /* NOTOC calls don't need to restore r2.  */
14158 		  can_plt_call = TRUE;
14159 		}
14160 
14161 	      /* All of these stubs may modify r2, so there must be a
14162 		 branch and link followed by a nop.  The nop is
14163 		 replaced by an insn to restore r2.  */
14164 	      else if (rel->r_offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
14165 		{
14166 		  unsigned long br;
14167 
14168 		  br = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
14169 				   contents + rel->r_offset);
14170 		  if ((br & 1) != 0)
14171 		    {
14172 		      unsigned long nop;
14173 
14174 		      nop = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
14175 					contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14176 		      if (nop == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
14177 			can_plt_call = TRUE;
14178 		      else if (nop == NOP
14179 			       || nop == CROR_151515
14180 			       || nop == CROR_313131)
14181 			{
14182 			  if (h != NULL
14183 			      && (h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
14184 				  || h == htab->tls_get_addr)
14185 			      && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
14186 			    {
14187 			      /* Special stub used, leave nop alone.  */
14188 			    }
14189 			  else
14190 			    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
14191 					LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
14192 					contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14193 			  can_plt_call = TRUE;
14194 			}
14195 		    }
14196 		}
14197 
14198 	      if (!can_plt_call && h != NULL)
14199 		{
14200 		  const char *name = h->elf.root.root.string;
14201 
14202 		  if (*name == '.')
14203 		    ++name;
14204 
14205 		  if (strncmp (name, "__libc_start_main", 17) == 0
14206 		      && (name[17] == 0 || name[17] == '@'))
14207 		    {
14208 		      /* Allow crt1 branch to go via a toc adjusting
14209 			 stub.  Other calls that never return could do
14210 			 the same, if we could detect such.  */
14211 		      can_plt_call = TRUE;
14212 		    }
14213 		}
14214 
14215 	      if (!can_plt_call)
14216 		{
14217 		  /* g++ as of 20130507 emits self-calls without a
14218 		     following nop.  This is arguably wrong since we
14219 		     have conflicting information.  On the one hand a
14220 		     global symbol and on the other a local call
14221 		     sequence, but don't error for this special case.
14222 		     It isn't possible to cheaply verify we have
14223 		     exactly such a call.  Allow all calls to the same
14224 		     section.  */
14225 		  asection *code_sec = sec;
14226 
14227 		  if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
14228 		    {
14229 		      bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
14230 				     - sec->output_section->vma
14231 				     - sec->output_offset);
14232 
14233 		      opd_entry_value (sec, off, &code_sec, NULL, FALSE);
14234 		    }
14235 		  if (code_sec == input_section)
14236 		    can_plt_call = TRUE;
14237 		}
14238 
14239 	      if (!can_plt_call)
14240 		{
14241 		  if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
14242 		      && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
14243 		    info->callbacks->einfo
14244 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
14245 		      (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
14246 			 "(plt call stub)\n"),
14247 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
14248 		  else
14249 		    info->callbacks->einfo
14250 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
14251 		      (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
14252 			 "(toc save/adjust stub)\n"),
14253 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
14254 
14255 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
14256 		  ret = FALSE;
14257 		}
14258 
14259 	      if (can_plt_call
14260 		  && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
14261 		  && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
14262 		unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14263 	    }
14264 
14265 	  if ((stub_entry == NULL
14266 	       || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
14267 	       || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
14268 	      && get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
14269 	    {
14270 	      /* The branch destination is the value of the opd entry. */
14271 	      bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
14272 			     - sec->output_section->vma
14273 			     - sec->output_offset);
14274 	      bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (sec, off, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
14275 	      if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
14276 		{
14277 		  relocation = dest;
14278 		  addend = 0;
14279 		  reloc_dest = DEST_OPD;
14280 		}
14281 	    }
14282 
14283 	  /* If the branch is out of reach we ought to have a long
14284 	     branch stub.  */
14285 	  from = (rel->r_offset
14286 		  + input_section->output_offset
14287 		  + input_section->output_section->vma);
14288 
14289 	  relocation += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (fdh
14290 						  ? fdh->elf.other
14291 						  : sym->st_other);
14292 
14293 	  if (stub_entry != NULL
14294 	      && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
14295 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
14296 	      && (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
14297 		  || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
14298 		  || (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
14299 		      < 2 * max_br_offset)))
14300 	    /* Don't use the stub if this branch is in range.  */
14301 	    stub_entry = NULL;
14302 
14303 	  if (stub_entry != NULL
14304 	      && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
14305 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
14306 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
14307 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
14308 	      && (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
14309 		  || ((fdh ? fdh->elf.other : sym->st_other)
14310 		      & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK) == 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)
14311 	      && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
14312 		  < 2 * max_br_offset))
14313 	    stub_entry = NULL;
14314 
14315 	  if (stub_entry != NULL
14316 	      && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
14317 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
14318 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
14319 		  || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
14320 	      && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
14321 	      && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
14322 		  < 2 * max_br_offset))
14323 	    stub_entry = NULL;
14324 
14325 	  if (stub_entry != NULL)
14326 	    {
14327 	      /* Munge up the value and addend so that we call the stub
14328 		 rather than the procedure directly.  */
14329 	      asection *stub_sec = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
14330 
14331 	      if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_save_res)
14332 		relocation += (stub_sec->output_offset
14333 			       + stub_sec->output_section->vma
14334 			       + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
14335 			       - htab->sfpr->output_offset
14336 			       - htab->sfpr->output_section->vma);
14337 	      else
14338 		relocation = (stub_entry->stub_offset
14339 			      + stub_sec->output_offset
14340 			      + stub_sec->output_section->vma);
14341 	      addend = 0;
14342 	      reloc_dest = DEST_STUB;
14343 
14344 	      if (((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
14345 		    && ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE)
14346 		   || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
14347 		   || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
14348 		  && !(h != NULL
14349 		       && (h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
14350 			   || h == htab->tls_get_addr)
14351 		       && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
14352 		  && rel + 1 < relend
14353 		  && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
14354 		  && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE)
14355 		relocation += 4;
14356 	      else if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
14357 			|| stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
14358 			|| stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
14359 		       && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
14360 		relocation += 4;
14361 	    }
14362 
14363 	  if (insn != 0)
14364 	    {
14365 	      if (is_isa_v2)
14366 		{
14367 		  /* Set 'a' bit.  This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
14368 		     on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
14369 		     for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t).  */
14370 		  if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
14371 		    insn |= 0x02 << 21;
14372 		  else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
14373 		    insn |= 0x08 << 21;
14374 		  else
14375 		    break;
14376 		}
14377 	      else
14378 		{
14379 		  /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
14380 		  if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + addend - from) < 0)
14381 		    insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
14382 		}
14383 
14384 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
14385 	    }
14386 
14387 	  /* NOP out calls to undefined weak functions.
14388 	     We can thus call a weak function without first
14389 	     checking whether the function is defined.  */
14390 	  else if (h != NULL
14391 		   && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
14392 		   && h->elf.dynindx == -1
14393 		   && (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
14394 		       || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
14395 		   && relocation == 0
14396 		   && addend == 0)
14397 	    {
14398 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
14399 	      goto copy_reloc;
14400 	    }
14401 	  break;
14402 	}
14403 
14404       /* Set `addend'.  */
14405       tls_type = 0;
14406       save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
14407       switch (r_type)
14408 	{
14409 	default:
14410 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
14411 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
14412 			      input_bfd, ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
14413 
14414 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
14415 	  ret = FALSE;
14416 	  goto copy_reloc;
14417 
14418 	case R_PPC64_NONE:
14419 	case R_PPC64_TLS:
14420 	case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
14421 	case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
14422 	case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
14423 	case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
14424 	case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
14425 	case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
14426 	  goto copy_reloc;
14427 
14428 	  /* GOT16 relocations.  Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
14429 	     address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
14430 	     symbol's value itself.  Also, create a GOT entry for the
14431 	     symbol and put the symbol value there.  */
14432 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
14433 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
14434 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
14435 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
14436 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
14437 	  goto dogot;
14438 
14439 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
14440 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
14441 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
14442 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
14443 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
14444 	  goto dogot;
14445 
14446 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
14447 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
14448 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
14449 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
14450 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
14451 	  goto dogot;
14452 
14453 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
14454 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
14455 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
14456 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
14457 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
14458 	  goto dogot;
14459 
14460 	case R_PPC64_GOT16:
14461 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
14462 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
14463 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
14464 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
14465 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
14466 	dogot:
14467 	  {
14468 	    /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
14469 	       offset table.  */
14470 	    asection *got;
14471 	    bfd_vma *offp;
14472 	    bfd_vma off;
14473 	    unsigned long indx = 0;
14474 	    struct got_entry *ent;
14475 
14476 	    if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
14477 		&& (h == NULL
14478 		    || !h->elf.def_dynamic))
14479 	      ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (input_bfd);
14480 	    else
14481 	      {
14482 		if (h != NULL)
14483 		  {
14484 		    if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
14485 			|| h->elf.dynindx == -1
14486 			|| SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
14487 			|| UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
14488 		      /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
14489 			 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
14490 			 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
14491 			 because of a version file.  */
14492 		      ;
14493 		    else
14494 		      {
14495 			indx = h->elf.dynindx;
14496 			unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14497 		      }
14498 		    ent = h->elf.got.glist;
14499 		  }
14500 		else
14501 		  {
14502 		    if (local_got_ents == NULL)
14503 		      abort ();
14504 		    ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
14505 		  }
14506 
14507 		for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14508 		  if (ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend
14509 		      && ent->owner == input_bfd
14510 		      && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
14511 		    break;
14512 	      }
14513 
14514 	    if (ent == NULL)
14515 	      abort ();
14516 	    if (ent->is_indirect)
14517 	      ent = ent->got.ent;
14518 	    offp = &ent->got.offset;
14519 	    got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->got;
14520 	    if (got == NULL)
14521 	      abort ();
14522 
14523 	    /* The offset must always be a multiple of 8.  We use the
14524 	       least significant bit to record whether we have already
14525 	       processed this entry.  */
14526 	    off = *offp;
14527 	    if ((off & 1) != 0)
14528 	      off &= ~1;
14529 	    else
14530 	      {
14531 		/* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker, except in
14532 		   the case of TLSLD where we'll use one entry per
14533 		   module.  */
14534 		asection *relgot;
14535 		bfd_boolean ifunc;
14536 
14537 		*offp = off | 1;
14538 		relgot = NULL;
14539 		ifunc = (h != NULL
14540 			 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
14541 			 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
14542 		if (ifunc)
14543 		  {
14544 		    relgot = htab->elf.irelplt;
14545 		    if (indx == 0)
14546 		      htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
14547 		    else if (is_static_defined (&h->elf))
14548 		      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
14549 		  }
14550 		else if (indx != 0
14551 			 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
14552 			     && (h == NULL
14553 				 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf)
14554 				 || (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
14555 				     && !h->elf.def_dynamic))
14556 			     && !(tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
14557 				  && bfd_link_executable (info)
14558 				  && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))))
14559 		  relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->relgot;
14560 		if (relgot != NULL)
14561 		  {
14562 		    outrel.r_offset = (got->output_section->vma
14563 				       + got->output_offset
14564 				       + off);
14565 		    outrel.r_addend = addend;
14566 		    if (tls_type & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
14567 		      {
14568 			outrel.r_addend = 0;
14569 			outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64);
14570 			if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
14571 			  {
14572 			    loc = relgot->contents;
14573 			    loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
14574 				    * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
14575 			    bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
14576 						       &outrel, loc);
14577 			    outrel.r_offset += 8;
14578 			    outrel.r_addend = addend;
14579 			    outrel.r_info
14580 			      = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
14581 			  }
14582 		      }
14583 		    else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
14584 		      outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
14585 		    else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
14586 		      outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_TPREL64);
14587 		    else if (indx != 0)
14588 		      outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT);
14589 		    else
14590 		      {
14591 			if (ifunc)
14592 			  outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
14593 			else
14594 			  outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
14595 
14596 			/* Write the .got section contents for the sake
14597 			   of prelink.  */
14598 			loc = got->contents + off;
14599 			bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend + relocation,
14600 				    loc);
14601 		      }
14602 
14603 		    if (indx == 0 && tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
14604 		      {
14605 			outrel.r_addend += relocation;
14606 			if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
14607 			  {
14608 			    if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
14609 			      outrel.r_addend = 0;
14610 			    else
14611 			      outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
14612 			  }
14613 		      }
14614 		    loc = relgot->contents;
14615 		    loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
14616 			    * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
14617 		    bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
14618 		  }
14619 
14620 		/* Init the .got section contents here if we're not
14621 		   emitting a reloc.  */
14622 		else
14623 		  {
14624 		    relocation += addend;
14625 		    if (tls_type != 0)
14626 		      {
14627 			if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
14628 			  relocation = 0;
14629 			else
14630 			  {
14631 			    if (tls_type & TLS_LD)
14632 			      relocation = 0;
14633 			    else
14634 			      relocation -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
14635 			    if (tls_type & TLS_TPREL)
14636 			      relocation += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
14637 			  }
14638 
14639 			if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD))
14640 			  {
14641 			    bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
14642 					got->contents + off + 8);
14643 			    relocation = 1;
14644 			  }
14645 		      }
14646 		    bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
14647 				got->contents + off);
14648 		  }
14649 	      }
14650 
14651 	    if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
14652 	      abort ();
14653 
14654 	    relocation = got->output_section->vma + got->output_offset + off;
14655 	    addend = -(TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
14656 	  }
14657 	  break;
14658 
14659 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
14660 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
14661 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
14662 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
14663 	case R_PPC64_PLT32:
14664 	case R_PPC64_PLT64:
14665 	case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
14666 	case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
14667 	  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
14668 	     procedure linkage table.  */
14669 	  unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
14670 	  {
14671 	    struct plt_entry **plt_list = NULL;
14672 	    if (h != NULL)
14673 	      plt_list = &h->elf.plt.plist;
14674 	    else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
14675 	      {
14676 		struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
14677 		  (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
14678 		plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
14679 	      }
14680 	    if (plt_list)
14681 	      {
14682 		struct plt_entry *ent;
14683 
14684 		for (ent = *plt_list; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
14685 		  if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
14686 		      && ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend)
14687 		    {
14688 		      asection *plt;
14689 		      bfd_vma got;
14690 
14691 		      plt = htab->elf.splt;
14692 		      if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
14693 			  || h == NULL
14694 			  || h->elf.dynindx == -1)
14695 			{
14696 			  if (h != NULL
14697 			      ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
14698 			      : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14699 			    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
14700 			  else
14701 			    plt = htab->pltlocal;
14702 			}
14703 		      relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
14704 				    + plt->output_offset
14705 				    + ent->plt.offset);
14706 		      if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
14707 			  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
14708 			  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
14709 			  || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS)
14710 			{
14711 			  got = (elf_gp (output_bfd)
14712 				 + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
14713 			  relocation -= got;
14714 			}
14715 		      addend = 0;
14716 		      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14717 		      break;
14718 		    }
14719 	      }
14720 	  }
14721 	  break;
14722 
14723 	case R_PPC64_TOC:
14724 	  /* Relocation value is TOC base.  */
14725 	  relocation = TOCstart;
14726 	  if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
14727 	    relocation += htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
14728 	  else if (unresolved_reloc)
14729 	    ;
14730 	  else if (sec != NULL && sec->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
14731 	    relocation += htab->sec_info[sec->id].toc_off;
14732 	  else
14733 	    unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
14734 	  goto dodyn;
14735 
14736 	  /* TOC16 relocs.  We want the offset relative to the TOC base,
14737 	     which is the address of the start of the TOC plus 0x8000.
14738 	     The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, and .plt,
14739 	     in this order.  */
14740 	case R_PPC64_TOC16:
14741 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
14742 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
14743 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
14744 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
14745 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
14746 	  addend -= TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
14747 	  break;
14748 
14749 	  /* Relocate against the beginning of the section.  */
14750 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
14751 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
14752 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
14753 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
14754 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
14755 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
14756 	  if (sec != NULL)
14757 	    addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
14758 	  break;
14759 
14760 	case R_PPC64_REL16:
14761 	case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
14762 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
14763 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
14764 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
14765 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
14766 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
14767 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
14768 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
14769 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
14770 	case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
14771 	  break;
14772 
14773 	case R_PPC64_REL14:
14774 	case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
14775 	case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
14776 	case R_PPC64_REL24:
14777 	case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
14778 	  break;
14779 
14780 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
14781 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
14782 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
14783 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
14784 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
14785 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
14786 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
14787 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
14788 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
14789 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
14790 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
14791 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
14792 	  if (h != NULL
14793 	      && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
14794 	      && h->elf.dynindx == -1)
14795 	    {
14796 	      /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
14797 		 resolve to zero.  This is really just a tweak, since
14798 		 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
14799 		 defined before using them.  */
14800 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
14801 
14802 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
14803 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 13);
14804 	      if (insn != 0)
14805 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
14806 	      break;
14807 	    }
14808 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
14809 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
14810 	  /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
14811 	     libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
14812 	     DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway.  */
14813 	  goto dodyn;
14814 
14815 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
14816 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
14817 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
14818 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
14819 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
14820 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
14821 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
14822 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
14823 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
14824 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
14825 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
14826 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
14827 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
14828 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
14829 	  break;
14830 
14831 	case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
14832 	  addend += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h != NULL
14833 					      ? h->elf.other
14834 					      : sym->st_other);
14835 	  break;
14836 
14837 	case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
14838 	  relocation = 1;
14839 	  addend = 0;
14840 	  goto dodyn;
14841 
14842 	case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
14843 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
14844 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
14845 	  goto dodyn;
14846 
14847 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
14848 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
14849 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
14850 	  /* Fall through.  */
14851 
14852 	  /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a
14853 	     dynamic object.  */
14854 	case R_PPC64_REL30:
14855 	case R_PPC64_REL32:
14856 	case R_PPC64_REL64:
14857 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
14858 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
14859 	case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
14860 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
14861 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
14862 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
14863 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
14864 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
14865 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
14866 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
14867 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
14868 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
14869 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
14870 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
14871 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
14872 	case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
14873 	case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
14874 	case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
14875 	case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
14876 	case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
14877 	case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
14878 	dodyn:
14879 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
14880 	    break;
14881 
14882 	  if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
14883 	    break;
14884 
14885 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
14886 	      ? ((h == NULL
14887 		  || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
14888 		 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
14889 		     || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
14890 	      : (h != NULL
14891 		 ? h->dyn_relocs != NULL
14892 		 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
14893 	    {
14894 	      bfd_boolean skip, relocate;
14895 	      asection *sreloc;
14896 	      bfd_vma out_off;
14897 	      long indx = 0;
14898 
14899 	      /* When generating a dynamic object, these relocations
14900 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
14901 		 time.  */
14902 
14903 	      skip = FALSE;
14904 	      relocate = FALSE;
14905 
14906 	      out_off = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
14907 						 input_section, rel->r_offset);
14908 	      if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -1)
14909 		skip = TRUE;
14910 	      else if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -2)
14911 		skip = TRUE, relocate = TRUE;
14912 	      out_off += (input_section->output_section->vma
14913 			  + input_section->output_offset);
14914 	      outrel.r_offset = out_off;
14915 	      outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
14916 
14917 	      /* Optimize unaligned reloc use.  */
14918 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 && (out_off & 7) != 0)
14919 		  || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR64 && (out_off & 7) == 0))
14920 		r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR64 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR64;
14921 	      else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR32 && (out_off & 3) != 0)
14922 		       || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR32 && (out_off & 3) == 0))
14923 		r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR32;
14924 	      else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16 && (out_off & 1) != 0)
14925 		       || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR16 && (out_off & 1) == 0))
14926 		r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR16;
14927 
14928 	      if (skip)
14929 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
14930 	      else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
14931 		       && !is_opd
14932 		       && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC)
14933 		{
14934 		  indx = h->elf.dynindx;
14935 		  BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
14936 		  outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
14937 		}
14938 	      else
14939 		{
14940 		  /* This symbol is local, or marked to become local,
14941 		     or this is an opd section reloc which must point
14942 		     at a local function.  */
14943 		  outrel.r_addend += relocation;
14944 		  if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC)
14945 		    {
14946 		      if (is_opd && h != NULL)
14947 			{
14948 			  /* Lie about opd entries.  This case occurs
14949 			     when building shared libraries and we
14950 			     reference a function in another shared
14951 			     lib.  The same thing happens for a weak
14952 			     definition in an application that's
14953 			     overridden by a strong definition in a
14954 			     shared lib.  (I believe this is a generic
14955 			     bug in binutils handling of weak syms.)
14956 			     In these cases we won't use the opd
14957 			     entry in this lib.  */
14958 			  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14959 			}
14960 		      if (!is_opd
14961 			  && r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
14962 			  && (h != NULL
14963 			      ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
14964 			      : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
14965 			outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
14966 		      else
14967 			{
14968 			  outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
14969 
14970 			  /* We need to relocate .opd contents for ld.so.
14971 			     Prelink also wants simple and consistent rules
14972 			     for relocs.  This make all RELATIVE relocs have
14973 			     *r_offset equal to r_addend.  */
14974 			  relocate = TRUE;
14975 			}
14976 		    }
14977 		  else
14978 		    {
14979 		      if (h != NULL
14980 			  ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
14981 			  : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
14982 			{
14983 			  info->callbacks->einfo
14984 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
14985 			    (_("%H: %s for indirect "
14986 			       "function `%pT' unsupported\n"),
14987 			     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
14988 			     ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
14989 			     sym_name);
14990 			  ret = FALSE;
14991 			}
14992 		      else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
14993 			;
14994 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
14995 			{
14996 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
14997 			  return FALSE;
14998 			}
14999 		      else
15000 			{
15001 			  asection *osec;
15002 
15003 			  osec = sec->output_section;
15004 			  indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
15005 
15006 			  if (indx == 0)
15007 			    {
15008 			      if ((osec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
15009 				  && htab->elf.data_index_section != NULL)
15010 				osec = htab->elf.data_index_section;
15011 			      else
15012 				osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
15013 			      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
15014 			    }
15015 			  BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
15016 
15017 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
15018 			     against a section symbol, so subtract out
15019 			     the output section's address but not the
15020 			     offset of the input section in the output
15021 			     section.  */
15022 			  outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
15023 			}
15024 
15025 		      outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
15026 		    }
15027 		}
15028 
15029 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
15030 	      if (h != NULL
15031 		  ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
15032 		  : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
15033 		{
15034 		  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
15035 		  if (indx == 0)
15036 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
15037 		  else if (is_static_defined (&h->elf))
15038 		    htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
15039 		}
15040 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
15041 		abort ();
15042 
15043 	      if (sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)
15044 		  >= sreloc->size)
15045 		abort ();
15046 	      loc = sreloc->contents;
15047 	      loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
15048 	      bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
15049 
15050 	      /* If this reloc is against an external symbol, it will
15051 		 be computed at runtime, so there's no need to do
15052 		 anything now.  However, for the sake of prelink ensure
15053 		 that the section contents are a known value.  */
15054 	      if (!relocate)
15055 		{
15056 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15057 		  /* The value chosen here is quite arbitrary as ld.so
15058 		     ignores section contents except for the special
15059 		     case of .opd where the contents might be accessed
15060 		     before relocation.  Choose zero, as that won't
15061 		     cause reloc overflow.  */
15062 		  relocation = 0;
15063 		  addend = 0;
15064 		  /* Use *r_offset == r_addend for R_PPC64_ADDR64 relocs
15065 		     to improve backward compatibility with older
15066 		     versions of ld.  */
15067 		  if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64)
15068 		    addend = outrel.r_addend;
15069 		  /* Adjust pc_relative relocs to have zero in *r_offset.  */
15070 		  else if (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->pc_relative)
15071 		    addend = outrel.r_offset;
15072 		}
15073 	    }
15074 	  break;
15075 
15076 	case R_PPC64_COPY:
15077 	case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
15078 	case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
15079 	case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
15080 	case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
15081 	  /* We shouldn't ever see these dynamic relocs in relocatable
15082 	     files.  */
15083 	  /* Fall through.  */
15084 
15085 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16:
15086 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
15087 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
15088 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI:
15089 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO:
15090 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
15091 	case R_PPC64_PLTREL32:
15092 	case R_PPC64_PLTREL64:
15093 	  /* These ones haven't been implemented yet.  */
15094 
15095 	  info->callbacks->einfo
15096 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
15097 	    (_("%P: %pB: %s is not supported for `%pT'\n"),
15098 	     input_bfd,
15099 	     ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, sym_name);
15100 
15101 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
15102 	  ret = FALSE;
15103 	  goto copy_reloc;
15104 	}
15105 
15106       /* Multi-instruction sequences that access the TOC can be
15107 	 optimized, eg. addis ra,r2,0; addi rb,ra,x;
15108 	 to		nop;	       addi rb,r2,x;  */
15109       switch (r_type)
15110 	{
15111 	default:
15112 	  break;
15113 
15114 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
15115 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
15116 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
15117 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
15118 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
15119 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
15120 	  /* These relocs would only be useful if building up an
15121 	     offset to later add to r2, perhaps in an indexed
15122 	     addressing mode instruction.  Don't try to optimize.
15123 	     Unfortunately, the possibility of someone building up an
15124 	     offset like this or even with the HA relocs, means that
15125 	     we need to check the high insn when optimizing the low
15126 	     insn.  */
15127 	  break;
15128 
15129 	case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
15130 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
15131 	    {
15132 	      /* No plt entry.  Make this into a direct call.  */
15133 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
15134 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
15135 	      insn &= 1;
15136 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B_DOT | insn, p);
15137 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p + 4);
15138 	      unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
15139 	      r_type = R_PPC64_REL24;
15140 	    }
15141 	  break;
15142 
15143 	case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
15144 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
15145 	    {
15146 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15147 	      goto nop_it;
15148 	    }
15149 	  break;
15150 
15151 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
15152 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
15153 	    {
15154 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15155 	      goto nop_it;
15156 	    }
15157 	  /* Fall through.  */
15158 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
15159 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
15160 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
15161 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
15162 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
15163 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
15164 	  if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
15165 	      && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
15166 	    {
15167 	      bfd_byte *p;
15168 	    nop_it:
15169 	      p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
15170 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
15171 	      goto copy_reloc;
15172 	    }
15173 	  break;
15174 
15175 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
15176 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
15177 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
15178 	    {
15179 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15180 	      goto nop_it;
15181 	    }
15182 	  /* Fall through.  */
15183 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
15184 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
15185 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15186 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
15187 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
15188 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
15189 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
15190 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
15191 	  if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
15192 	      && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
15193 	    {
15194 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
15195 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
15196 	      if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */)
15197 		{
15198 		  /* Transform addic to addi when we change reg.  */
15199 		  insn &= ~((0x3f << 26) | (0x1f << 16));
15200 		  insn |= (14u << 26) | (2 << 16);
15201 		}
15202 	      else
15203 		{
15204 		  insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
15205 		  insn |= 2 << 16;
15206 		}
15207 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
15208 	    }
15209 	  break;
15210 
15211 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
15212 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
15213 	    {
15214 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
15215 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
15216 	      if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
15217 		  != ((15u << 26) | (13 << 16)) /* addis rt,13,imm */)
15218 		/* xgettext:c-format */
15219 		info->callbacks->minfo
15220 		  (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
15221 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
15222 		   ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, insn);
15223 	      else
15224 		{
15225 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
15226 		  goto copy_reloc;
15227 		}
15228 	    }
15229 	  break;
15230 
15231 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
15232 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15233 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
15234 	    {
15235 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
15236 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
15237 	      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
15238 	      insn |= 13 << 16;
15239 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
15240 	    }
15241 	  break;
15242 	}
15243 
15244       /* Do any further special processing.  */
15245       switch (r_type)
15246 	{
15247 	default:
15248 	  break;
15249 
15250 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
15251 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
15252 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
15253 	case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
15254 	case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
15255 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
15256 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
15257 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
15258 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
15259 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
15260 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
15261 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
15262 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
15263 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
15264 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
15265 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
15266 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
15267 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
15268 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
15269 	  /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
15270 	     that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
15271 	     'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
15272 	     alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link).  */
15273 	  if (sec == NULL)
15274 	    break;
15275 	  /* Fall through.  */
15276 
15277 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
15278 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
15279 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
15280 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
15281 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
15282 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
15283 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
15284 	  /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
15285 	     Bits 0:15 are not used.  */
15286 	  addend += 0x8000;
15287 	  break;
15288 
15289 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
15290 	case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
15291 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
15292 	case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
15293 	case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
15294 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
15295 	case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
15296 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
15297 	case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
15298 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
15299 	case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
15300 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
15301 	case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15302 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
15303 	case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
15304 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
15305 	case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15306 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
15307 	case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
15308 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15309 	  mask = 3;
15310 	  /* If this reloc is against an lq, lxv, or stxv insn, then
15311 	     the value must be a multiple of 16.  This is somewhat of
15312 	     a hack, but the "correct" way to do this by defining _DQ
15313 	     forms of all the _DS relocs bloats all reloc switches in
15314 	     this file.  It doesn't make much sense to use these
15315 	     relocs in data, so testing the insn should be safe.  */
15316 	  if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (56u << 26)
15317 	      || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) && (insn & 3) == 1))
15318 	    mask = 15;
15319 	  relocation += addend;
15320 	  addend = insn & (mask ^ 3);
15321 	  if ((relocation & mask) != 0)
15322 	    {
15323 	      relocation ^= relocation & mask;
15324 	      info->callbacks->einfo
15325 		/* xgettext:c-format */
15326 		(_("%H: error: %s not a multiple of %u\n"),
15327 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
15328 		 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
15329 		 mask + 1);
15330 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15331 	      ret = FALSE;
15332 	      goto copy_reloc;
15333 	    }
15334 	  break;
15335 	}
15336 
15337       /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
15338 	 because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
15339 	 not process them.  */
15340       howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) r_type];
15341       if (unresolved_reloc
15342 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
15343 	       && h->elf.def_dynamic)
15344 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
15345 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
15346 	{
15347 	  info->callbacks->einfo
15348 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
15349 	    (_("%H: unresolvable %s against `%pT'\n"),
15350 	     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
15351 	     howto->name,
15352 	     h->elf.root.root.string);
15353 	  ret = FALSE;
15354 	}
15355 
15356       /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
15357 	 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values.  Really, we should
15358 	 have different reloc types.  */
15359       if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
15360 	  && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
15361 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
15362 	{
15363 	  enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
15364 
15365 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15366 	  if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
15367 	    complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
15368 	  else if (howto->rightshift == 0
15369 		   ? ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
15370 		      || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
15371 		      || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
15372 		   : ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 29u << 26 /* andis */
15373 		      || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 25u << 26 /* oris */
15374 		      || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 27u << 26 /* xoris */))
15375 	    complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
15376 	  if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
15377 	    {
15378 	      alt_howto = *howto;
15379 	      alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
15380 	      howto = &alt_howto;
15381 	    }
15382 	}
15383 
15384       if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA)
15385 	{
15386 	  /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate.  */
15387 	  if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
15388 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
15389 	  else
15390 	    {
15391 	      relocation += addend;
15392 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
15393 			     + input_section->output_offset
15394 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
15395 	      relocation = (bfd_signed_vma) relocation >> 16;
15396 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15397 	      insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
15398 	      insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
15399 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
15400 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
15401 	      if (relocation + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
15402 		r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
15403 	    }
15404 	}
15405       else
15406 	r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
15407 				      rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
15408 
15409       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
15410 	{
15411 	  char *more_info = NULL;
15412 	  const char *reloc_name = howto->name;
15413 
15414 	  if (reloc_dest != DEST_NORMAL)
15415 	    {
15416 	      more_info = bfd_malloc (strlen (reloc_name) + 8);
15417 	      if (more_info != NULL)
15418 		{
15419 		  strcpy (more_info, reloc_name);
15420 		  strcat (more_info, (reloc_dest == DEST_OPD
15421 				      ? " (OPD)" : " (stub)"));
15422 		  reloc_name = more_info;
15423 		}
15424 	    }
15425 
15426 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
15427 	    {
15428 	      /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
15429 		 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined.  */
15430 	      if (!warned
15431 		  && (reloc_dest == DEST_STUB
15432 		      || !(h != NULL
15433 			   && (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
15434 			       || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
15435 			   && is_branch_reloc (r_type))))
15436 		info->callbacks->reloc_overflow (info, &h->elf.root,
15437 						 sym_name, reloc_name,
15438 						 orig_rel.r_addend,
15439 						 input_bfd, input_section,
15440 						 rel->r_offset);
15441 	    }
15442 	  else
15443 	    {
15444 	      info->callbacks->einfo
15445 		/* xgettext:c-format */
15446 		(_("%H: %s against `%pT': error %d\n"),
15447 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
15448 		 reloc_name, sym_name, (int) r);
15449 	      ret = FALSE;
15450 	    }
15451 	  if (more_info != NULL)
15452 	    free (more_info);
15453 	}
15454     copy_reloc:
15455       if (wrel != rel)
15456 	*wrel = *rel;
15457     }
15458 
15459   if (wrel != rel)
15460     {
15461       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
15462       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
15463 
15464       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
15465       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
15466       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
15467 	{
15468 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
15469 	     one NONE reloc.
15470 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
15471 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
15472 	  deleted -= 1;
15473 	}
15474       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
15475       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
15476       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
15477     }
15478 
15479   /* If we're emitting relocations, then shortly after this function
15480      returns, reloc offsets and addends for this section will be
15481      adjusted.  Worse, reloc symbol indices will be for the output
15482      file rather than the input.  Save a copy of the relocs for
15483      opd_entry_value.  */
15484   if (is_opd && (info->emitrelocations || bfd_link_relocatable (info)))
15485     {
15486       bfd_size_type amt;
15487       amt = input_section->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela);
15488       rel = bfd_alloc (input_bfd, amt);
15489       BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs == NULL);
15490       ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs = rel;
15491       if (rel == NULL)
15492 	return FALSE;
15493       memcpy (rel, relocs, amt);
15494     }
15495   return ret;
15496 }
15497 
15498 /* Adjust the value of any local symbols in opd sections.  */
15499 
15500 static int
15501 ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook (struct bfd_link_info *info,
15502 			      const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
15503 			      Elf_Internal_Sym *elfsym,
15504 			      asection *input_sec,
15505 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
15506 {
15507   struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
15508   long adjust;
15509   bfd_vma value;
15510 
15511   if (h != NULL)
15512     return 1;
15513 
15514   opd = get_opd_info (input_sec);
15515   if (opd == NULL || opd->adjust == NULL)
15516     return 1;
15517 
15518   value = elfsym->st_value - input_sec->output_offset;
15519   if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
15520     value -= input_sec->output_section->vma;
15521 
15522   adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (value)];
15523   if (adjust == -1)
15524     return 2;
15525 
15526   elfsym->st_value += adjust;
15527   return 1;
15528 }
15529 
15530 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
15531    dynamic sections here.  */
15532 
15533 static bfd_boolean
15534 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
15535 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
15536 				 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
15537 				 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
15538 {
15539   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
15540   struct plt_entry *ent;
15541 
15542   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
15543   if (htab == NULL)
15544     return FALSE;
15545 
15546   if (!htab->opd_abi && !h->def_regular)
15547     for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
15548       if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
15549 	{
15550 	  /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
15551 	     defined in glink.  Leave the value if there were
15552 	     any relocations where pointer equality matters
15553 	     (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to make
15554 	     function pointer comparisons work between an
15555 	     application and shared library), otherwise set it
15556 	     to zero.  */
15557 	  sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
15558 	  if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
15559 	    sym->st_value = 0;
15560 	  else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
15561 	    {
15562 	      /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
15563 		 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
15564 		 function pointer.  */
15565 	      sym->st_value = 0;
15566 	    }
15567 	  break;
15568 	}
15569 
15570   if (h->needs_copy)
15571     {
15572       /* This symbol needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
15573       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
15574       asection *srel;
15575       bfd_byte *loc;
15576 
15577       if (h->dynindx == -1
15578 	  || (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
15579 	      && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
15580 	  || htab->elf.srelbss == NULL
15581 	  || htab->elf.sreldynrelro == NULL)
15582 	abort ();
15583 
15584       rela.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.value
15585 		       + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
15586 		       + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
15587       rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_COPY);
15588       rela.r_addend = 0;
15589       if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
15590 	srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
15591       else
15592 	srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
15593       loc = srel->contents;
15594       loc += srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
15595       bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
15596     }
15597 
15598   return TRUE;
15599 }
15600 
15601 /* Used to decide how to sort relocs in an optimal manner for the
15602    dynamic linker, before writing them out.  */
15603 
15604 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
15605 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
15606 			    const asection *rel_sec,
15607 			    const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
15608 {
15609   enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
15610   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
15611 
15612   if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
15613     return reloc_class_ifunc;
15614 
15615   r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rela->r_info);
15616   switch (r_type)
15617     {
15618     case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
15619       return reloc_class_relative;
15620     case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
15621       return reloc_class_plt;
15622     case R_PPC64_COPY:
15623       return reloc_class_copy;
15624     default:
15625       return reloc_class_normal;
15626     }
15627 }
15628 
15629 /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
15630 
15631 static bfd_boolean
15632 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
15633 				   struct bfd_link_info *info)
15634 {
15635   struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
15636   bfd *dynobj;
15637   asection *sdyn;
15638 
15639   htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
15640   if (htab == NULL)
15641     return FALSE;
15642 
15643   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
15644   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
15645 
15646   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
15647     {
15648       Elf64_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
15649 
15650       if (sdyn == NULL || htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
15651 	abort ();
15652 
15653       dyncon = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
15654       dynconend = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
15655       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
15656 	{
15657 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
15658 	  asection *s;
15659 
15660 	  bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
15661 
15662 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
15663 	    {
15664 	    default:
15665 	      continue;
15666 
15667 	    case DT_PPC64_GLINK:
15668 	      s = htab->glink;
15669 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
15670 	      /* We stupidly defined DT_PPC64_GLINK to be the start
15671 		 of glink rather than the first entry point, which is
15672 		 what ld.so needs, and now have a bigger stub to
15673 		 support automatic multiple TOCs.  */
15674 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) - 8 * 4;
15675 	      break;
15676 
15677 	    case DT_PPC64_OPD:
15678 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
15679 	      if (s == NULL)
15680 		continue;
15681 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
15682 	      break;
15683 
15684 	    case DT_PPC64_OPT:
15685 	      if (htab->do_multi_toc && htab->multi_toc_needed)
15686 		dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_MULTI_TOC;
15687 	      if (htab->has_plt_localentry0)
15688 		dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_LOCALENTRY;
15689 	      break;
15690 
15691 	    case DT_PPC64_OPDSZ:
15692 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
15693 	      if (s == NULL)
15694 		continue;
15695 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size;
15696 	      break;
15697 
15698 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
15699 	      s = htab->elf.splt;
15700 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
15701 	      break;
15702 
15703 	    case DT_JMPREL:
15704 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt;
15705 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
15706 	      break;
15707 
15708 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
15709 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
15710 	      break;
15711 
15712 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
15713 	      if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
15714 		info->callbacks->einfo
15715 		  (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
15716 		     "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
15717 	      else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
15718 		info->callbacks->einfo
15719 		  (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
15720 		     "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
15721 	      continue;
15722 	    }
15723 
15724 	  bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
15725 	}
15726     }
15727 
15728   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->elf.sgot->size != 0
15729       && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
15730     {
15731       /* Fill in the first entry in the global offset table.
15732 	 We use it to hold the link-time TOCbase.  */
15733       bfd_put_64 (output_bfd,
15734 		  elf_gp (output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF,
15735 		  htab->elf.sgot->contents);
15736 
15737       /* Set .got entry size.  */
15738       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
15739 	= 8;
15740     }
15741 
15742   if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
15743       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
15744     {
15745       /* Set .plt entry size.  */
15746       elf_section_data (htab->elf.splt->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
15747 	= PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
15748     }
15749 
15750   /* brlt is SEC_LINKER_CREATED, so we need to write out relocs for
15751      brlt ourselves if emitrelocations.  */
15752   if (htab->brlt != NULL
15753       && htab->brlt->reloc_count != 0
15754       && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
15755 				       htab->brlt,
15756 				       elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->rela.hdr,
15757 				       elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->relocs,
15758 				       NULL))
15759     return FALSE;
15760 
15761   if (htab->glink != NULL
15762       && htab->glink->reloc_count != 0
15763       && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
15764 				       htab->glink,
15765 				       elf_section_data (htab->glink)->rela.hdr,
15766 				       elf_section_data (htab->glink)->relocs,
15767 				       NULL))
15768     return FALSE;
15769 
15770 
15771   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
15772       && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0
15773       && htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
15774       && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
15775 					   htab->glink_eh_frame,
15776 					   htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
15777     return FALSE;
15778 
15779   /* We need to handle writing out multiple GOT sections ourselves,
15780      since we didn't add them to DYNOBJ.  We know dynobj is the first
15781      bfd.  */
15782   while ((dynobj = dynobj->link.next) != NULL)
15783     {
15784       asection *s;
15785 
15786       if (!is_ppc64_elf (dynobj))
15787 	continue;
15788 
15789       s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->got;
15790       if (s != NULL
15791 	  && s->size != 0
15792 	  && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
15793 	  && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
15794 					s->contents, s->output_offset,
15795 					s->size))
15796 	return FALSE;
15797       s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->relgot;
15798       if (s != NULL
15799 	  && s->size != 0
15800 	  && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
15801 	  && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
15802 					s->contents, s->output_offset,
15803 					s->size))
15804 	return FALSE;
15805     }
15806 
15807   return TRUE;
15808 }
15809 
15810 #include "elf64-target.h"
15811 
15812 /* FreeBSD support */
15813 
15814 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
15815 #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
15816 
15817 #undef  TARGET_BIG_SYM
15818 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM	powerpc_elf64_fbsd_vec
15819 #undef  TARGET_BIG_NAME
15820 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc-freebsd"
15821 
15822 #undef  ELF_OSABI
15823 #define	ELF_OSABI       ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
15824 
15825 #undef  elf64_bed
15826 #define elf64_bed	elf64_powerpc_fbsd_bed
15827 
15828 #include "elf64-target.h"
15829